US20140272592A1 - Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers - Google Patents

Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20140272592A1
US20140272592A1 US14/084,469 US201314084469A US2014272592A1 US 20140272592 A1 US20140272592 A1 US 20140272592A1 US 201314084469 A US201314084469 A US 201314084469A US 2014272592 A1 US2014272592 A1 US 2014272592A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
carbon
composite material
less
electrochemical modifier
polymer
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US14/084,469
Inventor
Leah A. Thompkins
Avery J. Sakshaug
Katharine Geramita
Aaron M. Feaver
Henry R. Costantino
Benjamin E. Kron
Aaron McAdie
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Group14 Technologies Inc
Original Assignee
EnerG2 Technologies Inc
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by EnerG2 Technologies Inc filed Critical EnerG2 Technologies Inc
Priority to US14/084,469 priority Critical patent/US20140272592A1/en
Assigned to ENERG2 TECHNOLOGIES, INC. reassignment ENERG2 TECHNOLOGIES, INC. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: GERAMITA, KATHARINE, COSTANTINO, HENRY R., FEAVER, AARON M., KRON, Benjamin E., MCADIE, Aaron, SAKSHAUG, AVERY J., THOMPKINS, LEAH A.
Publication of US20140272592A1 publication Critical patent/US20140272592A1/en
Priority to US15/675,462 priority patent/US10454103B2/en
Assigned to Group 14 Technologies, Inc. reassignment Group 14 Technologies, Inc. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: ENERG2 TECHNOLOGIES, INC.
Priority to US16/406,971 priority patent/US10714744B2/en
Priority to US16/894,582 priority patent/US11495793B2/en
Priority to US17/960,707 priority patent/US20230115078A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/36Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids
    • H01M4/362Composites
    • H01M4/366Composites as layered products
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01GCAPACITORS; CAPACITORS, RECTIFIERS, DETECTORS, SWITCHING DEVICES OR LIGHT-SENSITIVE DEVICES, OF THE ELECTROLYTIC TYPE
    • H01G11/00Hybrid capacitors, i.e. capacitors having different positive and negative electrodes; Electric double-layer [EDL] capacitors; Processes for the manufacture thereof or of parts thereof
    • H01G11/04Hybrid capacitors
    • H01G11/06Hybrid capacitors with one of the electrodes allowing ions to be reversibly doped thereinto, e.g. lithium ion capacitors [LIC]
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01GCAPACITORS; CAPACITORS, RECTIFIERS, DETECTORS, SWITCHING DEVICES OR LIGHT-SENSITIVE DEVICES, OF THE ELECTROLYTIC TYPE
    • H01G11/00Hybrid capacitors, i.e. capacitors having different positive and negative electrodes; Electric double-layer [EDL] capacitors; Processes for the manufacture thereof or of parts thereof
    • H01G11/22Electrodes
    • H01G11/30Electrodes characterised by their material
    • H01G11/32Carbon-based
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01GCAPACITORS; CAPACITORS, RECTIFIERS, DETECTORS, SWITCHING DEVICES OR LIGHT-SENSITIVE DEVICES, OF THE ELECTROLYTIC TYPE
    • H01G11/00Hybrid capacitors, i.e. capacitors having different positive and negative electrodes; Electric double-layer [EDL] capacitors; Processes for the manufacture thereof or of parts thereof
    • H01G11/22Electrodes
    • H01G11/30Electrodes characterised by their material
    • H01G11/50Electrodes characterised by their material specially adapted for lithium-ion capacitors, e.g. for lithium-doping or for intercalation
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M10/00Secondary cells; Manufacture thereof
    • H01M10/05Accumulators with non-aqueous electrolyte
    • H01M10/052Li-accumulators
    • H01M10/0525Rocking-chair batteries, i.e. batteries with lithium insertion or intercalation in both electrodes; Lithium-ion batteries
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/04Processes of manufacture in general
    • H01M4/0471Processes of manufacture in general involving thermal treatment, e.g. firing, sintering, backing particulate active material, thermal decomposition, pyrolysis
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/13Electrodes for accumulators with non-aqueous electrolyte, e.g. for lithium-accumulators; Processes of manufacture thereof
    • H01M4/133Electrodes based on carbonaceous material, e.g. graphite-intercalation compounds or CFx
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/13Electrodes for accumulators with non-aqueous electrolyte, e.g. for lithium-accumulators; Processes of manufacture thereof
    • H01M4/134Electrodes based on metals, Si or alloys
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/13Electrodes for accumulators with non-aqueous electrolyte, e.g. for lithium-accumulators; Processes of manufacture thereof
    • H01M4/139Processes of manufacture
    • H01M4/1393Processes of manufacture of electrodes based on carbonaceous material, e.g. graphite-intercalation compounds or CFx
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/13Electrodes for accumulators with non-aqueous electrolyte, e.g. for lithium-accumulators; Processes of manufacture thereof
    • H01M4/139Processes of manufacture
    • H01M4/1395Processes of manufacture of electrodes based on metals, Si or alloys
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/36Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids
    • H01M4/362Composites
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/36Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids
    • H01M4/362Composites
    • H01M4/364Composites as mixtures
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/36Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids
    • H01M4/38Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids of elements or alloys
    • H01M4/386Silicon or alloys based on silicon
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/36Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids
    • H01M4/58Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids of inorganic compounds other than oxides or hydroxides, e.g. sulfides, selenides, tellurides, halogenides or LiCoFy; of polyanionic structures, e.g. phosphates, silicates or borates
    • H01M4/583Carbonaceous material, e.g. graphite-intercalation compounds or CFx
    • H01M4/587Carbonaceous material, e.g. graphite-intercalation compounds or CFx for inserting or intercalating light metals
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/62Selection of inactive substances as ingredients for active masses, e.g. binders, fillers
    • H01M4/624Electric conductive fillers
    • H01M4/625Carbon or graphite
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/36Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids
    • H01M4/38Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids of elements or alloys
    • H01M4/387Tin or alloys based on tin
    • HELECTRICITY
    • H01ELECTRIC ELEMENTS
    • H01MPROCESSES OR MEANS, e.g. BATTERIES, FOR THE DIRECT CONVERSION OF CHEMICAL ENERGY INTO ELECTRICAL ENERGY
    • H01M4/00Electrodes
    • H01M4/02Electrodes composed of, or comprising, active material
    • H01M4/36Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids
    • H01M4/48Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids of inorganic oxides or hydroxides
    • H01M4/483Selection of substances as active materials, active masses, active liquids of inorganic oxides or hydroxides for non-aqueous cells
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02EREDUCTION OF GREENHOUSE GAS [GHG] EMISSIONS, RELATED TO ENERGY GENERATION, TRANSMISSION OR DISTRIBUTION
    • Y02E60/00Enabling technologies; Technologies with a potential or indirect contribution to GHG emissions mitigation
    • Y02E60/10Energy storage using batteries
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02EREDUCTION OF GREENHOUSE GAS [GHG] EMISSIONS, RELATED TO ENERGY GENERATION, TRANSMISSION OR DISTRIBUTION
    • Y02E60/00Enabling technologies; Technologies with a potential or indirect contribution to GHG emissions mitigation
    • Y02E60/13Energy storage using capacitors
    • YGENERAL TAGGING OF NEW TECHNOLOGICAL DEVELOPMENTS; GENERAL TAGGING OF CROSS-SECTIONAL TECHNOLOGIES SPANNING OVER SEVERAL SECTIONS OF THE IPC; TECHNICAL SUBJECTS COVERED BY FORMER USPC CROSS-REFERENCE ART COLLECTIONS [XRACs] AND DIGESTS
    • Y02TECHNOLOGIES OR APPLICATIONS FOR MITIGATION OR ADAPTATION AGAINST CLIMATE CHANGE
    • Y02TCLIMATE CHANGE MITIGATION TECHNOLOGIES RELATED TO TRANSPORTATION
    • Y02T10/00Road transport of goods or passengers
    • Y02T10/60Other road transportation technologies with climate change mitigation effect
    • Y02T10/70Energy storage systems for electromobility, e.g. batteries

Definitions

  • the present invention generally relates to composite carbon materials, methods for making the same and devices containing the same.
  • Lithium-based electrical storage devices have potential to replace devices currently used in any number of applications. For example, current lead acid automobile batteries are not adequate for next generation all-electric and hybrid electric vehicles due to irreversible, stable sulfate formations during discharge. Lithium ion batteries are a viable alternative to the lead-based systems currently used due to their capacity, and other considerations.
  • Carbon is one of the primary materials used in both lithium secondary batteries and hybrid lithium-ion capacitors (LIC).
  • the carbon anode typically stores lithium between layered graphite sheets through a mechanism called intercalation.
  • Traditional lithium ion batteries are comprised of a graphitic carbon anode and a metal oxide cathode; however such graphitic anodes typically suffer from low power performance and limited capacity.
  • Silicon, Tin, and other lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers have also been proposed based on their ability to store very large amounts of lithium per unit weight.
  • these materials are fundamentally limited by the substantial swelling that occurs when they are fully lithiated. This swelling and shrinkage when the lithium is removed results in an electrode that has limited cycle life and low power.
  • the solution thus far has been to use very small amounts of alloying electrochemical modifier in a largely carbon electrode, but this approach does not impart the desired increase in lithium capacity. Finding a way to increase the alloying electrochemical modifier content in an anode composition while maintaining cycle stability is desired to increase capacity.
  • Hard carbon materials have been proposed for use in lithium ion batteries, but the physical and chemical properties of known hard carbon materials are not optimized for use as anodes in lithium-based batteries. Thus, anodes comprising known hard carbon materials still suffer from many of the disadvantages of limited capacity and low first cycle efficiency. Hard carbon materials having properties optimized for use in lithium-based batteries are expected to address these deficiencies and provide other related advantages.
  • the current invention is directed to novel hard carbon materials and their composites that contain high lithium capacity alloying electrochemical modifiers with optimized lithium storage and utilization properties.
  • the novel composite materials find utility in any number of electrical energy storage devices, for example as electrode material in lithium-based electrical energy storage devices (e.g., lithium ion batteries). Electrodes comprising the composite materials display high reversible capacity, high first cycle efficiency, high power performance or any combination thereof.
  • the present disclosure provides a composite material having a first cycle insertion of at least 700 mAh/g and a first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation of greater than 70% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, wherein the composite material comprises a carbon material and a lithium alloying electrochemical modifier.
  • the first cycle insertion is at least 1000 mAh/g and the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 80%. In other embodiments, the first cycle insertion is at least 2400 mAh/g and the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 80%. In still other embodiments of the foregoing, the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 90%.
  • the composite material further comprises a first cycle extraction of at least 600 mAh/g and a fifth cycle retention of greater than 99%.
  • the first cycle extraction is at least 1200 mAh/g.
  • the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier is silicon, tin, germanium, nickel, aluminum, manganese, Al 2 O 3 , titanium, titanium oxide, sulfur, molybdenum, arsenic, gallium, phosphorous, selenium, antimony, bismuth, tellurium or indium or combinations thereof.
  • the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier is silicon.
  • the composite material comprises particles having a core-shell structure, wherein the shell comprises substantially the carbon material and the core comprises substantially the electrochemical modifier.
  • the composite material comprises particles having a core-shell structure wherein the core comprises substantially the carbon material and the shell comprises substantially the electrochemical modifier.
  • the composite material comprises particles of the carbon material, carbon material particles encapsulating a plurality of particles of the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises nanoparticles.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises particles having a particle size ranging from 10 nm to 500 nm.
  • ratios of carbon and electrochemical modifier are present in the disclosed composite materials.
  • a ratio of carbon material to electrochemical modifier ranges from 40:1 to 1:99 on a mass basis. In other embodiments, a ratio of carbon material to electrochemical modifier ranges from 19:1 to 1:9 on a mass basis.
  • the composite material further comprises an efficiency enhancing electrochemical modifier.
  • the efficiency enhancing electrochemical modifier comprises phosphorus and in further embodiments the phosphorous is present in the composite material at 3-13% as measured by TXRF.
  • the composite material comprises a total of less than 200 ppm of all elements having atomic numbers ranging from 11 to 92, excluding any intentionally added electrochemical modifier, as measured by TXRF.
  • the carbon material is a hard carbon material.
  • the present disclosure is directed to a composite material having a first cycle extraction of at least 1900 mAh/g and a first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation of greater than 80% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, wherein the composite material comprises silicon and carbon material in a ratio ranging from about 8.5:1 to about 9.5:1 by weight and further comprising 3-13% phosphorus. In other related embodiments, the ratio of silicon to carbon is about 9:1.
  • the disclosure provides a method for preparing a composite material, the composite material comprising a carbon material and a lithium alloying electrochemical modifier, the method comprising:
  • the polymer precursor comprises polyphenylglycidylether-co-formaldehyde polymer
  • copolymerizing further comprises reacting the polymer precursors in the presence of phosphoric acid.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises silicon. In still other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier or the compound comprising the electrochemical modifier is brought into contact with a composition comprising the polymer precursors before initiation of polymerization.
  • the electrochemical modifier or the compound comprising the electrochemical modifier is brought into contact with a composition comprising the polymer precursors after initiation of polymerization.
  • the electrochemical modifier is in the form of particles, for example nanoparticles.
  • the disclosure is directed to an electrode comprising any of the composite materials described herein. Devices comprising such electrodes are also provided.
  • an electrical energy storage device comprising:
  • the device is a lithium ion battery or hybrid lithium ion capacitor.
  • FIG. 1 depicts pore size distribution of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 2 shows electrochemical performance of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 3 presents pore size distributions of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 4 depicts RAMAN spectra of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 5 is a plot of an x-ray diffraction pattern of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 6 shows an example SAXS plot along with the calculation of the empirical R value for determining internal pore structure.
  • FIG. 7 presents SAXS of three exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 8 a presents FTIR spectra of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 8 b shows electrochemical performance of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 9 presents electrochemical performance of a carbon material before and after hydrocarbon surface treatment.
  • FIG. 10 is a graph showing pore size distribution of a carbon material before and after hydrocarbon surface treatment
  • FIG. 11 presents first cycle voltage profiles of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 12 is a graph showing the electrochemical stability of an exemplary carbon material compared to graphitic carbon.
  • FIG. 13 shows voltage versus specific capacity data for a silicon-carbon composite material.
  • FIG. 14 shows a TEM of a silicon particle embedded into a hard carbon particle
  • FIG. 15 depicts electrochemical performance of hard carbon materials comprising an electrochemical modifier.
  • FIG. 16 shows electrochemical performance of hard carbon materials comprising graphite.
  • FIG. 17 is a graph showing electrochemical performance of hard carbon materials comprising graphite.
  • FIG. 18 presents the differential capacity, the voltage profile and the stability of graphitic materials cycled at different voltage profiles.
  • FIG. 19 presents the differential capacity, the voltage profile and the stability of hard carbon materials cycled at different voltage profiles.
  • FIG. 20 is a graph of a wide angle XPS spectrum for an exemplary carbon material.
  • FIG. 21 presents an Auger scan using XPS methods for an exemplary carbon material having approximately 65% sp 2 hybridized carbons.
  • FIG. 22 depicts a SAXS measurement, internal pore analysis and domain size of exemplary hard carbon material
  • FIG. 23 demonstrates the effect on pH as the pyrolysis temperature increases for a representative carbon material.
  • FIG. 24 shows Li:C ratio for an exemplary carbon material as a function of pH from 7 to 7.5.
  • FIG. 25 presents the capacity of an exemplary, ultrapure hard carbon.
  • FIG. 26 is another graph showing the capacity of an exemplary, ultrapure hard carbon.
  • FIG. 27 presents specific extraction capacity data for exemplary carbon-silicon composites.
  • FIG. 28 provides specific extraction capacity data for exemplary carbon-silicon composites.
  • FIG. 29 provides first cycle efficiency data.
  • FIG. 30 shows FTIR spectra of neat epoxy resin (1), diluted phosphoric acid (2) and cured epoxy-P resin (3).
  • FIG. 31 shows the spectra from FIG. 30 , sized to highlight the fingerprint region.
  • FIG. 32 shows the FTIR spectra of the neat epoxy resin (5), cured epoxy-P resin with 5% acid (4), 10% acid (1), 20% acid (3), and 40% acid (2).
  • the viewing area of the spectra is sized to illustrate the epoxide bending absorbance band at ⁇ 910 cm-1.
  • FIG. 33 presents example TGA data for polymer resin comprising phosphoric acid demonstrating an exothermic event at about 250 C.
  • Carbon material refers to a material or substance comprised substantially of carbon. Carbon materials include ultrapure as well as amorphous and crystalline carbon materials. Examples of carbon materials include, but are not limited to, activated carbon, pyrolyzed dried polymer gels, pyrolyzed polymer cryogels, pyrolyzed polymer xerogels, pyrolyzed polymer aerogels, activated dried polymer gels, activated polymer cryogels, activated polymer xerogels, activated polymer aerogels and the like. “Carbon material” is also referred to herein as the “carbon component” with respect to the disclosed composites. Throughout the description herein, “carbon material” and/or “carbon component” refers to the carbon material or carbon component, respectively, in the absence of electrochemical modifier (which is typically present in the disclosed composites).
  • Hard Carbon refers to a non-graphitizable carbon material. At elevated temperatures (e.g., >1500° C.) a hard carbon remains substantially amorphous, whereas a “soft” carbon will undergo crystallization and become graphitic.
  • Modified hard carbon or “composite material” refer to material comprising both carbon and an electrochemical modifier such as a lithium alloying material, such as silicon, tin, germanium, nickel, aluminum, manganese, Al 2 O 3 , titanium, titanium oxide, sulfur, molybdenum, arsenic, gallium, phosphorous, selenium, antimony, bismuth, tellurium or indium or any other metal or semi-metal that is capable of lithium uptake.
  • the carbon and lithium alloying material are intimately integrated through chemical bonding or in other embodiments the two materials are a distinct mixture between two powders.
  • the composite materials comprise an efficiency enhancer.
  • Allotrope refers to a material which can exists in different forms. C60, graphene, diamond, hard carbon, soft carbon, graphite, and carbon nanotubes are non-limiting examples of carbon allotropes.
  • First cycle efficiency refers to the percent difference in volumetric or gravimetric capacity between the initial charge and the first discharge cycle of a lithium battery. First cycle efficiency is calculated by the following formula: (F 2 /F 1 ) ⁇ 100), where F 1 and F 2 are the volumetric or gravimetric capacity of the initial lithium insertion and the first cycle lithium extraction, respectively.
  • Electrochemical modifier refers to any chemical element, compound comprising a chemical element or any combination of different chemical elements and compounds which enhances the electrochemical performance of a carbon material. Electrochemical modifiers can change (increase or decrease) the resistance, capacity, efficiency, power performance, stability and/or other properties of a carbon material. Electrochemical modifiers generally impart a desired electrochemical effect. In contrast, an impurity in a carbon material is generally undesired and tends to degrade, rather than enhance, the electrochemical performance of the carbon material. Examples of electrochemical modifiers within the context of the present disclosure include, but are not limited to, elements, and compounds or oxides comprising elements, in groups 12-15 of the periodic table, other elements such as silicon, tin, sulfur, and tungsten and combinations thereof.
  • electrochemical modifiers include, but are not limited to, tin, silicon, tungsten, silver, zinc, molybdenum, iron, nickel, aluminum, manganese and combinations thereof as well as oxides of the same and compounds comprising the same.
  • the electrochemical modifier is a lithium alloying material, such as silicon, tin, germanium, nickel, aluminum, manganese, Al 2 O 3 , titanium, titanium oxide, sulfur, molybdenum, arsenic, gallium, phosphorous, selenium, antimony, bismuth, tellurium or indium or any other metal or semi-metal that is capable of lithium uptake.
  • Effective enhancer refers to a sub-class of electrochemical modifier that can increase the first cycle efficiency of a carbon material. In certain embodiments, the potency of an efficiency enhancer is dependent on the method of its incorporation into the carbon material.
  • Group 12 elements include zinc (Zn), cadmium (Cd), mercury (Hg), and copernicium (Cn).
  • Group 13 elements include boron (B), aluminum (Al), gallium (Ga), indium (In) and thallium (Tl).
  • Group 14 elements include carbon (C), silicon (Si), germanium (Ge), tin (Sn) and lead (Pb).
  • Group 15 elements include nitrogen (N), phosphorous (P), arsenic (As), antimony (Sb) and bismuth (Bi).
  • Amorphous refers to a material, for example an amorphous carbon material, whose constituent atoms, molecules, or ions are arranged randomly without a regular repeating pattern. Amorphous materials may have some localized crystallinity (i.e., regularity) but lack long-range order of the positions of the atoms. Pyrolyzed and/or activated carbon materials are generally amorphous.
  • Crystal refers to a material whose constituent atoms, molecules, or ions are arranged in an orderly repeating pattern.
  • Examples of crystalline carbon materials include, but are not limited to, diamond and graphene.
  • Synthetic refers to a substance which has been prepared by chemical means rather than from a natural source.
  • a synthetic carbon material is one which is synthesized from precursor materials and is not isolated from natural sources.
  • Impurity or “impurity element” refers to an undesired foreign substance (e.g., a chemical element) within a material which differs from the chemical composition of the base material.
  • an impurity in a carbon material or composite material refers to any element or combination of elements, other than carbon, which is present in the carbon material. Impurity levels are typically expressed in parts per million (ppm). Impurities do not include substances, such as electrochemical modifiers, which are purposely added to a carbon material or composite material.
  • TXRF impurity is any impurity element having an atomic number ranging from 11 to 92 (i.e., from sodium to uranium), excluding any intentionally added electrochemical modifier.
  • the phrases “total TXRF impurity content,” “total TXRF impurity level,” “total PIXE impurity content” and “total PIXE impurity level” refer to the sum of all TXRF or PIXE impurities present in a sample, for example, a polymer gel, a carbon material or a composite material. Electrochemical modifiers are not considered TXRF PIXE impurities as they are a desired constituent of the composite materials.
  • an element may be added to a carbon material as an electrochemical modifier and will not be considered a TXRF or PIXE impurity, while in other embodiments the same element may not be a desired electrochemical modifier and, if present in the carbon material or composite material, will be considered a TXRF or PIXE impurity.
  • TXRF impurity concentrations and identities may be determined by total x-ray reflection fluorescence (TXRF).
  • PIXE impurity concentrations and identities may be determined by proton induced x-ray emission (PIXE).
  • Ultratrapure refers to a substance having a total TXRF or PIXE impurity content of less than 0.050%.
  • an “ultrapure carbon material” is a carbon material having a total TXRF or PIXE impurity content of less than 0.050% (i.e., 500 ppm).
  • Ash content refers to the nonvolatile inorganic matter which remains after subjecting a substance to a high decomposition temperature.
  • the ash content of a carbon material is calculated from the total TXRF or PIXE impurity content as measured by total x-ray reflection fluorescence, assuming that nonvolatile elements are completely converted to expected combustion products (i.e., oxides).
  • Polymer refers to a macromolecule comprised of two or more structural repeating units.
  • Synthetic polymer precursor material refers to compounds used in the preparation of a synthetic polymer.
  • polymer precursors include, but are not limited to, aldehydes (i.e., HC( ⁇ O)R, where R is an organic group), such as for example, methanal (formaldehyde); ethanal (acetaldehyde); propanal (propionaldehyde); butanal (butyraldehyde); glucose; benzaldehyde and cinnamaldehyde.
  • exemplary polymer precursors include, but are not limited to, phenolic compounds such as phenol and polyhydroxy benzenes, such as dihydroxy or trihydroxy benzenes, for example, resorcinol (i.e., 1,3-dihydroxy benzene), catechol, hydroquinone, and phloroglucinol. Mixtures of two or more polyhydroxy benzenes are also contemplated within the meaning of polymer precursor.
  • “Monolithic” refers to a solid, three-dimensional structure that is not particulate in nature.
  • Sol refers to a colloidal suspension of precursor particles (e.g., polymer precursors), and the term “gel” refers to a wet three-dimensional porous network obtained by condensation or reaction of the precursor particles.
  • Polymer gel refers to a gel in which the network component is a polymer; generally a polymer gel is a wet (aqueous or non-aqueous based) three-dimensional structure comprised of a polymer formed from synthetic precursors or polymer precursors.
  • Solid gel refers to a sub-class of polymer gel where the polymer is a colloidal suspension that forms a wet three-dimensional porous network obtained by reaction of the polymer precursors.
  • Polymer hydrogel or “hydrogel” refers to a subclass of polymer gel or gel wherein the solvent for the synthetic precursors or monomers is water or mixtures of water and one or more water-miscible solvent.
  • Acid refers to any substance that is capable of lowering the pH of a solution. Acids include Arrhenius, Br ⁇ nsted and Lewis acids. A “solid acid” refers to a dried or granular compound that yields an acidic solution when dissolved in a solvent. The term “acidic” means having the properties of an acid.
  • Base refers to any substance that is capable of raising the pH of a solution. Bases include Arrhenius, Br ⁇ nsted and Lewis bases. A “solid base” refers to a dried or granular compound that yields basic solution when dissolved in a solvent. The term “basic” means having the properties of a base.
  • “Miscible” refers to the property of a mixture wherein the mixture forms a single phase over certain ranges of temperature, pressure, and composition.
  • Catalyst is a substance which alters the rate of a chemical reaction. Catalysts participate in a reaction in a cyclic fashion such that the catalyst is cyclically regenerated.
  • the present disclosure contemplates catalysts which are sodium free.
  • the catalyst used in the preparation of a ultrapure polymer gel as described herein can be any compound that facilitates the polymerization of the polymer precursors to form an ultrapure polymer gel.
  • a “volatile catalyst” is a catalyst which has a tendency to vaporize at or below atmospheric pressure. Exemplary volatile catalysts include, but are not limited to, ammoniums salts, such as ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium carbonate, ammonium hydroxide, and combinations thereof.
  • solvent refers to a substance which dissolves or suspends reactants (e.g., ultrapure polymer precursors) and provides a medium in which a reaction may occur.
  • solvents useful in the preparation of the gels, ultrapure polymer gels, ultrapure synthetic carbon materials and ultrapure synthetic amorphous carbon materials disclosed herein include, but are not limited to, water, alcohols and mixtures thereof.
  • Exemplary alcohols include ethanol, t-butanol, methanol and mixtures thereof.
  • solvents are useful for dissolution of the synthetic ultrapure polymer precursor materials, for example dissolution of a phenolic or aldehyde compound.
  • a cryogel is prepared by a process that does not include solvent exchange.
  • “Dried gel” or “dried polymer gel” refers to a gel or polymer gel, respectively, from which the solvent, generally water, or mixture of water and one or more water-miscible solvents, has been substantially removed.
  • “Pyrolyzed dried polymer gel” refers to a dried polymer gel which has been pyrolyzed but not yet activated, while an “activated dried polymer gel” refers to a dried polymer gel which has been activated.
  • Carbonizing”, “pyrolyzing”, “carbonization” and “pyrolysis” each refer to the process of heating a carbon-containing substance at a pyrolysis dwell temperature in an inert atmosphere (e.g., argon, nitrogen or combinations thereof) or in a vacuum such that the targeted material collected at the end of the process is primarily carbon.
  • an inert atmosphere e.g., argon, nitrogen or combinations thereof
  • “Pyrolyzed” refers to a material or substance, for example a carbon material, which has undergone the process of pyrolysis.
  • Dwell temperature refers to the temperature of the furnace during the portion of a process which is reserved for maintaining a relatively constant temperature (i.e., neither increasing nor decreasing the temperature).
  • the pyrolysis dwell temperature refers to the relatively constant temperature of the furnace during pyrolysis
  • the activation dwell temperature refers to the relatively constant temperature of the furnace during activation.
  • Pore refers to an opening or depression in the surface, or a tunnel in a carbon material, such as for example activated carbon, pyrolyzed dried polymer gels, pyrolyzed polymer cryogels, pyrolyzed polymer xerogels, pyrolyzed polymer aerogels, activated dried polymer gels, activated polymer cryogels, activated polymer xerogels, activated polymer aerogels and the like.
  • a pore can be a single tunnel or connected to other tunnels in a continuous network throughout the structure.
  • Pore structure refers to the layout of the surface of the internal pores within a carbon material, such as an activated carbon material. Components of the pore structure include pore size, pore volume, surface area, density, pore size distribution and pore length. Generally the pore structure of activated carbon material comprises micropores and mesopores.
  • Pore volume refers to the total volume of the carbon mass occupied by pores or empty volume.
  • the pores may be either internal (not accessible by gas sorption) or external (accessible by gas sorption).
  • Micropore generally refers to pores having a diameter between about 2 nanometers and about 50 nanometers while the term “micropore” refers to pores having a diameter less than about 2 nanometers.
  • Mesoporous carbon materials comprise greater than 50% of their total pore volume in mesopores while microporous carbon materials comprise greater than 50% of their total pore volume in micropores.
  • “Surface area” refers to the total specific surface area of a substance measurable by the BET technique. Surface area is typically expressed in units of m 2 /g.
  • the BET (Brunauer/Emmett/Teller) technique employs an inert gas, for example nitrogen, to measure the amount of gas adsorbed on a material and is commonly used in the art to determine the accessible surface area of materials.
  • Electrode refers to a conductor through which electricity enters or leaves an object, substance or region.
  • Binder refers to a material capable of holding individual particles of a substance (e.g., a carbon material) together such that after mixing a binder and the particles together the resulting mixture can be formed into sheets, pellets, disks or other shapes.
  • binders include fluoro polymers, such as, for example, PTFE (polytetrafluoroethylene, Teflon), PFA (perfluoroalkoxy polymer resin, also known as Teflon), FEP (fluorinated ethylene propylene, also known as Teflon), ETFE (polyethylenetetrafluoroethylene, sold as Tefzel and Fluon), PVF (polyvinyl fluoride, sold as Tedlar), ECTFE (polyethylenechlorotrifluoroethylene, sold as Halar), PVDF (polyvinylidene fluoride, sold as Kynar), PCTFE (polychlorotrifluoroethylene, sold as Kel-F and CTFE), trifluoro
  • “Inert” refers to a material that is not active in the electrolyte of an electrical energy storage device, that is it does not absorb a significant amount of ions or change chemically, e.g., degrade.
  • Conductive refers to the ability of a material to conduct electrons through transmission of loosely held valence electrons.
  • “Current collector” refers to a part of an electrical energy storage and/or distribution device which provides an electrical connection to facilitate the flow of electricity in to, or out of, the device.
  • Current collectors often comprise metal and/or other conductive materials and may be used as a backing for electrodes to facilitate the flow of electricity to and from the electrode.
  • Electrolytes means a substance containing free ions such that the substance is electrically conductive. Electrolytes are commonly employed in electrical energy storage devices. Examples of electrolytes include, but are not limited to, solvents such as propylene carbonate, ethylene carbonate, butylene carbonate, dimethyl carbonate, methyl ethyl carbonate, diethyl carbonate, sulfolane, methylsulfolane, acetonitrile or mixtures thereof in combination with solutes such as tetralkylammonium salts such as LiPF 6 (lithium hexafluorophosphate), LiBOB (lithium bis(oxatlato)borate, TEA TFB (tetraethylammonium tetrafluoroborate), MTEATFB (methyltriethylammonium tetrafluoroborate), EMITFB (1-ethyl-3-methylimidazolium tetrafluoroborate), tetraethyl
  • “Elemental form” refers to a chemical element having an oxidation state of zero (e.g., metallic lead).
  • Oxidized form refers to a chemical element having an oxidation state greater than zero.
  • “Skeletal density” refers to the density of the material including internal porosity and excluding external porosity as measured by helium pycnometry
  • Lithium uptake refers to a carbon's ability to intercalate, absorb, or store lithium as measured as a ratio between the maximum number of lithium atoms to 6 carbon atoms.
  • X-ray photoelectron spectroscopy (“XPS”) is a spectroscopic technique for quantitating a material's elemental composition and provides information on chemical state and electronic state of elements that exist within a material.
  • the presently disclosed composite materials comprise hard carbon materials which are optimized for use in lithium-based devices and which exceed the performance characteristics of other known devices.
  • the present disclosure is directed to composite materials useful as anode material in lithium-based (or sodium-based) and other electrical storage devices. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the electrochemical modifier content of a composite, electrochemical modifier structure within the composite, purity profile of the carbon, surface area of the carbon, porosity of the carbon and/or other properties of the carbon materials are related, at least in part, to its preparation method, and variation of the preparation parameters may yield composite materials having different properties. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the composite material is a pyrolyzed polymer gel with a high silicon content.
  • one embodiment of the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite material has a first cycle efficiency of greater than 50% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery.
  • some embodiments provide a composite material having a surface area of greater than 50 m 2 /g, wherein the composite material has a first cycle efficiency of greater than 50% and a reversible capacity of at least 600 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device.
  • the first cycle efficiency is greater than 55%. In some other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 60%. In yet other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 65%. In still other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 70%. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 75%, and in other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 80%, greater than 90%, greater than 95%, greater than 98%, or greater than 99%.
  • the composite materials also comprise a surface area ranging from about 5 m 2 /g to about 400 m 2 /g. or a pore volume ranging from about 0.05 to about 1.0 cc/g or both. For example, in some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 200 m 2 /g to about 300 m 2 /g or the surface area is about 250 m 2 /g.
  • the composite material has a surface area of less than 50 m 2 /g, wherein the composite material has a first cycle efficiency of greater than 50% and a reversible capacity of at least 600 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device.
  • the first cycle efficiency is greater than 55%.
  • the first cycle efficiency is greater than 60%.
  • the first cycle efficiency is greater than 65%.
  • the first cycle efficiency is greater than 70%.
  • the first cycle efficiency is greater than 75%, and in other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 80%, greater than 90%, greater than 95%, greater than 98%, or greater than 99%.
  • the composite materials comprise a surface area ranging from about 5 m 2 /g to about 400 m 2 /g or a pore volume ranging from about 0.05 to about 1.0 cc/g or both.
  • the surface area ranges from about 200 m 2 /g to about 300 m 2 /g or the surface area is about 250 m 2 /g.
  • the properties of the composite material can be determined by incorporating it into an electrode, known to those versed in the art.
  • the composite is tested electrochemically.
  • the methods of testing may vary depending on the carbon:electrochemical modifier composition, as known in the art.
  • the composite material to be characterized is tested between upper and lower voltages of 1.0V and 10 mV at a current of 400 mA/g, after two formation cycles between 1.0V and 70 mV at a current of 200 mA/g, with respect to the mass of the composite material.
  • the composite materials are tested by limiting the capacity at a predefined value and measuring the stability and voltage fluctuations of the composite.
  • the first cycle efficiency of the composite anode material can be determined by comparing the lithium inserted into the anode during the first cycle to the lithium extracted from the anode on the first cycle (without any ex situ prelithiation).
  • the composite material can be prelithiated before the first cycle. This process of prelithiation as described in the art, may be conducted to increase the first cycle efficiency. When the insertion and extraction are equal, the efficiency is 100%.
  • the anode material can be tested in a half cell, where the counter electrode is lithium metal, the electrolyte is a 1M LiPF 6 1:1 ethylene carbonate: diethylcarbonate (EC:DEC), using a commercial polypropylene separator.
  • the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 10% and 99.9%. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 50% and 98%. In yet other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 80% and 95%. In still other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 85% and 90%. In another embodiment the first cycle efficiency is around 80%.
  • the third cycle efficiency of the composite material can be determined by comparing the lithium inserted into the anode during the third cycle to the lithium extraction from the anode on the third cycle in a half cell.
  • the third cycle efficiency is between 90% and 100%, 95% and 100%, 99% and 99.999%, 99.95% and 99.99%.
  • the composite material is used as anode material.
  • the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the carbon material component of the composite has a volumetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 400 mAh/cc when the carbon material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery.
  • the volumetric capacity of the carbon materials can be calculated from multiplying the maximum gravimetric capacity (mAh/g) with the pycnometer, skeletal density (g/cc).
  • the volumetric capacity is at least 450 mAh/cc.
  • the volumetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/cc.
  • the volumetric capacity is at least 550 mAh/cc.
  • the volumetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 650 mAh/cc, and in other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/cc. In another embodiment, the volumetric capacity of the carbon component of the composite ranges from 700 to 1100 mAh/cc.
  • the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the carbon material component has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 150 mAh/g when the carbon material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 200 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 300 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 400 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g, at least 800 mAh/g, at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g or even at least 1200 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity ranges from 1200 to 3500 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the carbon materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 550 mAh/g to about 750 mAh/g. Certain examples of any of the above carbons comprise an electrochemical modifier as described in more detail below.
  • the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 150 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 200 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 300 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 400 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g, at least 800 mAh/g, at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g or even at least 1200 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 1200 and 3500 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the composite materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 550 mAh/g to about 750 mAh/g.
  • the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 400 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 450 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 800 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g, at least 1200 mAh/g, at least 1300 mAh/g or even at least 1400 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 1400 and 4200 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the composite materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 1200 mAh/g to about 1600 mAh/g.
  • the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite has a volumetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 800 mAh/cc when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery.
  • the volumetric capacity of the composite materials can be calculated from multiplying the maximum gravimetric capacity (mAh/g) with the pycnometer, skeletal density (g/cc) prior to electrochemical testing.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 900 mAh/cc.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 1000 mAh/cc.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 1100 mAh/cc.
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 1200 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 1300 mAh/cc, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 1400 mAh/cc, at least 1500 mAh/cc, at least 1600 mAh/cc, at least 1700 mAh/cc, at least 1800 mAh/cc or even at least 1900 mAh/cc. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 2000 and 8000 mAh/cc. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 4000 and 7000 mAh/cc.
  • the composite materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 2500 mAh/cc to about 3500 mAh/cc.
  • the volumetric and gravimetric capacity can be determined through the use of any number of methods known in the art, for example by incorporating into an electrode half cell with lithium metal counter electrode in a coin cell.
  • the gravimetric specific capacity is determined by dividing the measured capacity by the mass of the electrochemically active carbon materials.
  • the volumetric specific capacity is determined by dividing the measured capacity by the volume of the electrode, including binder and conductivity additive. Methods for determining the volumetric and gravimetric capacity are described in more detail in the Examples.
  • the composite materials comprise lithium metal in some embodiments, either through doping or through electrochemical cycling, in the pores of the carbon component.
  • Lithium plating within pores is seen as beneficial to both the capacity and cycling stability of the hard carbon in some embodiments.
  • Plating within the pores can yield novel nanofiber lithium.
  • lithium is plated on the outside of the particle.
  • the present inventors believe external lithium plating is detrimental to the overall performance as explained in the examples.
  • the presence of both internal and external lithium metal may be measured by cutting a material using a focused ion beam (FIB) and a scanning electron microscope (SEM). Metallic lithium is easily detected in contrast to hard carbon in an SEM.
  • FIB focused ion beam
  • SEM scanning electron microscope
  • the carbon may be sliced and imaged.
  • the carbon displays lithium in the micropores.
  • the carbon displays lithium in the mesopores.
  • the carbon displays no lithium plating on the surface of the carbon.
  • carbon is stored in multiple pore sizes and shapes. The material shape and pore size distribution may uniquely and preferentially promote pore plating prior to surface plating. Ideal pore size for lithium storage is explained below.
  • the particle size distribution of the composite materials is believed to contribute to power performance and/or volumetric capacity. As the packing improves, the volumetric capacity will typically increase.
  • the particle size distributions are either Gaussian with a single peak in shape, bimodal, or polymodal (>2 distinct peaks).
  • the properties of particle size of the composite can be described by the DO (smallest particle in the distribution), D50 (average particle size) and D100 (maximum size of the largest particle).
  • DO lowest particle in the distribution
  • D50 average particle size
  • D100 maximum size of the largest particle.
  • the optimal combination of particle packing and performance will be some combination of the size ranges below.
  • the DO of the composite ranges from 1 nm to 5 microns. In another embodiment the DO of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 1 micron, 5 nm to 500 nm, 5 nm to 100 nm or 10 nm to 50 nm. In another embodiment the DO of the composite ranges from 500 to 2 microns, 750 nm to 1 micron or 1 microns to 2 microns. In still another embodiment, the DO of the composite ranges from 2 to 5 microns or even greater than 5 microns.
  • the D50 of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 20 microns. In another embodiment the D50 of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 1 micron, 5 nm to 500 nm, 5 nm to 100 nm or 10 nm to 50 nm. In another embodiment the D50 of the composite ranges from 500 to 2 microns, 750 nm to 1 micron or 1 microns to 2 microns. In still another embodiment, the D50 of the composite ranges from 2 to 20 microns, 3 microns to 10 microns, 4 microns to 8 microns or is greater than 20 microns.
  • the D100 of the composite ranges from 8 nm to 100 microns. In another embodiment the D100 of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 1 micron, 5 nm to 500 nm, 5 nm to 100 nm or 10 nm to 50 nm. In another embodiment the D100 of the composite ranges from 500 to 2 microns, 750 nm to 1 micron or 1 microns to 2 microns. In still another embodiment, the D100 of the composite ranges from 2 to 100 microns, 5 to 50 microns, 8 to 40 microns, 10 to 35 microns, 15 to 30 microns, 20 to 30 microns, about 25 microns or greater than 100 microns.
  • the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device the composite material has a volumetric capacity at least 10% greater than when the lithium based energy storage device comprises a graphite electrode.
  • the lithium based energy storage device is a lithium ion battery.
  • the composite material has a volumetric capacity in a lithium based energy storage device that is at least 5% greater, at least 10% greater or at least 15% greater than the volumetric capacity of the same electrical energy storage device having a graphite electrode.
  • the composite material has a volumetric capacity in a lithium based energy storage device that is at least 20% greater, at least 30% greater, at least 40% greater, at least 50% greater, at least 200% greater, at least 100% greater, at least 150% greater, or at least 200% greater than the volumetric capacity of the same electrical energy storage device having a graphite electrode.
  • the superior properties of the disclosed composite materials is related, at least in part, to its unique properties such as surface area, purity, pore structure, crystallinity and/or surface chemistry, etc.
  • the specific surface area (as measured by BET analysis or in other embodiments by using CO 2 absorption) of the composite materials may be low ( ⁇ 50 m 2 /g), medium (from about 50 m 2 /g to about 100 m 2 /g) or high (>100 m 2 /g) or have a surface area that spans one or more of these ranges.
  • the surface area ranges from about 0.1 m 2 /g to about 50 m 2 /g for example from about 1 m 2 /g to about 20 m 2 /g. In other particular embodiments, the surface area ranges from about 5 m 2 /g to about 10 m 2 /g for example the surface area may be about 8 m 2 /g.
  • the specific surface area of the composite materials is less than about 100 m 2 /g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 50 m 2 /g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 20 m 2 /g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 10 m 2 /g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 5 m 2 /g.
  • the surface area of the composite materials ranges from about 1 m 2 /g to about 50 m 2 /g. In some other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 20 m 2 /g to about 50 m 2 /g. In yet other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 1 m 2 /g to about 20 m 2 /g, for example from about 2 m 2 /g to about 15 m 2 /g. While not limiting in any way, some embodiments which comprise a surface area ranging from about 1 m 2 /g to about 20 m 2 /g for example from about 5 m 2 /g to about 10 m 2 /g have also been found to have good first cycle efficiency (e.g., >80%).
  • composite materials comprising medium surface area (from 50 to 100 m 2 /g). In some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 50 m 2 /g to about 75 m 2 /g. In some other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 50 m 2 /g to about 60 m 2 /g. In yet other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 60 m 2 /g to about 100 m 2 /g. In yet other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 60 m 2 /g to about 80 m 2 /g.
  • the composite materials comprise high surface area (>100 m 2 /g). In some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 100 m 2 /g to about 500 m 2 /g. In some other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 100 m 2 /g to about 200 m 2 /g.
  • the surface area of the composite may be modified through activation.
  • the activation method may use steam, chemical activation, CO 2 or other gasses. Methods for activation of carbon material are well known in the art.
  • the carbon material may be doped with lithium atoms, wherein the lithium is in ionic form and not in the form of lithium metal. These lithium atoms may or may not be able to be separated from the carbon.
  • the number of lithium atoms to 6 carbon atoms can be calculated by techniques known to those familiar with the art:
  • Q is the lithium extraction capacity measured in mAh/g between the voltages of 5 mV and 2.0V versus lithium metal
  • MM is 72 or the molecular mass of 6 carbons
  • F is Faraday's constant of 96500
  • C % is the mass percent carbon present in the structure as measured by CHNO or XPS.
  • the material can be characterized by the ratio of lithium atoms to carbon atoms (Li:C) which, in some embodiments, ranges from about 0:6 to about 2:6. In some embodiments the Li:C ratio ranges from about 0.05:6 to about 1.9:6. In other embodiments the maximum Li:C ratio wherein the lithium is in ionic and not metallic form is 2.2:6. In certain other embodiments, the Li:C ratio ranges from about 1.2:6 to about 2:6, from about 1.3:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.6:6 to about 1.8:6 or from about 1.7:6 to about 1.8:6.
  • Li:C ratio of lithium atoms to carbon atoms
  • the Li:C ratio is greater than 1:6, greater than 1.2:6, greater than 1.4:6, greater than 1.6:6 or even greater than 1.8:6. In even other embodiments, the Li:C ratio is about 1.4:6, about 1.5:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.7:6, about 1.8:6 or about 2:6. In a specific embodiment the Li:C ratio is about 1.78:6.
  • the carbon materials comprise an Li:C ratio ranging from about 1:6 to about 2.5:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 2.2:6 or from about 1.4:6 to about 2:6.
  • the carbon materials may not necessarily include lithium, but instead have a lithium uptake capacity (i.e., the capability to uptake a certain quantity of lithium). While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed the lithium uptake capacity of the carbon materials contributes to their superior performance in lithium based energy storage devices. The lithium uptake capacity is expressed as a ratio of the atoms of lithium taken up by the carbon per atom of carbon.
  • the carbon materials comprise a lithium uptake capacity ranging from about 1:6 to about 2.5:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 2.2:6 or from about 1.4:6 to about 2:6.
  • the lithium uptake capacity ranges from about 1.2:6 to about 2:6, from about 1.3:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.6:6 to about 1.8:6 or from about 1.7:6 to about 1.8:6. In other embodiments, the lithium uptake capacity is greater than 1:6, greater than 1.2:6, greater than 1.4:6, greater than 1.6:6 or even greater than 1.8:6. In even other embodiments, the Li:C ratio is about 1.4:6, about 1.5:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.7:6, about 1.8:6 or about 2:6. In a specific embodiment the Li:C ratio is about 1.78:6.
  • lithium may include chemical reactions, electrochemical reactions, physical mixing of particles, gas phase reactions, solid phase reactions, and liquid phase reactions.
  • the lithium is in the form of lithium metal.
  • the total pore volume of the carbon component of the composite may partially relate to the incorporation of large amounts of electrochemical modifier and hence the storage of lithium ions, the internal ionic kinetics, as well as the available composite/electrolyte surfaces capable of charge-transfer, this is one parameter that can be adjusted in the carbon prior to incorporation of electrochemical modifier to obtain the desired electrochemical properties in the final composite.
  • Some embodiments include composite materials having carbons with low total pore volume (e.g., less than about 0.1 cc/g). In one embodiment, the total pore volume of the carbon without the added electrochemical modifier is less than about 0.01 cc/g. In another embodiment, the total pore volume of the carbon without electrochemical modifier is less than about 0.001 cc/g. In yet another embodiment, the total pore volume of the carbon without electrochemical modifier is less than about 0.0001 cc/g.
  • the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.00001 cc/g to about 0.1 cc/g, for example from about 0.0001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g.
  • the composite materials comprise a total pore volume of greater than or equal to 0.1 cc/g, and in other embodiments the composite materials comprise a total pore volume less than or equal to 0.6 cc/g. In other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a total pore volume ranging from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.2 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.2 cc/g to about 0.3 cc/g.
  • the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.3 cc/g to about 0.4 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.4 cc/g to about 0.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.5 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g.
  • the present invention also includes composite materials having high total pore volume, for example greater than 0.6 cc/g.
  • the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 1.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 1.0 cc/g to about 1.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g.
  • the composite materials comprise a majority (e.g., >50%) of the total pore volume residing in pores of a certain diameter.
  • a majority e.g., >50% of the total pore volume residing in pores of a certain diameter.
  • greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 1 nm or less.
  • greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 100 nm or less.
  • greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 0.5 nm or less.
  • the tap density of the composite materials is predictive of their electrochemical performance, for example the volumetric capacity.
  • the pore volume of a composite material may be related to its tap density and composite s having low pore volume are sometimes found to have high tap density (and vice versa). Accordingly, composite materials having low tap density (e.g., ⁇ 0.3 g/cc), medium tap density (e.g., from 0.3 to 0.75 g/cc) or high tap density (e.g., >0.75 g/cc) are provided.
  • the composite materials comprise a tap density less than 0.3 g/cc. In yet some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.05 g/cc to about 0.25 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.1 g/cc to about 0.2 g/cc.
  • the composite materials comprise a tap density greater than or equal to 0.3 g/cc. In yet some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.3 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.35 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.30 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.40 g/cc to about 0.50 g/cc.
  • the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the composite materials comprise a medium total pore volume (e.g., from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g).
  • the composite materials comprise a tap density greater than about 0.5 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 2.0 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.75 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc, for example from about 0.75 g/cc to about 0.95 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the composite materials comprise a low, medium or high tap density.
  • the density of the composite materials can also be characterized by their skeletal density as measured by helium pycnometry.
  • the skeletal density of the composite materials ranges from about 1 g/cc to about 3 g/cc, for example from about 1.5 g/cc to about 2.3 g/cc.
  • the skeletal density ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 1.6 cc/g, from about 1.6 cc/g to about 1.7 cc/g, from about 1.7 cc/g to about 1.8 cc/g, from about 1.8 cc/g to about 1.9 cc/g, from about 1.9 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g, from about 2.0 cc/g to about 2.1 cc/g, from about 2.1 cc/g to about 2.2 cc/g or from about 2.2 cc/g to about 2.4 cc/g.
  • the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.00001 cc/g to about 0.1 cc/g, for example from about 0.0001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g.
  • the carbon component comprises a total pore volume ranging greater than or equal to 0.1 cc/g, and in other embodiments the carbon component comprises a total pore volume less than or equal to 0.6 cc/g. In other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a total pore volume ranging from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.2 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.2 cc/g to about 0.3 cc/g.
  • the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.3 cc/g to about 0.4 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.4 cc/g to about 0.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.5 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g.
  • the present invention also includes composites comprising carbon components having high total pore volume, for example greater than 0.6 cc/g.
  • the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 1.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 1.0 cc/g to about 1.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g.
  • the carbon component comprises a majority (e.g., >50%) of the total pore volume residing in pores of a certain diameter.
  • a majority e.g., >50% of the total pore volume residing in pores of a certain diameter.
  • greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 1 nm or less.
  • greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 100 nm or less.
  • greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 0.5 nm or less.
  • the tap density of the carbon component is predictive of its ability to incorporate electrochemical modifiers and hence electrochemical performance, for example the volumetric capacity.
  • the pore volume of a carbon component may be related to its tap density and carbon components having low pore volume are sometimes found to have high tap density (and vice versa). Accordingly, carbon components having low tap density (e.g., ⁇ 0.3 g/cc), medium tap density (e.g., from 0.3 to 0.5 g/cc) or high tap density (e.g., >0.5 g/cc) are provided as components of the composite.
  • the carbon component comprises a tap density greater than or equal to 0.3 g/cc. In yet some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.3 g/cc to about 0.5 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.35 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.30 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.40 g/cc to about 0.50 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the carbon component comprises a medium total pore volume (e.g., from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g).
  • the carbon component comprises a tap density greater than about 0.5 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 2.0 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.75 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc, for example from about 0.75 g/cc to about 0.95 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the carbon component comprises a low, medium or high total pore volume.
  • the skeletal density of the carbon component ranges from about 1 g/cc to about 3 g/cc, for example from about 1.5 g/cc to about 2.3 g/cc.
  • the skeletal density ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 1.6 cc/g, from about 1.6 cc/g to about 1.7 cc/g, from about 1.7 cc/g to about 1.8 cc/g, from about 1.8 cc/g to about 1.9 cc/g, from about 1.9 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g, from about 2.0 cc/g to about 2.1 cc/g, from about 2.1 cc/g to about 2.2 cc/g or from about 2.2 cc/g to about 2.3 cc/g.
  • the properties of the carbon component can easily be measured before incorporation of the electrochemical modifier.
  • the properties of the carbon component can also be measured by removal of the electrochemical modifier after the fact. In the case of silicon this can easily be accomplished by dissolving the silicon with a solvent that does not impact the carbon and then measuring the properties of the carbon without electrochemical modifier.
  • the surface functionality of the presently disclosed composite materials may be altered to obtain the desired electrochemical properties.
  • One property which can be predictive of surface functionality is the pH of the composite materials.
  • the presently disclosed composite materials comprise pH values ranging from less than 1 to about 14, for example less than 5, from 5 to 8 or greater than 8.
  • the pH of the composite materials is less than 4, less than 3, less than 2 or even less than 1.
  • the pH of the composite materials is between about 5 and 6, between about 6 and 7, between about 7 and 8 or between 8 and 9 or between 9 and 10.
  • the pH is high and the pH of the composite materials ranges is greater than 8, greater than 9, greater than 10, greater than 11, greater than 12, or even greater than 13.
  • Pore size distribution of the carbon component may, in some embodiments, contribute to both the storage capacity of the composite material and the kinetics and power capability of the system as well as the ability to incorporate large amounts of electrochemical modifiers.
  • the pore size distribution can range from micro to meso to macro (see e.g., FIG. 1 ) and may be either monomodal, bimodal or multimodal (i.e., may comprise one or more different distribution of pore sizes, see e.g., FIG. 3 ).
  • Micropores, with average pore sizes less than 1 nm, may create additional storage sites as well as lithium (or sodium) ion diffusion paths.
  • Graphite sheets typically are spaced 0.33 nm apart for lithium storage.
  • pores of similar size may yield graphite-like structures within pores with additional hard carbon-type storage in the bulk structure.
  • Mesopores are typically below 100 nm. These pores are ideal locations for nano particle dopants, such as metals, and provide pathways for both conductive additive and electrolyte for ion and electron conduction.
  • the carbon materials comprise macropores greater than 100 nm which may be especially suited for large particle doping.
  • Pore size distribution of the composite may be important to both the storage capacity of the material and the kinetics and power capability of the system as well as the ability to incorporate large amounts of electrochemical modifiers.
  • the pore size distribution can range from micro to meso to macro and may be either monomodal, bimodal or multimodal.
  • the composite materials comprise micropores less than 100 nm which may be especially suited for lithium diffusion.
  • the carbon material comprises a fractional pore volume of pores at or below 1 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore volume, at least 75% of the total pore volume, at least 90% of the total pore volume or at least 99% of the total pore volume.
  • the carbon material comprises a fractional pore volume of pores at or below 10 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore volume, at least 75% of the total pore volume, at least 90% of the total pore volume or at least 99% of the total pore volume.
  • the carbon material comprises a fractional pore volume of pores at or below 50 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore volume, at least 75% of the total pore volume, at least 90% of the total pore volume or at least 99% of the total pore volume.
  • the carbon material comprises a fractional pore surface area of pores at or below 100 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore surface area, at least 75% of the total pore surface area, at least 90% of the total pore surface area or at least 99% of the total pore surface area.
  • the carbon material comprises a fractional pore surface area of pores at or greater than 100 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore surface area, at least 75% of the total pore surface area, at least 90% of the total pore surface area or at least 99% of the total pore surface area.
  • the carbon material comprises pores predominantly in the range of 100 nm or lower, for example 10 nm or lower, for example 5 nm or lower.
  • the carbon material comprises micropores in the range of 0-2 nm and mesopores in the range of 2-100 nm.
  • the ratio of pore volume or pore surface in the micropore range compared to the mesopore range can be in the range of 95:5 to 5:95.
  • the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 0.5 to 1000 microns. In other embodiments the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 1 to 100 microns. Still in other embodiments the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 1 to 50 microns. Yet in other embodiments, the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 5 to 15 microns or from 1 to 5 microns. Still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter for the composite materials is about 10 microns. Still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter for the composite materials is less than 4, is less than 3, is less than 2, is less than 1 microns.
  • the composite materials exhibit a median particle diameter ranging from 1 micron to 5 microns. In other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 5 microns to 10 microns. In yet other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 10 nm to 20 microns. Still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 20 nm to 30 microns. Yet still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 30 microns to 40 microns. Yet still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 40 microns to 50 microns. In other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 50 microns to 100 microns. In other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges in the submicron range ⁇ 1 micron.
  • the carbon components are microporous (e.g., greater than 50% of pores less than 1 nm) and comprise monodisperse micropores.
  • the carbon components are microporous, and (Dv90 ⁇ Dv10)/Dv50, where Dv10, Dv50 and Dv90 refer to the pore size at 10%, 50% and 90% of the distribution by volume, is about 3 or less, typically about 2 or less, often about 1.5 or less.
  • the carbon components are mesoporous (e.g., greater than 50% of pores less than 100 nm) and comprise monodisperse mesopores.
  • the carbon components are mesoporous and (Dv90 ⁇ Dv10)/Dv50, where Dv10, Dv50 and Dv90 refer to the pore size at 10%, 50% and 90% of the distribution by volume, is about 3 or less, typically about 2 or less, often about 1.5 or less.
  • the carbon components are macroporous (e.g., greater than 50% of pores greater than 100 nm) and comprise monodisperse macropores.
  • the carbon components are macroporous and (Dv90 ⁇ Dv10)/Dv50, where Dv10, Dv50 and Dv90 refer to the pore size at 10%, 50% and 90% of the distribution by volume, is about 3 or less, typically about 2 or less, often about 1.5 or less.
  • the carbon components have a bimodal pore size distribution.
  • the carbon component comprise a population of micropores and a population of mesopores.
  • the ratio of micropores to mesopores ranges from about 1:10 to about 10:1, for example from about 1:3 to about 3:1.
  • the carbon component comprises pores having a peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranging from 0.1 nm to 0.25 nm. In other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.25 nm to 0.50 nm. Yet in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.75 nm to 1.0 nm. Still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.1 nm to 0.50 nm. Yet still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.50 nm to 1.0 nm.
  • the carbon component comprises pores having a peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranging from 2 nm to 10 nm. In other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 10 nm to 20 nm. Yet in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 20 nm to 30 nm. Still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 30 nm to 40 nm. Yet still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 40 nm to 50 nm. In other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 50 nm to 100 nm.
  • the present inventors believe that the extent of disorder in the carbon component and composite materials may have an impact on the electrochemical properties of the carbon materials.
  • Table 4 shows a possible trend between the available lithium sites for insertion and the range of disorder/crystallite size.
  • the present invention includes embodiments which comprise both high and low levels of disorder.
  • RAMAN spectroscopy is a measure of the size of the crystallites found within both amorphous and crystalline structures (M. A. Pimenta, G. Dresselhaus, M. S. Dresselhaus, L. G. Can ado, A. Jorio, and R. Saito, “Studying disorder in graphite-based systems by Raman spectroscopy,” Physical Chemistry Chemical Physics, vol. 9, no. 11, p. 1276, 2007).
  • RAMAN spectra of exemplary carbon are shown in FIG. 4 .
  • crystallite sizes (L a ) can be calculated from the relative peak intensities of the D and G Raman shifts (Eq 1)
  • R ranges from about 0 to about 1 or from about 0.50 to about 0.95.
  • R ranges from about 0.60 to about 0.90.
  • R ranges from about 0.80 to about 0.90.
  • L a also varies in certain embodiments and can range from about 1 nm to about 500 nm.
  • La ranges from about 5 nm to about 100 nm or from about 10 to about 50 nm. In other embodiments, La ranges from about 15 nm to about 30 nm, for example from about 20 to about 30 nm or from about 25 to 30 nm.
  • the electrochemical properties of the carbon component are related to the level of crystallinity as measured by X-ray diffraction (XRD). While Raman measures the size of the crystallites, XRD records the level of periodicity in the bulk structure through the scattering of incident X-rays (see e.g., FIG. 5 ).
  • the present invention includes composites comprising carbon materials that are non-graphitic (crystallinity ⁇ 10%) and semi-graphitic (crystallinity between 10 and 50%). The crystallinity of the carbon component ranges from about 0% to about 99%.
  • the carbon component comprises less than 10% crystallinity, less than 5% crystallinity or even less than 1% crystallinity (i.e., highly amorphous). In other embodiments, the carbon component comprises from 10% to 50% crystallinity. In still other embodiments, the carbon component comprises less than 50% crystallinity, less than 40% crystallinity, less than 30% crystallinity or even less than 20% crystallinity.
  • the electrochemical properties of the composite materials are related to the level of crystallinity as measured by X-ray diffraction (XRD).
  • the present invention includes composite materials that are non-crystalline (crystallinity ⁇ 10%) and semi-crystalline (crystallinity between 10 and 50%) and crystalline (>50%).
  • the crystallinity of the composite materials ranges from about 0% to about 99%.
  • the carbon materials without electrochemical modifier comprise less than 10% crystallinity, less than 5% crystallinity or even less than 1% crystallinity (i.e., highly amorphous).
  • the composite materials comprise from 10% to 50% crystallinity.
  • the composite materials comprise less than 50% crystallinity, less than 40% crystallinity, less than 30% crystallinity or even less than 20% crystallinity.
  • SAXS Small Angle X-ray Diffraction
  • the R factor has the ability to measure internal pores, perhaps inaccessible by gas adsorption techniques but capable of lithium storage.
  • the R factor is below 1, comprising single layers of graphene.
  • the R factor ranges from about 0.1 to about 20 or from about 1 to 10.
  • the R factor ranges from 1 to 5, from 1 to 2, or from 1.5 to 2.
  • the R factor ranges from 1.5 to 5, from 1.75 to 3, or from 2 to 2.5.
  • the R factor is greater than 10.
  • the SAXS pattern may also be analyzed by the number of peaks found between 10° and 40°. In some embodiments, the number of peaks found by SAXS at low scattering angles are 1, 2, 3, or even more than 3.
  • FIGS. 6 and 7 present representative SAXS plots.
  • the organic content of either the composite materials or the carbon materials can be manipulated to provide the desired properties, for example by contacting the materials with a hydrocarbon compound such as cyclohexane and the like.
  • Infra-red spectroscopy can be used as a metric to determine the organic content of both surface and bulk structures of the materials (see e.g., FIG. 8A ).
  • the carbon component comprises essentially no organic material.
  • An FTIR spectra which is essentially featureless is indicative of such embodiments (e.g., carbons B and D).
  • the carbon component comprises organic material, either on the surface or within the bulk structure. In such embodiments, the FTIR spectra generally depict large hills and valleys which indicates the presence of organic content.
  • the organic content may have a direct relationship to the electrochemical performance ( FIG. 8 b ) and response of the material when placed into a lithium bearing device for energy storage.
  • Carbon components with flat FTIR signals no organics
  • the extract voltage is typical of lithium stripping.
  • the carbon component comprises organic content and the lithium stripping plateau is absent or near absent.
  • the carbon component comprises varying amounts of carbon, oxygen, hydrogen and nitrogen as measured by gas chromatography CHNO analysis in various embodiments.
  • the carbon content is greater than 98 wt. % or even greater than 99.9 wt % as measured by CHNO analysis.
  • the carbon content ranges from about 10 wt % to about 99.9%, for example from about 50 to about 98 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges 90 to 98 wt. %, 92 to 98 wt % or greater than 95% of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges from 80 to 90 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges from 70 to 80 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges from 60 to 70 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the composite materials may also comprise varying amounts of carbon, oxygen, hydrogen and nitrogen as measured by gas chromatography CHNO analysis.
  • the carbon content of the composite is greater than 98 wt. % or even greater than 99.9 wt % as measured by CHNO analysis.
  • the carbon content of the composite ranges from about 10 wt % to about 99.9%, for example from about 50 to about 98 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content of the composite ranges 90 to 98 wt. %, 92 to 98 wt % or greater than 95% of the total mass.
  • the carbon content of the composite ranges from 80 to 90 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content of the composite ranges from 70 to 80 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 60 to 70 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 50 to 60 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 40 to 50 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 30 to 40 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 20 to 30 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 10 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 1 to 10 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the nitrogen content of the carbon component ranges from 0 to 90 wt. % based on total mass of all components in the carbon material as measured by CHNO analysis. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 10 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from 10 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from 20 to 30 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content is greater than 30 wt. %. In some more specific embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from about 1% to about 6%, while in other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from about 0.1% to about 1%. In certain of the above embodiments, the nitrogen content is based on weight relative to total weight of all components in the carbon material
  • the carbon and nitrogen content may also be measured as a ratio of C:N (carbon atoms to nitrogen atoms).
  • the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 0.001:1 or from 1:0.001 to 1:1.
  • the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 1:0.01.
  • the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.01 to 1:1.
  • the content of nitrogen exceeds the content of carbon, for example the C:N ratio can range from about 0.01:1 to about 0.1:1 or from 0.1:1 to about 0.5:1.
  • the composite materials may also comprise varying amounts of carbon, oxygen, nitrogen, Cl, and Na, to name a few, as measured by XPS analysis.
  • the carbon content is greater than 98 wt. % as measured by XPS analysis.
  • the carbon content ranges from 50 to 98 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges 90 to 98 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges from 80 to 90 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges from 70 to 80 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content ranges from 60 to 70 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the carbon content in the composite ranges from 10% to 99.9%, from 10% to 99%, from 10% to 98%, from 50% to 99.9%, from 50% to 99%, from 50% to 98%, from 75% to 99.9%, from 75% to 99% or from 75% to 98% of the total mass of all components in the carbon material as measured by XPS analysis
  • the nitrogen content in the composite ranges from 0 to 90 wt. % as measured by XPS analysis. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 75 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 50 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 25 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 10 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 6 wt. % of the total mass.
  • the nitrogen content ranges from 10 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from 20 to 30 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content is greater than 30 wt. %.
  • the carbon and nitrogen content may also be measured as a ratio of C:N by XPS.
  • the C:N ratio of the composite ranges from 0.001:1 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 0.01:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 0.1:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.1. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.2 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 1:1. In another embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 0.01. In yet another embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.01 to 1:1. In yet another embodiment, the content of nitrogen exceeds the content of carbon.
  • the carbon and phosphorus content of the composite may also be measured as a ratio of C:P by XPS.
  • the C:P ratio of the composite ranges from 0.001:1 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 0.01:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 0.1:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.1. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.2 to 1:0.01.
  • the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 1:1. In another embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 0.01. In yet another embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.01 to 1:1. In yet another embodiment, the content of nitrogen exceeds the content of carbon.
  • XPS may also be used to detect individual bonds between elements.
  • the interface between the carbon and the electrochemical modifier may include an C—X bond, wherein X is the primary element that alloys with lithium (such as C—Si bond for a silicon electrochemical modifier).
  • C—X may affect the performance of the material.
  • This percent of C—X bonds within a composite can be characterized using XPS.
  • the percent of C—X bonds as measured by XPS is between 0% and 50%.
  • the percent of C—X bonds is between 0% and 10%, 0% and 5%, 0% and 3%, 0% and 2%, 0% and 1%, 1% and 2%, between 10% and 50%, or greater than 50%.
  • the C—X bond also produces a material in-situ that is also capable of alloying electrochemically with silicon.
  • the carbon material can include both sp3 and sp2 hybridized carbons.
  • the percentage of sp2 hybridization can be measured by XPS using the Auger spectrum, as known in the art. It is assumed that for materials which are less than 100% sp2, the remainder of the bonds are sp3.
  • the carbon materials range from about 1% sp2 hybridization to 100% sp2 hybridization.
  • Other embodiments include carbon materials comprising from about 25% to about 95% sp2, from about 50%-95% sp2, from about 50% to about 75% sp2, from about 65% to about 95% sp2 or about 65% sp2.
  • the composite materials may also be created by incorporation of an electrochemical modifier selected to optimize the electrochemical performance of the non-modified carbon materials.
  • the electrochemical modifier may be incorporated within the pore structure and/or on the surface of the carbon material or incorporated in any number of other ways.
  • the composite materials comprise a coating of the electrochemical modifier (e.g., silicon or Al 2 O 3 ) on the surface of the carbon materials.
  • the composite materials comprise greater than about 100 ppm of an electrochemical modifier.
  • the electrochemical modifier is selected from iron, tin, silicon, nickel, aluminum and manganese.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises an element with the ability to lithiate from 3 to 0 V versus lithium metal (e.g. silicon, tin, sulfur).
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises metal oxides with the ability to lithiate from 3 to 0 V versus lithium metal (e.g. iron oxide, molybdenum oxide, titanium oxide).
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises elements which do not lithiate from 3 to 0 V versus lithium metal (e.g. aluminum, manganese, nickel, metal-phosphates).
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises a non-metal element (e.g. fluorine, nitrogen, hydrogen).
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises any of the foregoing electrochemical modifiers or any combination thereof (e.g. tin-silicon, nickel-titanium oxide).
  • the electrochemical modifier is an efficiency enhancer, such as phosphorous.
  • the composite comprises a lithium alloying element and an efficiency enhancer, such as phosphorous.
  • the electrochemical modifier may be provided in any number of forms.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises a salt.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises one or more elements in elemental form, for example elemental iron, tin, silicon, nickel or manganese.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises one or more elements in oxidized form, for example iron oxides, tin oxides, silicon oxides, nickel oxides, aluminum oxides or manganese oxides.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises iron. In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises tin. In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises silicon. In some other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises nickel. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises aluminum. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises manganese. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises Al 2 O 3 . In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises titanium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises titanium oxide. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises lithium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises sulfur. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises phosphorous. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises molybdenum.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises germanium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises arsenic. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises gallium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises phosphorous. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises selenium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises antimony. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises bismuth. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises tellurium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises indium.
  • the composite materials comprise a second carbon allotrope such as, but not limited to, graphite, amorphous carbon (soft and hard), diamond, C60, carbon nanotubes (e.g., single and/or multi-walled), graphene and carbon fibers.
  • the second carbon form is graphite.
  • the second form is soft carbon.
  • the ratio of carbon material (e.g., hard carbon) to second carbon allotrope can be tailored to fit any desired electrochemical application.
  • the second carbon allotrope is considered the electrochemical modifier of the hard carbon if and only if the second allotrope exhibits alloying behavior with lithium ions during an electrochemical reaction.
  • the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope in the composite materials ranges from about 0.01:1 to about 100:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:1 to about 10:1 or about 5:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:10 to about 10:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:5 to about 5:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:3 to about 3:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:2 to about 2:1.
  • a hard carbon can be blended with both graphite and soft carbon to change the density as well as the capacity or first cycle efficiency.
  • the three or more carbon allotropes will have a synergistic effect, creating a unique structure and performance.
  • the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes present in the composite material ranges from about 0.01:1 to about 100:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:1 to about 10:1 or about 5:1.
  • the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:10 to about 10:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:5 to about 5:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:3 to about 3:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:2 to about 2:1.
  • the electrochemical properties of the composite materials can be modified, at least in part, by the amount of the electrochemical modifier in the composite material.
  • the electrochemical modifier is an alloying material such as silicon, tin, indium, aluminum, germanium or gallium, for example silicon.
  • the composite material comprises at least 0.10%, at least 0.25%, at least 0.50%, at least 1.0%, at least 5.0%, at least 10%, at least 25%, at least 50%, at least 75%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 99% or at least 99.5% of the electrochemical modifier.
  • the composite materials comprise between 0.5% and 99.5% carbon and between 0.5% and 99.5% electrochemical modifier.
  • the composite material comprises 70%-99% silicon, for example between 75% and 95%, for example between 80% and 95%.
  • the percent of the electrochemical modifier is calculated on weight percent basis (wt %).
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises iron, tin, silicon, nickel and manganese.
  • the composite material comprises 70%-99% silicon, for example between 75% and 95%, for example between 80% and 95%.
  • the composite materials comprise carbon and silicon, wherein the silicon is present in about 1% to about 75% by weight of composite material.
  • the silicon content ranges from about 1% to about 10% or from about 3% to about 7%.
  • the silicon content ranges from about 40% to about 60%, for example about 45% to about 55%.
  • the composite materials comprise carbon and silicon, wherein the silicon is present in about 65% to about 85% by weight of composite material.
  • the silicon content ranges from about 70% to about 80% or from about 72% to about 78%.
  • the silicon content ranges from about 80% to about 95%, for example about 85% to about 95%.
  • the unmodified carbon materials have purities not previously obtained with hard carbon materials. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the high purity of the unmodified carbon materials contributes to the superior electrochemical properties of the same.
  • the unmodified carbon material comprises low total TXRF impurities (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier).
  • the total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of all other TXRF elements in the carbon material is less than 1000 ppm.
  • the total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of all other TXRF elements in the carbon material is less than 800 ppm, less than 500 ppm, less than 300 ppm, less than 200 ppm, less than 150 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 25 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • the carbon component may comprise high total carbon content.
  • the carbon material may also comprise oxygen, hydrogen, nitrogen and an optional electrochemical modifier.
  • the material comprises at least 75% carbon, 80% carbon, 85% carbon, at least 90% carbon, at least 95% carbon, at least 96% carbon, at least 97% carbon, at least 98% carbon or at least 99% carbon on a weight/weight basis.
  • the carbon material comprises less than 10% oxygen, less than 5% oxygen, less than 3.0% oxygen, less than 2.5% oxygen, less than 1% oxygen or less than 0.5% oxygen on a weight/weight basis.
  • the carbon material comprises less than 10% hydrogen, less than 5% hydrogen, less than 2.5% hydrogen, less than 1% hydrogen, less than 0.5% hydrogen or less than 0.1% hydrogen on a weight/weight basis. In other embodiments, the carbon material comprises less than 5% nitrogen, less than 2.5% nitrogen, less than 1% nitrogen, less than 0.5% nitrogen, less than 0.25% nitrogen or less than 0.01% nitrogen on a weight/weight basis.
  • the oxygen, hydrogen and nitrogen content of the disclosed carbon materials can be determined by combustion analysis. Techniques for determining elemental composition by combustion analysis are well known in the art.
  • the total ash content of an unmodified carbon material may, in some instances, have an effect on the electrochemical performance of a carbon material. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of the carbon material ranges from 0.1% to 0.001% weight percent ash, for example in some specific embodiments the ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of the carbon material is less than 0.1%, less than 0.08%, less than 0.05%, less than 0.03%, than 0.025%, less than 0.01%, less than 0.0075%, less than 0.005% or less than 0.001%.
  • the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 500 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.08%. In further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 300 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.05%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 200 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.05%.
  • the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 200 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.025%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 100 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.02%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 50 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.01%.
  • the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier, such as silicon) of greater than 500 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 0.08%. In further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 5000 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 0.5%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 1% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 0.5%.
  • the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 2% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 1%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 3% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 2%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 4% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 3%.
  • the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 5% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 4%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 6% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 5%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 7% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 6%.
  • the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 8% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 7%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 9% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 8%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 10% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 9%.
  • the amount of individual TXRF impurities present in the disclosed composite materials can be determined by total x-ray fluorescence. Individual TXRF impurities may contribute in different ways to the overall electrochemical performance of the disclosed composite materials.
  • the level of sodium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 500 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of magnesium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of aluminum present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of silicon present in the composite material is less than 500 ppm, less than 300 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of phosphorous present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of sulfur present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 30 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of chlorine present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of potassium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of calcium present in the composite material is less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of chromium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of iron present in the composite material is less than 50 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In other embodiments, the level of nickel present in the composite material is less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of copper present in the composite material is less than 140 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 40 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • the level of zinc present in the composite material is less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • the sum of all other TXRF impurities (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 500 pm, less than 300 ppm, less than 200 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 25 ppm, less than 10 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • other impurities such as hydrogen, oxygen and/or nitrogen may be present in levels ranging from less than 10% to less than 0.01%.
  • the composite material comprises undesired TXRF impurities near or below the detection limit of the proton induced x-ray emission analysis.
  • the unmodified composite material comprises less than 50 ppm sodium, less than 15 ppm magnesium, less than 10 ppm aluminum, less than 8 ppm silicon, less than 4 ppm phosphorous, less than 3 ppm sulfur, less than 3 ppm chlorine, less than 2 ppm potassium, less than 3 ppm calcium, less than 2 ppm scandium, less than 1 ppm titanium, less than 1 ppm vanadium, less than 0.5 ppm chromium, less than 0.5 ppm manganese, less than 0.5 ppm iron, less than 0.25 ppm cobalt, less than 0.25 ppm nickel, less than 0.25 ppm copper, less than 0.5 ppm zinc, less than 0.5 ppm gallium, less than 0.5 ppm germanium, less than 0.5 ppm arsenic,
  • the composite material comprises undesired TXRF impurities near or below the detection limit of the proton induced x-ray emission analysis.
  • the unmodified composite material comprises less than 100 ppm sodium, less than 300 ppm silicon, less than 50 ppm sulfur, less than 100 ppm calcium, less than 20 ppm iron, less than 10 ppm nickel, less than 140 ppm copper, less than 5 ppm chromium and less than 5 ppm zinc as measured by TXRF.
  • the composite material comprises less than 50 ppm sodium, less than 30 ppm sulfur, less than 100 ppm silicon, less than 50 ppm calcium, less than 10 ppm iron, less than 5 ppm nickel, less than 20 ppm copper, less than 2 ppm chromium and less than 2 ppm zinc.
  • the composite material comprises less than 50 ppm sodium, less than 50 ppm silicon, less than 30 ppm sulfur, less than 10 ppm calcium, less than 2 ppm iron, less than 1 ppm nickel, less than 1 ppm copper, less than 1 ppm chromium and less than 1 ppm zinc.
  • the composite material comprises less than 100 ppm sodium, less than 50 ppm magnesium, less than 50 ppm aluminum, less than 10 ppm sulfur, less than 10 ppm chlorine, less than 10 ppm potassium, less than 1 ppm chromium and less than 1 ppm manganese.
  • the impurity content is measured by PIXE, rather than TXRF.
  • the composite material comprises carbon and two or more different electrochemical modifiers.
  • the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and one or more electrochemical modifiers selected from: phosphorus, nitrogen, sulfur, boron and aluminum.
  • the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and 1-20% (by weight) of a Group 13 element or combinations thereof.
  • the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and 1-20% (by weight) of a Group 15 element, or combinations thereof.
  • the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and 1-20% (by weight) of lithium, sodium, or potassium, or combinations thereof.
  • the composite material may include various surface treatments or properties in order to further improve the electrochemical performance as defined by capacity, stability and/or power performance.
  • the composite e.g., the individual composite particles
  • the composite is covered by an ionically conductive polymer with a thickness ranging from about 1 nm to about 10 microns.
  • the composite is covered by a ceramic protective coating with a thickness ranging from about 1 nm to about 10 microns.
  • the composite is covered by an organic film with a thickness ranging from about 1 nm to about 10 microns. The thickness can be measured with a variety of techniques known in the art such as but not limited to XPS sputtering, FIB/SEM or SIMS.
  • any of the above described materials can be prepared via a variety of processes including sol gel, emulsion/suspension, solvent free (solid state, melt/liquid state, vapor state). Exemplary methods are described below.
  • the carbon component can be prepared by a method disclosed herein, for example, in some embodiments the carbon material is prepared by a method comprising pyrolyzing a polymer gel as disclosed herein.
  • the carbon materials may also be prepared by pryolyzing a substance such as chitosan.
  • the carbon materials can be prepared by any number of methods described in more detail below.
  • the composite may be formed through a gas phase deposition of an electrochemical modifier onto the carbon.
  • the composite may be synthesized through mechanical mixing or milling of two distinct solids.
  • Electrochemical modifiers can also be incorporated during the polymerization stage, into the polymer gel or into the pyrolyzed or activated carbon materials. Methods for preparation of carbon materials are described in more detail below.
  • Polymer gels are intermediates in the preparation of the disclosed composite materials. As such, the physical and chemical properties of the polymer gels contribute to, and are predictive of, the properties of the carbon materials. Polymer gels used for preparation of the composite materials are included within the scope of certain aspects of the present invention.
  • the carbon materials may synthesized through pyrolysis of either a single precursor (such as chitosan) or from a complex resin, formed using a sol-gel method using polymer precursors such as phenol, resorcinol, urea, melamine, etc. in water, ethanol, methanol, etc. with formaldehyde.
  • the resin may be acid or basic, and possibly contain a catalyst.
  • the pyrolysis temperature and dwell time may be optimized as described below.
  • the methods comprise preparation of a polymer gel by a sol gel process, condensation process or crosslinking process involving monomer precursor(s) and a crosslinking agent, two existing polymers and a crosslinking agent or a single polymer and a crosslinking agent, followed by pyrolysis of the polymer gel.
  • the polymer gel may be dried (e.g., freeze dried) prior to pyrolysis; however drying is not required and in some embodiments is not desired.
  • the sol gel process provides significant flexibility such that an electrochemical modifier can be incorporated at any number of steps.
  • a method for preparing a polymer gel comprising an electrochemical modifier is provided.
  • methods for preparing pyrolyzed polymer gels are provided. Details of the variable process parameters of the various embodiments of the disclosed methods are described below.
  • the target carbon properties can be derived from a variety of polymer chemistries provided the polymerization reaction produces a resin/polymer with the necessary carbon backbone.
  • Different polymer families include novolacs, resoles, acrylates, styrenics, ureathanes, rubbers (neoprenes, styrene-butadienes, etc.), nylons, etc.
  • the preparation of any of these polymer resins can occur via a number of different processes including sol gel, emulsion/suspension, solid state, solution state, melt state, etc. for either polymerization and crosslinking processes.
  • the polymer gels may be prepared by a sol gel process.
  • the polymer gel may be prepared by co-polymerizing one or more polymer precursors in an appropriate solvent.
  • the one or more polymer precursors are copolymerized under acidic conditions.
  • a first polymer precursor is a phenolic compound and a second polymer precursor is an aldehyde compound.
  • the phenolic compound is phenol, resorcinol, catechol, hydroquinone, phloroglucinol, or a combination thereof and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde, acetaldehyde, propionaldehyde, butyraldehyde, benzaldehyde, cinnamaldehyde, or a combination thereof.
  • the phenolic compound is resorcinol, phenol or a combination thereof, and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde.
  • the phenolic compound is resorcinol and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde.
  • polymer precursors include nitrogen containing compounds such as melamine, urea and ammonia.
  • the precursors include silicon containing compounds such as silanes (silane, dimethyl silane, diethylsilane, chlorosilane, chloromethyl silane, chloroethyl silane, dichloro silane, dichlorodimethyl silane, dichlorodiethyl silane, diphenylsilane, tristrimethylsilyl silane) siloxane, silica, silicon carbide.
  • silanes silane, dimethyl silane, diethylsilane, chlorosilane, chloromethyl silane, chloroethyl silane, dichloro silane, dichlorodimethyl silane, dichlorodiethyl silane, diphenylsilane, tristrimethylsilyl silane
  • the electrochemical modifier is incorporated as a metal salt into the mixture from which the gel resin is produced.
  • the metal salt dissolved into the mixture from which the gel resin is produced is soluble in the reaction mixture.
  • the mixture from which the gel resin is produced may contain an acid and/or alcohol which improves the solubility of the metal salt.
  • the metal-containing polymer gel can be optionally freeze dried, followed by pyrolysis. Alternatively, the metal-containing polymer gel is not freeze dried prior to pyrolysis.
  • the electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the material as a polymer.
  • the organic or carbon containing polymer RF (resorcinol-formaldehyde) for example, is copolymerized with the polymer, which contains the electrochemical modifier.
  • the electrochemical modifier-containing polymer contains silicon.
  • the polymer is tetraethylorthosiliane (TEOS).
  • TEOS tetraethylorthosiliane
  • a TEOS solution is added to the RF solution prior to or during polymerization.
  • the polymer is a polysilane with organic side groups.
  • these side groups are methyl groups, in other cases these groups are phenyl groups, in other cases the side chains include phenyl, pyrrole, acetate, vinyl, siloxane fragments.
  • the side chain includes a group 14 element (silicon, germanium, tin or lead).
  • the side chain includes a group 13 element (boron, aluminum, boron, gallium, indium).
  • the side chain includes a group 15 element (nitrogen, phosphorous, arsenic).
  • the side chain includes a group 16 element (oxygen, sulfur, selenium).
  • the electrochemical modifier is a silole. In some cases it is a phenol-silole or a silafluorene. In other cases it is a poly-silole or a poly-silafluorene. In some cases the silicon is replaced with germanium (germole or germafluorene), tin (stannole or stannaflourene) nitrogen (carbazole) or phosphorous (phosphole, phosphafluorene). In all cases the heteroatom containing material can be a small molecule, an oligomer or a polymer. Phosphorous atoms may or may not be also bonded to oxygen.
  • the heteroatom containing polymer is a physical mixture with the carbon polymer. In another case it is a copolymer. In another case a block or multi-block copolymer. In other cases it is in the polymer side chain, main chain or a small molecule used to crosslink the carbon polymers.
  • Heteroatoms include but are not limited to Group 14 elements (Si, Ge, Sn, Pb), Group 15 elements (N, P, As, Sb), Group 16 elements (O, S, Se, Te).
  • the electrochemical modifier is a silicon dendrimer. In one case it is a first generation dendrimer. In another case it is a higher generation dendrimer.
  • the polymer and dendrimer form a mixture.
  • the dendrimer is covalently bonded to the polymer. In other embodiments the dendrimer is ionically bonded to the polymer.
  • the polymerization reaction contains phosphorous.
  • the phosphorus is in the form of phosphoric acid.
  • the phosphorus can be in the form of a salt, wherein the anion of the salt comprises one or more phosphate, phosphite, phosphide, hydrogen phosphate, dihydrogen phosphate, hexafluorophosphate, hypophosphite, polyphosphate, or pyrophosphate ions, or combinations thereof.
  • the phosphorus can be in the form of a salt, wherein the cation of the salt comprises one or more phosphonium ions.
  • non-phosphate containing anion or cation pair for any of the above embodiments can be chosen for those known and described in the art.
  • exemplary cations to pair with phosphate-containing anions include, but are not limited to, ammonium, tetraethylammonium, and tetramethylammonium ions.
  • exemplary anions to pair with phosphate-containing cations include, but are not limited to, carbonate, dicarbonate, and acetate ions.
  • crosslinker is important because of its chemical and electrochemical properties. In other cases the crosslinker is important because it locks in the polymer geometry. In other cases both polymer geometry and chemical composition are important.
  • the crosslinker can react at either low or high temperatures. In some cases a portion of the reaction will occur at low temperatures with the rest of the reaction occurring at higher temperatures. Both extent of crosslinking and reaction kinetics can be measured by a variety of chemical techniques (TGA, FTIR, NMR, XRD, etc.) and physical techniques (indentation, tensile testing, modulus, hardness, etc.).
  • the structure of the polymer precursors is not particularly limited, provided that the polymer precursor is capable of reacting with another polymer precursor or with a second polymer precursor to form a polymer.
  • Polymer precursors include, but are not limited to, amine-containing compounds, alcohol-containing compounds and carbonyl-containing compounds.
  • the polymer precursors are selected from an alcohol, a phenol, a polyalcohol, a sugar, an alkyl amine, an aromatic amine, an aldehyde, a ketone, a carboxylic acid, an ester, a urea, an acid halide, an alkene, an alkyne, an acrylate, an epoxide and an isocyanate.
  • Various monomers, molecular components, oligomers and polymeric materials may be combined to make a variety of polymers including, novolacs, resoles, novolac epoxides (comprised of one or more of phenol, resorcinol, formaldehyde, epichlorohydrin, bisphenol-A, bisphenol-F, epoxide), rubbers (isoprene, styrene-butadiene, styrene-butadiene-styrene, isobutylene, polyacrylate rubber, ethylenene-acrylate rubber, bromo-isobutylene, isoprene, polybutadiene, chloro isobutadiene isoprene, polychloroprene, epichlorohydrin, ethylene propylene, ethylene propylene diene monomer, polyether urethane, perfluorocarbon rubber, fluorosilicone, hydrogenated nitrile buta
  • the polymer precursor materials include (a) alcohols, phenolic compounds, and other mono- or polyhydroxy compounds and (b) aldehydes, ketones, and combinations thereof.
  • Representative alcohols in this context include straight chain and branched, saturated and unsaturated alcohols.
  • Suitable phenolic compounds include polyhydroxy benzene, such as a dihydroxy or trihydroxy benzene.
  • Representative polyhydroxy benzenes include resorcinol (i.e., 1,3-dihydroxy benzene), catechol, hydroquinone, and phloroglucinol. Mixtures of two or more polyhydroxy benzenes can also be used. Phenol (monohydroxy benzene) can also be used.
  • Representative polyhydroxy compounds include sugars, such as glucose, and other polyols, such as mannitol.
  • Aldehydes in this context include: straight chain saturated aldehydes such as methanal (formaldehyde), ethanal (acetaldehyde), propanal (propionaldehyde), butanal (butyraldehyde), and the like; straight chain unsaturated aldehydes such as ethenone and other ketenes, 2-propenal (acrylaldehyde), 2-butenal (crotonaldehyde), 3 butenal, and the like; branched saturated and unsaturated aldehydes; and aromatic-type aldehydes such as benzaldehyde, salicylaldehyde, hydrocinnamaldehyde, and the like.
  • Suitable ketones include: straight chain saturated ketones such as propanone and 2 butanone, and the like; straight chain unsaturated ketones such as propenone, 2 butenone, and 3-butenone (methyl vinyl ketone) and the like; branched saturated and unsaturated ketones; and aromatic-type ketones such as methyl benzyl ketone (phenylacetone), ethyl benzyl ketone, and the like.
  • the polymer precursor materials can also be combinations of the precursors described above.
  • the method comprises use of a first and second polymer precursor, and in some embodiments the first or second polymer precursor is a carbonyl containing compound and the other of the first or second polymer precursor is an alcohol containing compound.
  • a first polymer precursor is a phenolic compound and a second polymer precursor is an aldehyde compound (e.g., formaldehyde).
  • the phenolic compound is phenol, resorcinol, catechol, hydroquinone, phloroglucinol, or a combination thereof; and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde, acetaldehyde, propionaldehyde, butyraldehyde, benzaldehyde, cinnamaldehyde, or a combination thereof.
  • the phenolic compound is resorcinol, phenol or a combination thereof, and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde.
  • the phenolic compound is resorcinol and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde.
  • the polymer precursors are alcohols and carbonyl compounds (e.g., resorcinol and aldehyde) and they are present in a ratio of about 0.5:1.0, respectively.
  • one polymer precursor is an alcohol-containing species and another polymer precursor is a carbonyl-containing species.
  • the relative amounts of alcohol-containing species e.g., alcohols, phenolic compounds and mono- or poly-hydroxy compounds or combinations thereof
  • the carbonyl containing species e.g. aldehydes, ketones or combinations thereof
  • the ratio of alcohol-containing species to aldehyde species is selected so that the total moles of reactive alcohol groups in the alcohol-containing species is approximately the same as the total moles of reactive carbonyl groups in the aldehyde species.
  • the ratio of alcohol-containing species to ketone species may be selected so that the total moles of reactive alcohol groups in the alcohol containing species is approximately the same as the total moles of reactive carbonyl groups in the ketone species.
  • the same general 1:1 molar ratio holds true when the carbonyl-containing species comprises a combination of an aldehyde species and a ketone species.
  • the polymer precursor is a urea or an amine containing compound.
  • the polymer precursor is urea or melamine.
  • Other embodiments include polymer precursors selected from isocyanates or other activated carbonyl compounds such as acid halides and the like.
  • the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 5:1 to about 2000:1 or the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 20:1 to about 200:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 25:1 to about 100:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 5:1 to about 10:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 100:1 to about 5:1.
  • the resorcinol to catalyst ratio can be varied to obtain the desired properties of the resultant polymer gel and carbon materials.
  • the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 10:1 to about 2000:1 or the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 20:1 to about 200:1.
  • the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 25:1 to about 100:1.
  • the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 5:1 to about 10:1.
  • the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 100:1 to about 5:1.
  • the total solids content in the solution or suspension prior to polymer gel formation can be varied.
  • the weight ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.05 to 1 to about 0.70 to 1.
  • the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.15 to 1 to about 0.6 to 1.
  • the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.15 to 1 to about 0.35 to 1.
  • the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.25 to 1 to about 0.5 to 1.
  • the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.3 to 1 to about 0.35 to 0.6.
  • solvents useful in the preparation of the polymer gels disclosed herein include but are not limited to water or alcohols such as, for example, ethanol, t butanol, methanol or combinations thereof as well as aqueous mixtures of the same. Such solvents are useful for dissolution of the polymer precursor materials, for example dissolution of the phenolic compound.
  • solvents are employed for solvent exchange in the polymer gel (prior to freezing and drying), wherein the solvent from the polymerization of the precursors, for example, resorcinol and formaldehyde, is exchanged for a pure alcohol.
  • a polymer gel is prepared by a process that does not include solvent exchange.
  • Suitable catalysts in the preparation of the polymer gels include volatile basic catalysts that facilitate polymerization of the precursor materials into a monolithic polymer.
  • the catalyst can also comprise various combinations of the catalysts described above.
  • such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 200:1 phenolic compound:catalyst.
  • such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 10:1 phenolic compound:catalyst.
  • the gel polymerization process is performed under catalytic conditions. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the method comprises admixing a catalyst with the solvent-free mixture. In some embodiments, the catalyst is a solid at room temperature and pressure.
  • the catalyst is a liquid at room temperature and pressure. In some embodiments, the catalyst is a liquid at room temperature and pressure that does not provide dissolution of one or more of the other polymer precursors.
  • the catalyst comprises a basic volatile catalyst.
  • the basic volatile catalyst comprises ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium acetate, ammonium hydroxide, or combinations thereof.
  • the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium carbonate.
  • the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium acetate.
  • the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor may have an effect on the final properties of the polymer gel as well as the final properties of the carbon materials.
  • such catalysts are used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 2000:1 polymer precursor:catalyst.
  • such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 10:1 to 400:1 polymer precursor:catalyst.
  • such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 100:1 polymer precursor:catalyst.
  • the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 400:1.
  • the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 100:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 50:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 10:1.
  • the polymer precursor is a phenolic compound such as resorcinol or phenol.
  • the method comprises admixing an acid with the solvent-free mixture.
  • the acid is a solid at room temperature and pressure.
  • the acid is a liquid at room temperature and pressure.
  • the acid is a liquid at room temperature and pressure that does not provide dissolution of one or more of the other polymer precursors.
  • the acid may be selected from any number of acids suitable for the polymerization process.
  • the acid is acetic acid and in other embodiments the acid is oxalic acid.
  • the acid is mixed with the first or second solvent in a ratio of acid to solvent of 99:1, 90:10, 75:25, 50:50, 25:75, 20:80, 10:90 or 1:90.
  • the acid is acetic acid and the first or second solvent is water.
  • acidity is provided by adding a solid acid.
  • the total content of acid in the mixture can be varied to alter the properties of the final product.
  • the acid is present from about 1% to about 50% by weight of mixture. In other embodiments, the acid is present from about 5% to about 25%. In other embodiments, the acid is present from about 10% to about 20%, for example about 10%, about 15% or about 20%.
  • the polymer precursor components are blended together and subsequently held for a time and at a temperature sufficient to achieve polymerization.
  • One or more of the polymer precursor components can have particle size less than about 20 mm in size, for example less than 10 mm, for example less than 7 mm, for example, less than 5 mm, for example less than 2 mm, for example less than 1 mm, for example less than 100 microns, for example less than 10 microns.
  • the particle size of one or more of the polymer precursor components is reduced during the blending process.
  • the blending of one or more polymer precursor components in the absence of solvent can be accomplished by methods described in the art, for example ball milling, jet milling, Fritsch milling, planetary mixing, and other mixing methodologies for mixing or blending solid particles while controlling the process conditions (e.g., temperature).
  • the mixing or blending process can be accomplish before, during, and/or after (or combinations thereof) incubation at the reaction temperature.
  • Reaction parameters include aging the blended mixture at a temperature and for a time sufficient for the one or more polymer precursors to react with each other and form a polymer.
  • suitable aging temperature ranges from about room temperature to temperatures at or near the melting point of one or more of the polymer precursors.
  • suitable aging temperature ranges from about room temperature to temperatures at or near the glass transition temperature of one or more of the polymer precursors.
  • the solvent free mixture is aged at temperatures from about 20° C. to about 600° C., for example about 20° C. to about 500° C., for example about 20° C. to about 400° C., for example about 20° C. to about 300° C., for example about 20° C. to about 200° C.
  • the solvent free mixture is aged at temperatures from about 50 to about 250° C.
  • the reaction duration is generally sufficient to allow the polymer precursors to react and form a polymer, for example the mixture may be aged anywhere from 1 hour to 48 hours, or more or less depending on the desired result.
  • Typical embodiments include aging for a period of time ranging from about 2 hours to about 48 hours, for example in some embodiments aging comprises about 12 hours and in other embodiments aging comprises about 4-8 hours (e.g., about 6 hours).
  • an electrochemical modifier is incorporated during the above described polymerization process.
  • an electrochemical modifier in the form of metal particles, metal paste, metal salt, metal oxide or molten metal can be dissolved or suspended into the mixture from which the gel resin is produced
  • Exemplary electrochemical modifiers for producing the composite materials may fall into one or more than one of the chemical classifications listed in Table 1.
  • Electrochemical modifiers can be combined with a variety of polymer systems through either physical mixing or chemical reactions with latent (or secondary) polymer functionality.
  • latent polymer functionality include, but are not limited to, epoxide groups, unsaturation (double and triple bonds), acid groups, alcohol groups, amine groups, basic groups.
  • Crosslinking with latent functionality can occur via heteroatoms (e.g. vulcanization with sulfur, acid/base/ring opening reactions with phosphoric acid), reactions with organic acids or bases (described above), coordination to transition metals (including but not limited to Ti, Cr, Mn, Fe, Co, Ni, Cu, Zn, Zr, Nb, Mo, Ag, Au), ring opening or ring closing reactions (rotaxanes, spiro compounds, etc.).
  • Polymerization to form a polymer gel can be accomplished by various means described in the art and may include addition of an electrochemical modifier.
  • polymerization can be accomplished by incubating suitable polymer precursor materials, and optionally an electrochemical modifier, in the presence of a suitable catalyst for a sufficient period of time.
  • the time for polymerization can be a period ranging from minutes or hours to days, depending on the temperature (the higher the temperature the faster, the reaction rate, and correspondingly, the shorter the time required).
  • the polymerization temperature can range from room temperature to a temperature approaching (but lower than) the boiling point of the starting solution.
  • the polymer gel is aged at temperatures from about 20° C. to about 120° C., for example about 20° C. to about 100° C.
  • Other embodiments include temperature ranging from about 30° C. to about 90° C., for example about 45° C. or about 85° C. In other embodiments, the temperature ranges from about 65° C. to about 80° C., while other embodiments include aging at two or more temperatures, for example about 45° C. and about 75-85° C. or about 80-85° C.
  • Electrochemical modifiers can also be added to the polymer system through physical blending.
  • Physical blending can include but is not limited to melt blending of polymers and/or co-polymers, the inclusion of discrete particles, chemical vapor deposition of the electrochemical modifier and coprecipitation of the electrochemical modifier and the main polymer material.
  • the electrochemical modifier is a particle.
  • the particles of electrochemical modifier can be added with differing particle size distributions.
  • the electrochemical modifier particles have a D50 of 10 nm or 50 nm or 100 nm or 150 nm or 200 nm or 500 nm or 1 um or 1.5 um or 2 um or 3 um or 5 um or 10 um or 20 um or 40 um or up to 50 um, or up to 100 um.
  • the polymer and particle form a mixture.
  • the particle is covalently bonded to the polymer.
  • the particle is ionically bonded to the polymer.
  • the particle is silicon, in other cases the particles are a different Group 14 elements (Ge, Sn, Pb), Group 15 elements (P, As, Sb), Group 16 elements (S, Se, Te). In some cases the particle is comprised of a single element, in other cases it is comprised of a mixture of two or more elements.
  • Electrochemical modifier particles can be dispersed in the organic polymer solution or pre-polymer in a variety of ways.
  • the particles are dispersed by sonication.
  • the particles are dispersed by mixing.
  • the particles are dispersed by modifying the surface chemistry of the particles or the pH of the solution.
  • the particles are dispersed by use of a surfactant.
  • the surfactant is SPAN 80.
  • the particles are dispersed in an emulsion or suspension.
  • the surfactant is used in combination with a hydrocarbon solvent.
  • the hydrocarbon is cyclohexane.
  • the hydrocarbon is mineral oil.
  • the hydrocarbon is vegetable oil.
  • the electrochemical modifier can be added via a metal salt solution.
  • the metal salt solution or suspension may comprise acids and/or alcohols to improve solubility of the metal salt.
  • the polymer gel (either before or after an optional drying step) is contacted with a paste comprising the electrochemical modifier.
  • the polymer gel is contacted with a metal or metal oxide sol comprising the desired electrochemical modifier.
  • the composite materials may comprise one or more additional forms (i.e., allotropes) of carbon.
  • allotropes such as graphite, amorphous carbon, diamond, C60, carbon nanotubes (e.g., single and/or multi-walled), graphene and/or carbon fibers into the composite materials is effective to optimize the electrochemical properties of the composite materials in certain embodiments.
  • the various allotropes of carbon can be incorporated into the carbon materials during any stage of the preparation process described herein. For example, during the solution phase, during the gelation phase, during the curing phase, during the pyrolysis phase, during the milling phase, or after milling.
  • the second carbon form is incorporated into the composite material by adding the second carbon form before or during polymerization of the polymer gel as described in more detail herein.
  • the polymerized polymer gel containing the second carbon form is then processed according to the general techniques described herein to obtain a carbon material containing a second allotrope of carbon.
  • the organic polymer and the electrochemical modifier have different solvents, ratios of solvents, mixtures of solvents, catalysts type, catalyst ratios, solvent pH, type of acid, or base.
  • the electrochemical modifier content of the final composite can be varied.
  • the solids concentration of the organic polymer solution can be varied between 1% to 99% solids or from 10% to 90% solids, or from 20% to 80% solids or from 20% to 50% or from 30% to 40% solids.
  • the solids concentration of the polymer solution is 35%.
  • the solids concentration of the electrochemical modifier polymer solution can be varied between 1% to 99% solids or from 10% to 90% solids, or from 20% to 80% solids or from 20% to 50% or from 30% to 40% solids.
  • the solids concentration of the electrochemical modifier solution is 35%.
  • the electrochemical modifier is a TEOS polymer is mixed with ethanol. In other embodiments, the TEOS polymer is mixed with acetone, or isopropyl alcohol.
  • ratio of organic polymer to electrochemical modifier polymer solutions in any given mixture may alter the final ratio of the carbon to electrochemical modifier in the final composite.
  • the ratio of organic polymer to electrochemical modifier polymer is about 10:1 or 9:1 or 8:1 or 7:1 or 6:1 or 5:1 or 4:1 or 3:1 or 2:1, or 1:1, or 1:2, or 1:3 or 1:4 or 1:5, or 1:6 or 1:7 or 1:8 or 1:9 or 1:10.
  • the organic polymer/electrochemical modifier polymer solution is heated until a gel is formed.
  • a TEOS/RF solution is heated until a gel is formed.
  • the heating is carried out in a sealed container.
  • the heating is carried out in a polymer reactor.
  • the solution is heated in an emulsion, or in an inverse emulsion or in a suspension. The temperature at which gelation takes place is known to impact the structure of the polymer and can be modified to control the structure of the final composite material.
  • the gel is formed at 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C or 110 C or 120 C or 130 C.
  • the gel is formed in a two-step reaction. For example one temperature to cause the organic polymer to gel and a different temperature to cause the electrochemical modifier polymer to gel.
  • the two step polymerization is carried out at 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C or 110 C or 120 C or 130 C and then the second step is carried out at 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C or 110 C or 120 C or 130 C.
  • the organic polymer is fully gelled and then a electrochemical modifier polymer solution is added through a solvent exchange to dope the organic polymer.
  • the electrochemical modifier polymer is fully gelled and then an organic polymer solution is added through a solvent exchange to dope the electrochemical modifier polymer.
  • an optional electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the polymer gel after the polymerization step, for example either before or after an optional drying and before pyrolyzing polymer gel.
  • the polymer gel (either before or after and optional drying and prior to pyrolysis) is impregnated with electrochemical modifier by immersion in a metal salt solution or suspension or particles.
  • the particle comprises micronized silicon powder.
  • the particles are comprised of nanoparticles of silicon.
  • the particles are comprised of nanotubes of silicon.
  • the particles are comprised of polycrystalline silicon.
  • the particles are comprised of nanocrystalline silicon.
  • the particles are comprised of amorphous silicon.
  • the particles are comprised of porous silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of silicyne. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of black silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprise a mixture of two or more different forms of silicon as exemplified above.
  • the particle is tin. In still other embodiments, the particle is a combination of silicon, tin, carbon, or any oxides.
  • Particles of electrochemical modifier can be added in different ratios to alter the electrochemical performance of the final composite.
  • the electrochemical modifier can be added to create a specific ratio of carbon to electrochemical modifier after the polymer has been pyrolyzed and this ratio can range from 10:1-1:10. In one embodiment this ratio is 10:1 or 9:1 or 8:1 or 7:1 or 6:1 or 5:1 or 4:1 or 3:1 or 2:1, or 1:1, or 1:2, or 1:3 or 1:4 or 1:5, or 1:6 or 1:7 or 1:8 or 1:9 or 1:10.
  • the particles of electrochemical modifier can be added with differing particle size distributions.
  • the electrochemical modifier particles have a D50 of 10 nm or 50 nm or 100 nm or 150 nm or 200 nm or 500 nm or 1 um or 1.5 um or 2 um or 3 um or 5 um or 10 um.
  • the electrochemical modifier is added prior to polymerization of the polymer solution.
  • the electrochemical modifier is added at a point where the polymer solution is pre-polymerized or partially polymerized by heating to an elevated temperature such as 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C to create a partially cross linked network.
  • the sol gel polymerization process is generally performed under catalytic conditions. Accordingly, in some embodiments, preparing the polymer gel comprises co-polymerizing one or more polymer precursors in the presence of a catalyst.
  • the catalyst comprises a basic volatile catalyst.
  • the basic volatile catalyst comprises ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium acetate, ammonium hydroxide, or combinations thereof.
  • the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium carbonate.
  • the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium acetate.
  • the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor may have an effect on the final properties of the polymer gel as well as the final properties of the carbon materials.
  • catalysts are used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 2000:1 polymer precursor compound:catalyst.
  • catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 10:1 to 400:1 polymer precursor compound:catalyst.
  • such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 100:1 polymer precursor compound:catalyst.
  • the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 400:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 100:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 50:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 10:1.
  • the reaction solvent is another process parameter that may be varied to obtain the desired properties (e.g., surface area, porosity, purity, etc.) of the polymer gels and composite materials.
  • the solvent for preparation of the polymer gel is a mixed solvent system of water and a miscible co-solvent.
  • the solvent comprises a water miscible acid.
  • water miscible acids include, but are not limited to, propionic acid, acetic acid, and formic acid.
  • the solvent comprises a ratio of water-miscible acid to water of 99:1, 90:10, 75:25, 50:50, 25:75, 10:90 or 1:90.
  • acidity is provided by adding a solid acid to the reaction solvent.
  • the solvent for preparation of the polymer gel is acidic.
  • the solvent comprises acetic acid.
  • the solvent is 100% acetic acid.
  • a mixed solvent system is provided, wherein one of the solvents is acidic.
  • the solvent is a binary solvent comprising acetic acid and water.
  • the solvent comprises a ratio of acetic acid to water of 99:1, 90:10, 75:25, 50:50, 25:75, 20:80, 10:90 or 1:90.
  • acidity is provided by adding a solid acid to the reaction solvent.
  • One embodiment of the present disclosure is a method for preparing polymer materials following a polymerization process in the absence of solvent.
  • the method comprises heating polymer gel particles that were formed in absence of solvent to obtain a carbon material, wherein the polymer has been prepared by a process comprising:
  • the solvent can be present at a level of less than 80% of the total mass of polymer to be processed into carbon, for example less than 70% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 60% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 50% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 40% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 30% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 20% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 10% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 1% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 0.1% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 0.01% of the total mass of polymer to be processed.
  • the process can also occur in the melt state.
  • Monomer or polymer components are heated above their melting point and then react to form an altered small molecule, a higher molecular weight thermoplastic or a crosslinked thermoset.
  • Another embodiment of the present disclosure provides a method for making polymer particles in gel form via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • the carrier fluid comprises a surfactant in a concentration equal to or greater than the critical micelle concentration and the volume average particle size (Dv, 50) of the polymer particles is less than or equal to 1 mm.
  • the disclosure provides a method for making polymer particles in gel form via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • the carrier fluid comprises 50 wt % or more of cyclohexane, based on the total weight of the carrier fluid, and the volume average particle size (Dv, 50) of the polymer particles is less than or equal to 1 mm.
  • the disclosure is directed to a method for making polymer particles in gel form via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • the carrier fluid comprises 50 wt % or more of cyclohexane, based on the total weight of the carrier fluid, and the volume average particle size (Dv, 50) of the polymer particles is greater than or equal to 1 mm.
  • the present application provides a method for preparing a condensation polymer gel via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • the disclosed methods include preparing a dried condensation polymer gel, the method comprises drying a condensation polymer gel, wherein the condensation polymer gel has been prepared by an emulsion or suspension process comprising:
  • the invention provides a method for preparing a carbon material, the method comprising heating condensation polymer gel particles to obtain a carbon material, wherein the condensation polymer gel particles have been prepared by a process comprising:
  • the condensation polymer gel may be used without drying or the methods may further comprise drying the condensation polymer gel.
  • the polymer gel is dried by freeze drying.
  • the polymer formed in the emulsion or suspension can also be formed via an addition, free radical, or living polymerization method.
  • the methods are useful for preparation of condensation polymer gels and/or carbon materials having any number of various pore structures.
  • the pore structure can be controlled by variation of any number of process parameters such as continuous phase type, stir rate, temperature, aging time, etc.
  • the condensation polymer gel is microporous, and in other embodiments the condensation polymer gel is mesoporous.
  • the condensation polymer gel comprises a pore structure having a mixture of microporous and mesoporous pores.
  • the carbon material is microporous or the carbon material is mesoporous.
  • the carbon material comprises a pore structure comprised of micropores, mesopores or macropores, or a combination thereof
  • the polymer phase may be prepared by admixing the one or more polymer precursors and the optional solvent, and in some examples the mixture is prepared by admixing the continuous phase and the polymer phase.
  • the method includes embodiments wherein the mixture is an emulsion, while in other embodiments the mixture is a suspension.
  • the continuous phase and the polymer phase are not miscible with each other, and the mixture is an emulsion. While in other exemplary methods the continuous phase and the polymer phase are not soluble in each other, and the mixture is a suspension. In other examples, the polymer phase is aged prior to preparation of the mixture, and the mixture is an emulsion and/or a suspension upon combination of the continuous phase and the polymer phase.
  • both the continuous phase and the polymer phase are soluble in each other (i.e., miscible).
  • the continuous phase and polymer phase are miscible initially but the polymer phase is aged such that it becomes immiscible with the continuous phase and the mixture becomes a suspension upon aging.
  • the polymer phase may be prepared by admixing the one or more polymer precursors and the optional solvent.
  • the polymer phase is “pre-reacted” prior to mixing with the continuous phase such the polymer precursors are at least partially polymerized.
  • the polymer precursors are not pre-reacted.
  • the method is a continuous process.
  • the polymer precursors may be continuously mixed with a continuous phase and the final condensation polymer gel may be continuously isolated from the mixture.
  • a single polymer precursor may be used or the methods may comprise use of two or more different polymer precursors.
  • the structure of the polymer precursors is not particularly limited, provided that the polymer precursor is capable of reacting with another polymer precursor or with a second polymer precursor to form a polymer.
  • a monolithic polymer gel can be physically disrupted to create smaller particles according to various techniques known in the art.
  • the resultant polymer gel particles generally have an average diameter of less than about 30 mm, for example, in the size range of about 1 mm to about 25 mm, or between about 1 mm to about 5 mm or between about 0.5 mm to about 10 mm.
  • the size of the polymer gel particles can be in the range below about 1 mm, for example, in the size range of about 10 to 1000 microns.
  • Techniques for creating polymer gel particles from monolithic material include manual or machine disruption methods, such as sieving, grinding, milling, or combinations thereof. Such methods are well-known to those of skill in the art.
  • Various types of mills can be employed in this context such as roller, bead, and ball mills and rotary crushers and similar particle creation equipment known in the art.
  • the polymer gel particles are in the range of 0.1 microns to 2.5 cm, from about 0.1 microns to about 1 cm, from about 1 micron to about 1000 microns, from about 1 micron to about 100 microns, from about 1 micron to about 50 microns, from about 1 micron to about 25 microns or from about 1 microns to about 10 microns. In other embodiments, the polymer gel particles are in the range of about 1 mm to about 100 mm, from about 1 mm to about 50 mm, from about 1 mm to about 25 mm or from about 1 mm to about 10 mm.
  • a roller mill is employed.
  • a roller mill has three stages to gradually reduce the size of the gel particles.
  • the polymer gels are generally very brittle and are not damp to the touch. Consequently they are easily milled using this approach; however, the width of each stage must be set appropriately to achieve the targeted final mesh. This adjustment is made and validated for each combination of gel recipe and mesh size.
  • Each gel is milled via passage through a sieve of known mesh size. Sieved particles can be temporarily stored in sealed containers.
  • a rotary crusher is employed.
  • the rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about 1 ⁇ 8 th inch.
  • the rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about 3 ⁇ 8 th inch.
  • the rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about 5 ⁇ 8 th inch.
  • the rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about 3 ⁇ 8 th inch.
  • Milling can be accomplished at room temperature according to methods well known to those of skill in the art. Alternatively, milling can be accomplished cryogenically, for example by co-milling the polymer gel with solid carbon dioxide (dry ice) particles.
  • the polymer gel particles are formed by emulsion/suspension.
  • a mixture of organic polymer solution can be mixed with electrochemical modifier particles, for example, through sonication or other methods. The mixture can then be stirred or further sonicated into a solution or continuous phase that is used to create an emulsion or suspension or an inverse emulsion.
  • the continuous phase contains cyclohexane.
  • the continuous phase contains a surfactant.
  • the continuous phase contains SPAN 80 as a surfactant.
  • the continuous phase contains mineral oil.
  • the continuous phase contains vegetable oil.
  • the continuous phase is largely free of cyclohexane.
  • the ratio of surfactant can be modified to control the formation of particles.
  • the continuous phase has a ratio of surfactant to continuous phase of 200:1 v/v. In one embodiment, the continuous phase has a ratio of surfactant to continuous phase of 2000:1 v/v.
  • the organic polymer gels described above can be further soaked or treated for the inclusion of an optional electrochemical modifier.
  • the inclusion of the electrochemical modifier may change both the electrochemical properties of the final product when used in a lithium battery and/or change the physical/chemical properties of the material.
  • an electrochemical modifier is added through a liquid phase soaking or solvent exchange.
  • the solvent used may be the same or different than that used in the polymer gel process.
  • wet polymer gels are weighed and placed into a larger container.
  • a solution containing a solvent and a precursor for electrochemical modification is combined with the wet polymer gel to form a mixture.
  • the mixture is left to soak at a set stir rate, temperature and time. Upon completion, the excess solvent is decanted from the mixture.
  • the optional electrochemical modifier is added through a vapor phase.
  • the precursor may be soluble in the solvent.
  • the solution may be unsaturated, saturated, or super saturated.
  • the precursor may be insoluble and therefore suspended in the solvent.
  • the soak temperature ranges from 20 to 30° C. In other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 30 to 40° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 40 to 50° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 50 to 60° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 60 to 70° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 70 to 80° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 80 to 100° C.
  • the soak time (the period of time between the combination of the wet polymer gel and the solution and the decanting of the excess liquid) is from about 0 hours to about 5 hours. In other embodiments, the soak time ranges from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, between about 30 minute and 90 minutes, and between about 40 minutes and 60 minutes. In yet other embodiments, the soak time is between about from about 0 hours to about 10 hours, from about 0 hours to about 20 hours, from about 10 hours to about 100 hours, from about 10 hours to about 15 hours, or from about 5 hours to about 10 hours.
  • the stir rate is between 0 and 10 rpm. In other embodiments, the stir rate is between 10 and 15 rpm, between 15 and 20 rpm, between 20 and 30 rpm, between 30 and 50 rpm, between 50 and 100 rpm, between 100 and 200 rpm, between 200 and 1000 rpm, or greater than 1000 rpm. In yet other embodiments, the mixture undergoes no artificial agitation.
  • the polymer gels described above can be further processed to obtain the desired composite materials.
  • processing includes, for example, pyrolysis.
  • wet polymer gels are weighed and placed in a rotary kiln.
  • the temperature ramp is set at 10° C. per minute, the dwell time and dwell temperature are set; cool down is determined by the natural cooling rate of the furnace.
  • the entire process is usually run under an inert atmosphere, such as a nitrogen environment.
  • the gas may be a hydrocarbon listed in table 1, such as methane, or ammonia.
  • Pyrolyzed samples are then removed and weighed.
  • Other pyrolysis processes are well known to those of skill in the art.
  • an optional electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the carbon material after pyrolysis of the polymer gel.
  • the electrochemical modifier can be incorporated into the pyrolyzed polymer gel by contacting the pyrolyzed polymer gel with the electrochemical modifier, for example, colloidal metal, molten metal, metal salt, metal paste, metal oxide or other sources of metals.
  • molten tin as an electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the pyrolyzed organic polymer during or after pyrolysis.
  • tin chloride as an electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the pyrolyzed organic polymer during or after pyrolysis.
  • tin chloride is in the form of tin tetrachloride.
  • silicon chloride as an electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the pyrolyzed organic polymer during or after pyrolysis.
  • tin chloride is in the form of silicon tetrachloride
  • pyrolysis dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • Pyrolysis may also be carried out more slowly than described above. For example, in one embodiment the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 480 minutes. In other embodiments, the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 240 minutes.
  • pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 850° C. to about 1050° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C.
  • the pyrolysis dwell temperature is varied during the course of pyrolysis.
  • the pyrolysis is carried out in a rotary kiln with separate, distinct heating zones. The temperature for each zone is sequentially decreased from the entrance to the exit end of the rotary kiln tube.
  • the pyrolysis is carried out in a rotary kiln with separate distinct heating zones, and the temperature for each zone is sequentially increased from entrance to exit end of the rotary kiln tube.
  • the surface of the composite may be modified during pyrolysis due to the thermal breakdown of solid, liquid or gas precursors.
  • Theses precursors may include any of the chemicals listed in Table 1.
  • the precursors may be introduced prior to pyrolysis under room temperature conditions.
  • the precursors may be introduced while the material is at an elevated temperature during pyrolysis.
  • the precursors may be introduced post-pyrolysis. Multiple precursors or a mixture of precursors for chemical and structural modification may also be used.
  • a reducing gas is used to reduce the electrochemical modifier into its elemental form.
  • the reducing gas is hydrogen.
  • the reducing gas is ammonia.
  • the reducing gas is hydrogen sulfide.
  • the reducing gas is carbon monoxide.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 850° C. to about 1050° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 800° C. to about 1100° C.
  • heat treatment dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 300 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • Pyrolysis may also be carried out more slowly than described above. For example, in one embodiment the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 480 minutes. In other embodiments, the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 240 minutes.
  • the composite may also undergo a heat treatment under a volatile gas, such as a hydrocarbon listed in Table 1.
  • a volatile gas such as a hydrocarbon listed in Table 1.
  • the hydrocarbon or volatile gas may decompose or react on the surface of the composite when exposed to elevated temperatures.
  • the volatile may leave behind a thin layer, such as a soft carbon, covering the surface of the composite.
  • the material comprising an electrochemical modifier is subjected to coating with soft carbon layer.
  • silicon powders are coated with soft carbon to form a composite.
  • tin powder is coated with soft carbon to form a composite.
  • the gas may be piped in directly from a compressed tank.
  • the gas may originate through the heating of a liquid and the mixing of an inert carrier gas using a bubbler technique commonly known in the art.
  • as solid or liquid may be placed upstream of the sample and decompose into a volatile gas, which then reacts with the carbon in the hot zone.
  • the vapor deposition may be completed under a static gas environment. In another embodiment the vapor deposition may be completed in a dynamic, gas flowing environment but wherein the carbon is static. In yet another embodiment, the vapor deposition may be completed under continuous coating, wherein the gas and the carbon are flowing through a hot zone. In still yet another embodiment the vapor deposition may be completed under continuous coating, wherein the gas and the carbon are flowing through a hot zone, but where the gas is flowing counter current to the solid carbon. In another embodiment the carbon is coated by chemical vapor deposition while rotating in a rotatory kiln.
  • the composite may also undergo a vapor deposition through the heating of a volatile gas at different temperatures.
  • the electrochemical modifier is incorporated during the pyrolysis or high temperature treatment by a gas phase deposition of the desired compounds.
  • the gas phase contains silicon.
  • the silicon is conveyed in the form of silane gas.
  • the silicon is conveyed in the form of trichlorosilane gas.
  • the silicon containing gas is combined with nitrogen gas.
  • the gas stream contains phospine, diborane, or arsine.
  • the gas contains tin.
  • the gas comprises vaporized elemental tin.
  • the gas phase deposition of electrochemical modifier is performed in a kiln or in a fluidized bed.
  • the pressure of the deposition can be modified to create a near vacuum condition.
  • vapor deposition temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1000° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 800° C. to about 900° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 900° C. to about 1100° C., from about 950° C. to about 1050° C. or about 1000° C.
  • the composite may also undergo a vapor deposition through the heating of a volatile gas for different dwell times.
  • vapor deposition dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 5 hours, from about 10 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • the thickness of the layer of carbon deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition can be measured by HRTEM. In one embodiment the thickness of the layer is less than 0.1 nm, less than 0.5 nm, less than 1 nm, or less than 2 nm. In other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 1 nm and 100 nm. In yet other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 0.1 nm and 50 nm. In still other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 1 nm and 50 nm. In still other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 2 nm and 50 nm, for example between about 10 nm and 25 nm.
  • a composite material may also be synthesized through a one-step polymerization/pyrolysis method.
  • the polymer is formed during the pyrolysis temperature ramp.
  • the precursors are placed into a rotary kiln with an inert nitrogen atmosphere.
  • the precursors will undergo polymerization within the kiln during the temperature ramp.
  • the temperature is once again increased, where the polymer undergoes pyrolysis as previously described.
  • the precursors comprise a saccharide, protein, or a biopolymer.
  • saccharides include, but are not limited to chitin, chitosan, and lignin.
  • a non-limiting example of a protein is animal derived gelatin.
  • the precursors may be partially polymerized prior to insertion into the kiln. In yet other embodiments, the precursors are not fully polymerized before pyrolysis is initiated.
  • the intermediate dwell time may vary. In one embodiment, no intermediate dwell time exists. In another embodiment, the dwell time ranges from about 0 to about 10 hrs. In yet another embodiment, the dwell time ranges from about 0 to about 5 hrs. In yet other embodiments, the dwell time ranges from about 0 to about 1 hour.
  • the intermediate dwell temperature may also vary. In some embodiments, the intermediate dwell temperature ranges from about 100 to about 600° C., from about 150 to about 500° C., or from about 350 to about 450° C. In other embodiments, the dwell temperature is greater than about 600° C. In yet other embodiments, the intermediate dwell temperature is below about 100° C.
  • pyrolysis dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • Pyrolysis may also be carried out more slowly than described above. For example, in one embodiment the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 480 minutes. In other embodiments, the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 240 minutes.
  • pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 850° C. to about 1050° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C.
  • the surface area of the carbon as measured by nitrogen sorption may vary between 0 and 500 m 2 /g, 0 and 250 m 2 /g, 5 and 100 m 2 /g, 5 and 50 m 2 /g. In other embodiments, the surface area of the carbon as measured by nitrogen sorption may vary between 250 and 500 m 2 /g, 300 and 400 m 2 /g, 300 and 350 m 2 /g, 350 and 400 m 2 /g.
  • the composite comprises carbon and an electrochemical modifier in elemental form.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises elemental silicon.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises elemental Tin.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises elemental Germanium.
  • silicon oxides can be used to form a composite and then reduced to elemental silicon.
  • the silicon comprises poly-crystalline silicon.
  • the silicon comprises crystalline silicon.
  • the reduction is carried out using carbothermal reduction.
  • the carbon is supplied to the reaction from the carbon in the composite material.
  • the reaction is carried out in a reducing atmosphere as described above.
  • the carbothermal reduction involves a heat treatment step under an inert atmosphere.
  • the atmosphere comprises nitrogen or argon.
  • the reaction is carried out under a vacuum.
  • the atmosphere contains a reducing gas as described above.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to 2200° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1500° C. to about 2000° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1600° C. to about 1900° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature is about 1900° C.
  • the heat treatment step is carried out with a dwell temperature for a specific period of time. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • the reduction is carried out in an alkaline environment.
  • reduction is magnesiothermal reduction.
  • the reduction is calciothermal reduction.
  • the reduction is carried out using beryllium or strontium, or barium.
  • the amount of material to be reduced can be varied against the amount of alkaline reducing agent.
  • the molar ration of SiO 2 to alkaline reducing agent can be varied depending on the reaction conditions, completeness of reaction desired, and other reducing agents such as carbon or gases present.
  • the ratio of SiO 2 :Alkaline is 1:1.
  • the ratio of SiO 2 :Alkaline is 1:1.9.
  • the ratio of SiO 2 :Alkaline is 1:3.
  • the composite material comprising electrochemical modifier to be reduced is milled and mixed with powdered alkaline reducing agent.
  • the alkaline reduction involves a heat treatment step under a controlled atmosphere.
  • the atmosphere comprises nitrogen or argon.
  • the reaction is carried out under a vacuum.
  • the atmosphere contains a reducing gas as described above.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 600° C. to 1500° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 600° C. to about 1000° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 800° C.
  • heat treatment dwell temperature is about 725° C.
  • the heat treatment step is carried out with a dwell temperature for a specific period of time.
  • heat treatment dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • the reduction is carried out by electrochemical reduction.
  • the electrochemical modifier to be reduced to elemental form is arranged in a high temperature electrochemical cell as the anode in an electrochemical cell.
  • the cathode is typically graphite but other highly stable electrically conductive compounds can be used.
  • the anode is a graphite rod.
  • the graphite rode is in electrical contact with a metal current collector and a power supply. This type of arrangements requires a high temperature electrolyte such a molten salt.
  • the electrolyte is calcium chloride.
  • the electrolyte is sodium chloride.
  • the electrolyte is a low temperature ionic liquid.
  • the electrochemical modifier to be reduced is placed in a metal crucible, which is in turn in electrical connection with a power supply.
  • the crucible comprises nickel.
  • the crucible is inconel.
  • the crucible comprises stainless steel.
  • the metal crucible containing the material to be reduced is filled with salt, and placed in the hot zone of a furnace in a controlled atmosphere and heated to a known temperature to melt the salt into an ionically conductive molten salt.
  • the atmosphere comprises nitrogen.
  • the dwell temperature of the furnace is 25 C or 50 C or 100 C or 200 C or 300 C or 400 C, or 500 C or 600 C or 700 C or 800 C or 850 C or 900 C or 950 C or 1000 C. In one embodiment, the temperature is above the melting point of the salt to be used. In one embodiment the furnace is held at the dwell temperature for a period of time required to fully melt the salt. In one embodiment, the dwell time is 30 minutes. In one embodiment, the dwell time is 60 minutes. After the dwell time has elapsed the power supply connected to the electrochemical cell is set to a potential necessary to reduce the electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment, the potential is 2.8V. In one embodiment, the current on the power supply is monitored. In one embodiment, power supply is turned off when the current stops decreasing. In one embodiment, the furnace is cooled, the crucible is removed and the salt is rinsed off of the reduced material with water.
  • the composite may be formed through a gas phase deposition of an electrochemical modifier onto the carbon.
  • the composite may be synthesized through mechanical mixing or milling of two distinct solids.
  • both the carbon and the electrochemical modifier are in solid form.
  • the form factor for both the solid carbon and/or the solid electrochemical modifier may be presented in any shape, such as, but not limited to a monolith, a powder, a rod, a wire, a sheet, or a tube.
  • the two populations of materials may be combined to create a unique composite, whose physical and electrochemical properties are defined in the previous section.
  • the two distinct populations are combined to make a composite prior to the fabrication of electrodes for testing.
  • the composite is two distinct populations included independently into an electrode, if the two materials exhibit the same physical and electrochemical characteristics of a composite if combined prior to electrode fabrication.
  • the carbon solid may include multiple populations of carbon allotropes, such as graphite, soft carbon and graphene.
  • the additional carbon allotropes are considered an electrochemical modifier if they alloy with lithium during electrochemical lithiations. Ratio of populations of allotropes are described in the previous section.
  • Methods of combination of multiple populations of powders to create a unique composite include but are not limited to mechanical milling (described in more detail below) such as jet milling, bead milling and ball milling, in process manufacturing techniques such as flow diversion, or techniques wherein the optimal composite is formed during electrode fabrication.
  • the carbon solid prior to gas phase growth of an electrochemical modifier may be considered ultrapure.
  • the carbon solid may have any properties of the proposed composite as described in the previous section.
  • the gas phase techniques may include thin film techniques known to those in the art, such as atomic layer deposition (ALD), chemical vapor deposition (CVD) and physical layer deposition (PLD).
  • Gas phase precursors for the electrochemical modifier include, but are not limited to silane and all silane derivatives such as polysilanes, silicon tetrachloride, tin chloride, tetrakis-(dimethylamido)titanium, and tetrikis-(ethylamido)titanium.
  • the time for gas phase deposition of the electrochemical modifier on the carbon solid may impact the thickness of the silicon layer and ultimately the performance of the composite.
  • the time of deposition is between 5 mins and 5 hours.
  • the time of deposition is between 15 minutes and 60 minutes.
  • the time of deposition if between 60 minutes and 4 hours, 2 hour an 3 hours or 2.5 hours.
  • the temperature for gas phase deposition of the electrochemical modifier on the carbon solid may impact the thickness of the silicon layer and ultimately the performance of the composite.
  • the temperature of deposition is between 200 C and 1200 C.
  • the temperature of deposition is between 300 C and 600 C, 400 C and 550 C, and 450 C and 500 C.
  • the temperature of deposition if between 600 C and 1200 C, 600 C and 1000 C, 650 C and 800 C, 700 C and 750 C.
  • the composite is formed through a gas phase interaction with a silicon solid.
  • the silicon solid may be any allotrope of known silicon and may have specific properties prior to gas phase growth of carbon.
  • Electrochemical modifiers can be incorporated with a pure carbon material by milling the two materials together using high-energy milling. Milling can create micronized and in some cases nanometer sized particles which are intimately combined by co-milling or by combination after milling.
  • the carbon component comprises hard carbon.
  • the carbon component comprises graphite.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises silicon.
  • the electrochemical modifier comprises tin.
  • Alternate forms of milling techniques can be used to mill the materials.
  • the milling technique is jet milling.
  • the milling technique is Fritch-milling.
  • the milling technique is ball milling.
  • the milling technique is high-energy ball milling.
  • the residence time of the material in the mill can be varied to alter the result.
  • the residence time is about 10 seconds. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 30 seconds. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 1 minute. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 5 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 10 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 15 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 20 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 30 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 45 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 60 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 90 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 120 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 180 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 240 minutes.
  • the ratio of carbon to electrochemical modifier can be varied to create a material with different properties, such as capacity.
  • the ratio can vary from 1:5 to 5:1.
  • the ratio is 1:5 or 1:4 or 1:3 or 1:2 or 1:1 or 2:1 or 3:1 or 4:1 or 5:1.
  • the electrochemical modifier can be used in a crystalline form.
  • electrochemical modifier can be used in an amorphous form.
  • the milling technique can be modified to create different particle size distributions.
  • the D50 of the particle size distribution of the carbon can be varied independently or with the D50 of the particle size distribution of the electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 0.1 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 0.2 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 0.5 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 1 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 3 um.
  • the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 5 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 8 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 10 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 15 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 20 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 30 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 40 um.
  • the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 50 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 70 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 100 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 150 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 200 um.
  • the composite after milling, can be coated with carbon using vapor phase deposition as described above.
  • the techniques described above can be used to create different arrangements and layouts of both carbon and electrochemical modifier.
  • the above techniques are capable of creating a wide variety of formats of carbon, electrochemical modifier and their arrangement relative to each other.
  • the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is porous.
  • the electrochemical modifier is inside the pores of the carbon, for example encapsulated in the carbon.
  • the carbon is inside the pores of the electrochemical modifier.
  • either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is arranged in a core-shell format.
  • the core is carbon.
  • the core is the electrochemical modifier, such as silicon or another lithium alloying element.
  • the shell thickness is about 5 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 10 nm.
  • the shell thickness is about 30 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 50 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 100 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 200 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 300 nm.
  • the core is electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is arranged in a rod. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier comprises foam. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is arranged in a tube. In one embodiment, the tube is hollow or in some embodiments the tube is filled with either carbon or electrochemical modifier. In still other embodiments, the composite is a physical blend of particles of the carbon component and particles of the electrochemical modifier.
  • the electrochemical modifier is a coating on the surface of the carbon material.
  • the properties of the electrochemical modifier coated onto the carbon may influence various important electrochemical metrics such as power performance and cycle life.
  • the thickness of the electrochemical modifier coating on the surface of the carbon is ranges from 1 to 10000 nm. In another embodiment the thickness ranges from 1 to 100 nm, 1, 50 nm, 1 to 10 nm, 10 to 20 nm. In yet another embodiment the thickness ranges from 100 to 1000 nm, 100 to 500 nm, 200 to 400 nm, 500 to 750 nm. In still another embodiment the thickness ranges from 1000 to 10000 nm, 1000 to 5000, or greater than 10000 nm. Examples of methods and conditions of synthesis are described in more detail below.
  • the structural properties of the final carbon material and intermediate polymer gels may be measured using Nitrogen sorption at 77K, a method known to those of skill in the art.
  • the final performance and characteristics of the finished carbon material is important, but the intermediate products (both dried polymer gel and pyrolyzed, but not activated, polymer gel), can also be evaluated, particularly from a quality control standpoint, as known to those of skill in the art.
  • the Micromeretics ASAP 2020 is used to perform detailed micropore and mesopore analysis, which reveals a pore size distribution from 0.35 nm to 50 nm in some embodiments.
  • the system produces a nitrogen isotherm starting at a pressure of 10 ⁇ 7 atm, which enables high resolution pore size distributions in the sub 1 nm range.
  • the software generated reports utilize a Density Functional Theory (DFT) method to calculate properties such as pore size distributions, surface area distributions, total surface area, total pore volume, and pore volume within certain pore size ranges.
  • the impurity and optional electrochemical modifier content of the carbon materials can be determined by any number of analytical techniques known to those of skill in the art.
  • One particular analytical method useful within the context of the present disclosure is total x-ray reflection fluorescence (TXRF).
  • Another analytical method useful within the context of the present disclosure is proton induced x-ray emission (PIXE).
  • TXRF total x-ray reflection fluorescence
  • PIXE proton induced x-ray emission
  • the disclosed composite materials can be used as electrode material in any number of electrical energy storage and distribution devices.
  • the present disclosure provides a lithium-based electrical energy storage device comprising an electrode prepared from the disclosed composite materials.
  • Such lithium based devices are superior to previous devices in a number of respects including gravimetric and volumetric capacity and first cycle efficiency.
  • Electrodes comprising the disclosed composite materials are also provided.
  • an electrical energy storage device comprising:
  • the electrical energy storage device has a first cycle efficiency of at least 70% and a reversible capacity of at least 500 mAh/g with respect to the mass of the hard carbon material.
  • the efficiency is measured at a current density of about 100 mA/g with respect to the mass of the active hard carbon material in the anode. In still other embodiments, the efficiency is measured at a current density of about 1000 mA/g with respect to the mass of the active hard carbon material in the anode.
  • the properties of the device are tested electrochemically between upper and lower voltages of 3V and ⁇ 20 mV, respectively.
  • the lower cut-off voltage is between 50 mV and ⁇ 20 mV, between 0V and ⁇ 15 mV, or between 10 mV and 0V.
  • the device is tested at a current density of 40 mA/g with respect to the mass of carbon material.
  • the composite material may be any of the composite materials described herein.
  • the first cycle efficiency is greater than 55%. In some other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 60%. In yet other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 65%. In still other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 70%. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 75%, and in other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 80%, greater than 90%, greater than 95%, greater than 98%, or greater than 99%.
  • the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 300 m 2 /g. In other embodiments, the composite material comprises a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g. In still other embodiments of the foregoing, the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 50 m 2 /g and a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g.
  • the electrical energy storage device has a volumetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 400 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 450 mAh/cc. In some other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/cc. In yet other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 550 mAh/cc. In still other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 650 mAh/cc, and in other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/cc.
  • a volumetric capacity i.e., reversible capacity
  • the device has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity, based on mass of composite) of at least 150 mAh/g. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 200 mAh/g. In some other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 300 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 400 mAh/g. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g.
  • a gravimetric capacity i.e., reversible capacity, based on mass of composite
  • the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g, at least 800 mAh/g, at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g or even at least 1200 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the device has a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 550 mAh/g to about 750 mAh/g.
  • the cycle stability of the material is in part determined by the relative amount that the composite material swells when it takes on lithium.
  • the most stable materials have a very low percent expansion relative to the original dimensions of a particle or electrode.
  • the percent expansion of the composite is about 0.5%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 1%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 2%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 3%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 4%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 5%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 7%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 10%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 15%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 20%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 30%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 50%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 100%.
  • the cycle stability of the composite material can be defined as the number of cycle a device is cycled until the capacity reaches 80% of the initial reversible capacity. In one embodiment the stability of the composite in a device is between 100 and 1000000 cycles. In another embodiment the cycle stability is between 100 and 5000 cycles, 200 and 1000 cycles, 300 and 1000 cycles. In yet another embodiment the cycle stability of the composite material is between 5000 and 1000000 cycles, 5000 and 100000, 5000 and 10000, or greater than 1000000 cycles.
  • the kinetics of charge and discharge of a composite material in a device can further be measured by power performance.
  • the power density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 W/kg, 200 and 800 W/kg, 200 and 450 W/kg, 300 and 400 W/kg.
  • the power density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 W/L, 100 and 500 W/L, 200 to 500 W/L, 300 to 450 W/L, greater than 1000 W/L.
  • the energy density of a device comprising the composite material can be defined both volumetrically and gravimetrically.
  • the energy density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 Wh/kg, 200 and 800 Wh/kg, 200 and 450 Wh/kg, 300 and 400 Wh/kg.
  • the energy density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 Wh/L, 100 and 500 Wh/L, 200 to 500 Wh/L, 300 to 450 Wh/L, greater than 1000 Wh/L.
  • the capacity may be due to surface loss/storage, structural intercalation or storage of lithium within the pores.
  • Structural storage is defined as capacity inserted above 50 mV vs Li/Li while lithium pore storage is below 50 mV versus Li/Li+ but above the potential of lithium plating.
  • the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:10 and 10:1.
  • the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:5 and 1:10.
  • the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:2 and 1:4.
  • the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:1.5 and 1:2. In still another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is 1:1. The ratio of capacity stored through intercalation may be greater than that of pore storage in a device. In another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 10:1 and 5:1. In yet another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 2:1 and 4:1. In still yet another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1.5:1 and 2:1.
  • lithium plating may occur at different voltages.
  • the voltage of lithium plating is defined as when the voltage increases despite lithium insertion at a slow rate of 20 mA/g.
  • the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is 0V.
  • the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is between 0V and ⁇ 5 mV.
  • the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is between ⁇ 5 mV and ⁇ 10 mV.
  • the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is between ⁇ 10 mV and ⁇ 15 mV. In still another embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g ranges from ⁇ 15 mV to ⁇ 20 mV. In yet another embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is below ⁇ 20 mV.
  • the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 300 m 2 /g. In other embodiments, the composite material comprises a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g. In still other embodiments of the foregoing, the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 300 m 2 /g and a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g.
  • the electrical energy storage device has a volumetric capacity at least 5% greater than the same device which comprises a graphite electrode instead of an electrode comprising the disclosed composite material.
  • the electrical energy storage device has a gravimetric capacity that is at least 10% greater, at least 20% greater, at least 30% greater, at least 40% greater or at least 50% than the gravimetric capacity of the same electrical energy storage device having a graphite electrode.
  • the cathode comprises a material other than a metal oxide
  • the cathode comprises a sulfur-based material rather than a metal oxide.
  • the cathode comprises a lithium containing metal-phosphate.
  • the cathode comprises lithium metal.
  • the cathode is a combination of two or more of any of the foregoing materials.
  • the cathode is an air cathode.
  • the polymer gels, pyrolyzed cryogels, carbon materials and composite materials disclosed herein may be prepared according to the following exemplary procedures. Chemicals were obtained from commercial sources at reagent grade purity or better and were used as received from the supplier without further purification.
  • Phenolic compound and aldehyde were reacted in the presence of a catalyst in a binary solvent system (e.g., water and acetic acid).
  • a binary solvent system e.g., water and acetic acid
  • the molar ratio of phenolic compound to aldehyde was typically 0.5 to 1.
  • the reaction was allowed to incubate in a sealed container at temperatures of up to 85° C. for up to 24 h.
  • the resulting polymer hydrogel contained water, but no organic solvent; and was not subjected to solvent exchange of water for an organic solvent, such as t-butanol.
  • the polymer hydrogel monolith was then physically disrupted, for example by grinding, to form polymer hydrogel particles having an average diameter of less than about 5 mm.
  • the wet polymer hydrogel was typically pyrolyzed by heating in a nitrogen atmosphere at temperatures ranging from 800-1200° C. for a period of time as specified in the examples. Specific pyrolysis conditions were as described in the following examples.
  • impregnation of the carbon materials with electrochemical modifiers was accomplished by including a source of the electrochemical modifier in the polymerization reaction or contacting the carbon material, or precursors of the same (e.g., polymer hydrogel, dried polymer hydrogel, pyrolyzed polymer gel, etc.), with a source of the electrochemical modifier as described more fully above and exemplified below.
  • a source of the electrochemical modifier in the polymerization reaction or contacting the carbon material, or precursors of the same (e.g., polymer hydrogel, dried polymer hydrogel, pyrolyzed polymer gel, etc.), with a source of the electrochemical modifier as described more fully above and exemplified below.
  • Polymer gels were prepared using the following general procedure.
  • the reaction mixture was placed at elevated temperature (incubation at 45° C. for about 6 h followed by incubation at 85° C. for about 24 h) to allow for gellation to create a polymer gel.
  • Polymer gel particles were created from the polymer gel and passed through a 4750 micron mesh sieve.
  • the polymer is rinsed in a urea or polysaccharide solution. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed such treatment may either impart surface functionality or alter the bulk structure of the carbon and improve the electrochemical characteristics of the carbon materials.
  • polymer gels were also prepared using the following general procedure.
  • a polymer gel was prepared by polymerization of urea and formaldehyde (1:1.6) in water (3.3:1 water:urea) and formic acid. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature until gellation to create a white polymer gel. Polymer gel particles were created through manually crushing.
  • the extent of crosslinking of the resin can be controlled through both the temperature and the time of curing.
  • various amine containing compounds such as urea, melamine and ammonia can be used.
  • aldehyde e.g., formaldehyde
  • solvent e.g., water
  • amine containing compound can be varied to obtain the desired extent of cross linking and nitrogen content.
  • a nitrogen containing hard carbon was synthesized using a resorcinol-formaldehyde gel mixture in a manner analogous to that described in Example 1.
  • About 20 mL of polymer solution was obtained (prior to placing solution at elevated temperature and generating the polymer gel).
  • the solution was then stored at 45° C. for about 5 h, followed by 24 h at 85° C. to fully induce cross-linking.
  • the monolith gel was broken mechanically and milled to particle sizes below 100 microns.
  • the gel particles were then soaked for 16 hours in a 30% saturated solution of urea (0.7:1 gel:urea and 1.09:1 gel:water) while stirring. After the excess liquid was decanted, the resulting wet polymer gel was allowed to dry for 48 hours at 85° C. in air then pyrolyzed by heating from room temperature to 1100° C. under nitrogen gas at a ramp rate of 10° C. per min to obtain a hard carbon containing the nitrogen electrochemical modifier.
  • the gel particles are soaked for about 5 minutes to about 100 hrs, from about 1 hour to about 75 hours, from about 5 hours to about 60 hours, from about 10 hours to 50 hours, from about 10 hours to 20 hours from about 25 hours to about 50 hours, or about 40 hours. In certain embodiments the soak time is about 16 hours.
  • the drying temperature may be varied, for example from about room temperature (e.g. about 20-25 C) to about 100 C, from about 25 C to about 100 C, from about 50 to about 90 C, from about 75 C to about 95 C, or about 85 C.
  • Ratio of the polymer gel to the soak composite can also be varied to obtain the desired result.
  • the ratio of gel to nitrogen containing compound ranges from about 0.01:1 to about 10:1, from about 0.1:1 to about 10:1, from about 0.1:1 to about 5:1, from about 1:1 to about 5:1, from about 0.2:1 to about 1:1 or from about 0.4:1 to about 0;9:1.
  • the ratio of gel to water can also range from about 0.01:1 to about 10:1, from about 0.5:1 to about 1.5:1, from about 0.7:1 to about 1.2:1 or from about 0.9:1 to about 1.1:1.
  • Various solvents such as water, alcohols, oils and/or ketones may be used for soaking the polymer gel as described above.
  • Various embodiments of the invention include polymer gels which have been prepared as described above (e.g., contain nitrogen as a result of soaking in a nitrogen containing compound) as well as carbon materials prepared from the same (which also contain nitrogen). Methods according to the general procedure described above are also included within the scope of the invention.
  • the concentration of the soak composite in the solvent in which it is soaked may be varied from about 5% to close to 100% by weight. In other embodiments, the concentration ranges from about 10% to about 90%, from about 20% to about 85%, from about 25% to about 85%, from about 50% to about 80% or from about 60% to about 80%, for example about 70%.
  • the gel may undergo further cross linking while being soaked in the solution containing a compound from Table I.
  • the surface area of the pyrolyzed dried polymer gel was examined by nitrogen surface analysis using a surface area and porosity analyzer.
  • the measured specific surface area using the standard BET approach was in the range of about 150 to 200 m 2 /g.
  • the pyrolysis conditions, such as temperature and time, are altered to obtain hard carbon materials having any number of various properties.
  • the carbon after pyrolysis is rinsed in either a urea or polysaccharide solution and re-pyrolyzed at 600° C. in an inert nitrogen atmosphere.
  • the pyrolysis temperature is varied to yield varying chemical and physical properties of the carbon.
  • the wet gel may also be pyrolyzed in a non-inert atmosphere such as ammonia gas.
  • a non-inert atmosphere such as ammonia gas.
  • a 5 gram sample first purged under a dynamic flow of 5% ammonia/95% N2 volume mixture. The sample is then heated to 900° C. under the ammonia/N2 flow. The temperature is held for 1 hour, wherein the gas is switched to pure nitrogen for cool down. The material is not exposed to an oxygen environment until below 150° C.
  • Carbon material prepared according to Example 2 was jet milled using a Jet Pulverizer Micron Master 2 inch diameter jet mill.
  • the conditions comprised about 0.7 lbs of activated carbon per hour, nitrogen gas flow about 20 scf per min and about 100 psi pressure.
  • the average particle size after jet milling was about 8 to 10 microns.
  • the 1 st cycle lithiation efficiency of the resulting hard carbon from example 5 can be improved via a non-oxygen containing hydrocarbon (from Table 1) treatment of the surface.
  • the micronized/milled carbon is heated to 800° C. in a tube furnace under flowing nitrogen gas. At peak temperature the gas is diverted through a flask containing liquid cyclohexane. The cyclohexane then pyrolyzes on the surface of the hard carbon.
  • FIG. 9 shows the superior electrochemical performance of the surface treated hard carbon.
  • the modified pore size distribution is shown in FIG. 10 . Exemplary surface areas of untreated and hydrocarbon treated hard carbon materials are presented in Table 2.
  • Carbon materials were prepared in a manner analogous to those described in the above Examples and their properties measured.
  • the electrochemical performance and certain other properties of the carbon samples are provided in Table 3.
  • the data in Table 3 show that the carbons with surface area ranging from about 200 to about 700 m 2 /g and pore volumes ranging from about 0.1 to about 0.7 cc/g) had the best 1 st cycle efficiency and reversible capacity (Q rev ).
  • FIG. 1 The pore size distribution of exemplary hard carbons is provided in FIG. 1 , which shows that hard carbon materials having pore size distributions ranging from microporous to mesoporous to macroporous can be obtained.
  • the data also shows that the pore structure may also determine the packing and volumetric capacities of the material when used in a device.
  • FIG. 2 depicts storage of lithium per unit volume of the device as a function of cycle number. The data from FIG. 2 correlates well with the data from FIG. 1 .
  • the two microporous materials display the highest volumetric capacity, possibly due to a higher density material.
  • the mesoporous material has the third highest volumetric capacity while the macroporous material has the lowest volumetric capacity. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the macroporous materials create empty spaces within the device, void of carbon for energy storage.
  • the particle size and particle size distribution of the hard carbon materials may affect the carbon packing efficiency and may contribute to the volumetric capacity of electrodes comprising the carbon materials.
  • the particle size distribution of two exemplary hard carbon materials is presented in FIG. 3 . Thus both single Gaussian and bimodal particle size distributions can be obtained. Other particle size distributions can be obtained by altering the synthetic parameters and/or through post processing such as milling or grinding.
  • Table 4 shows a possible trend between the available lithium sites for insertion and the range of disorder/crystallite size. This crystallite size may also affect the rate capability for carbons since a smaller crystallite size may allow for lower resistive lithium ion diffusion through the amorphous structure. Due to the possible different effects that the value of disorder has on the electrochemical output, this present invention includes embodiments having high and low levels of disorder.
  • the data in Table 5 shows possible compositions of hard carbons as measured by CHNO analysis.
  • the nitrogen content may be added either in the polymer gel synthesis (Carbon A and B), during soaking of the wet polymer gel (Carbon C), or after carbon synthesis. It is possible that the nitrogen content or the C:N ratio may create a different crystalline or surface structure, allowing for the reversible storage of lithium ions. Due to the possible different effects nitrogen content may play in lithium kinetics, the present invention includes embodiments having both low and high quantities of nitrogen.
  • the elemental composition of the hard carbon may also be measured through XPS.
  • FIG. 20 shows a wide angle XPS for an outstanding, unique carbon.
  • the carbon has 2.26% nitrogen content, 90.55% carbon with 6.90% oxygen content.
  • FIG. 21 uses Auger to indicate an sp2/sp3 hybridization percent concentration of 65%.
  • Exemplary carbon materials were also analyzed by X-ray diffraction (XRD) to determine the level of crystallinity (see FIG. 5 ). While Raman measures the size of the crystallites, XRD records the level of periodicity in the bulk structure through the scattering of incident X-rays.
  • This invention include embodiments which are non-graphitic (crystallinity ⁇ 10%) and semi-graphitic (crystallinity between 10 and 50%).
  • the broad, dull peaks are synonymous with amorphous carbon, while sharper peaks indicate a higher level of crystal structure. Materials with both sharp and broad peaks are labeled as semi-graphitic.
  • the bulk structure of the carbon materials is also characterized by hardness or Young's Elastic modulus.
  • the carbon material may also be analyzed using Small Angle X-ray Diffraction (SAXS) (see FIGS. 6 and 7 ). Between 10° and 40°, the scattering angle is an indication of the number of stacked graphene sheets present within the bulk structure.
  • SAXS Small Angle X-ray Diffraction
  • Initial test of a carbon indicates a mixed-bulk structure of both single layer graphene sheets and double stacked graphene layers.
  • the percentage of single-double layers can be calculated from an empirical value (R) that compares the intensities of the single (A) and double component (B). Since lithium is stored within the layers, the total reversible capacity can be optimized by tailoring the internal carbon structure.
  • Example SAXS of exemplary carbons is depicted in FIG. 7 . Notice that single, double, and even tri-layer features are present in some of the carbons.
  • SAXS may also be used to measure the internal pore size distribution of the carbon.
  • FIG. 22 shows the SAXS curve and the pore size distribution for pore smaller than 16 nm.
  • the nitrogen containing carbon has between 0.5 and 1% of pores below 1 nm in radius.
  • the surface chemistry (e.g., presence of organics on the carbon surface) is a parameter that is adjusted to optimize the carbon materials for use in the lithium-based energy storage devices.
  • Infra-red spectroscopy can be used as a metric to determine both surface and bulk structures of the carbon materials when in the presence of organics.
  • FIG. 8 a depicts FTIR spectra of certain exemplary carbons of the present disclosure.
  • the FTIR is featureless and indicates a carbon structure void of organics (e.g., carbons B and D).
  • the FTIR depicts large hills and valleys relating to a high level of organic content (e.g., carbons A and C).
  • the carbon material comprises organic functionality as determined by FTIR analysis.
  • the samples with flat FTIR signals display a low extraction peak in the voltage profile at 0.2 V.
  • the extract voltage is typical of lithium stripping. The lithium stripping plateau is absent in the two FTIR samples that display organic curves in FTIR.
  • the pH of the carbon can also be controlled through the pyrolysis temperature.
  • FIG. 23 shows pH as the pyrolysis temperature increases. Not being bound by theory, as the temperature of pyrolysis is increased, the surface functionality and the pH of the carbon will rise, becoming more basic. Tailoring the pH can be accomplished post-pyrolysis through heat treatment or an additional pyrolysis step.
  • the material may also be characterized as the Li:C ratio, wherein there is no metallic lithium present.
  • FIG. 24 shows an unexpected result wherein the maximum ratio of Li:C possible without the presence of metallic lithium is greater than 1.6 for a carbon between the pH values of 7 and 7.5.
  • FIG. 11 shows 1 st cycle voltage profiles for three exemplary carbons containing between 1.5% and 6% nitrogen, prepared as described above.
  • the total capacity and operating voltage can be tailored to the desired application.
  • Carbon A has been tuned to have lowest gravimetric capacity upon extraction, though it is superior of all of the carbons in energy density due to the plateau close to zero.
  • Carbon B has a smaller plateau but a larger gravimetric capacity than A.
  • Carbon C is advantageous for vehicular applications due to its sloping voltage profile. This sloping profile allows for easy gauging of the state-of-charge (SOC) of the battery, which is difficult with flat plateaus.
  • SOC state-of-charge
  • FIG. 12 shows the gravimetric capacity of an exemplary embodiment compared to the theoretical maximum capacity of traditional commercial graphite versus lithium metal, thus demonstrating that the presently disclosed carbon materials represent an improvement over previously known materials.
  • the solid points represent lithium insertion while the open points represent lithium extraction.
  • the carbon is both ultra-pure with a low percentage of impurities as measured by PIXE and with 1.6% nitrogen content and where the maximum atomic Li:C ratio without the presence of metallic lithium is 1.65:6.
  • FIGS. 25 and 26 shows the capacity of an exemplary, ultrapure hard carbon as measured by a third party laboratory.
  • the material shows excellent efficiency, capacity and rate capability.
  • the material can be described as having 1.6% nitrogen content and where the maximum atomic Li:C ratio without the presence of metallic lithium is 1.65:6.
  • Silicon was incorporated into the carbon structure by mixing silicon powder directly with the gel prior to polymerization. After pyrolysis, the silicon was found to be encased in carbon matrix.
  • the silicon powder may be nano-sized ( ⁇ 1 micron) or micron-sized (between 1 and 100 microns).
  • the silicon-carbon composite was prepared by mechanically mixing for 10 minutes in a mortar and pestel, 1:1 by weight micronized silicon ( ⁇ 325 mesh) powder and micronized microporous non-activated carbon.
  • the silicon-carbon powder was mixed into a slurry with the composition 80:10:10 (silicon-carbon:conductivity enhancer (carbon black):binder (polyvinylidene fluoride)) in n-methyl pyrrolidone solvent then coated onto a copper current collector.
  • Other embodiments may utilize nano ( ⁇ 100 nm) silicon powder.
  • FIG. 13 depicts the voltage vs. specific capacity (mass relative to silicon) for this silicon-carbon composite.
  • FIG. 14 shows a TEM of a silicon particle embedded into a hard carbon particle.
  • a resorcinol-formaldehyde-iron composite gel was prepared by combining resorcinol, 37 wt % formaldehyde solution, methanol, and iron acetate in the weight ratio 31:46:19:4 until all components were dissolved. The mixture was kept at 45° C. for 24 hours until polymerization was complete. The gel was crushed and pyrolyzed at 650° C. for 1 hr in flowing nitrogen gas. Iron or manganese containing carbon materials are prepared in an analogous manner by use of nickel acetate or manganese acetate, respectively, instead of iron. Different pyrolysis temperatures (e.g., 900° C., 1000° C., etc.) may also be used.
  • Table 6 summarizes physical properties of metal doped carbon composites as determined by BET/porosimetry nitrogen physisorption.
  • FIG. 15 shows the modification to the electrochemical voltage profile with the addition of Ni-doping. Notice that both the shape of the voltage profile and the capacity can be tailored depending on the dopant, the quantity, and the processing conditions.
  • a resorcinol-formaldehyde gel mixture is prepared in a manner analogous to that described in Example 1.
  • About 20 mL of polymer solution is obtained (prior to placing solution at elevated temperature and generating the polymer gel).
  • about 5 mL of a saturated solution containing a salt of an electrochemical modifier is added.
  • the solution is then stored at 45° C. for about 5 h, followed by 24 h at 85° C. to fully induce the formation of a polymer gel containing the electrochemical modifier. This gel is disrupted to create particles, and the particles are frozen in liquid nitrogen.
  • the resulting wet polymer gel is then pyrolyzed by heating from room temperature to 850° C. under nitrogen gas at a ramp rate of 20° C. per min to obtain a hard carbon containing the electrochemical modifier.
  • a resorcinol-formaldehyde gel was prepared as in Example 1 but during the solution phase (before addition of formaldehyde) graphite powder (99:1 w/w resorcinol/graphite) was added while stirring. The solution was continually stirred until gellation occurred at which point the resin was allowed to cure at 85° C. for 24 hours followed by pyrolysis (10° C./min ramp rate) at 1100° C. for 1 hour in flowing nitrogen. The electrochemical performance typical of this material is seen in FIGS. 16 and 17 . This material is extremely unique as it shows both hard carbon and graphite phases during lithiation and delithiation.
  • Example 3 The material from Example 3 is tested in lithium ion battery half-cells as previously described.
  • the laminate thickness is 40 microns after calendaring.
  • FIG. 18 compares the performance of the two cells using different lower voltage cut-offs for graphite. It is well known that graphite performs poorly when cycled below zero volts due to lithium plating and irreversible capacity. Notice that the capacity of graphite with a 0 V cut-off window displays stable cycling. However, when the voltage window is widened to ⁇ 15 mV, the reversible capacity is actually lower and unstable.
  • FIG. 19 compares the performance of the hard carbon two cells using different lower voltage cut-offs for graphite. Both the differential capacities and the voltage profiles show that the insertion mechanism for lithium is identical for both voltage windows. The cycling stability plot indicates that a negative voltage cut-off provides a 25% increase in capacity with no stability losses. This is drastically different than the graphite, where the capacity was lower and unstable. It is clear that hard carbons do not undergo the same detrimental lithium plating as in graphite. This may be due to the change in overpotential for lithium plating, associated with the insertion of lithium into the pores of the hard carbon anode material.
  • PIXE proton induced x-ray emission
  • the ultrapure synthetic activated carbons according to the instant disclosure have a lower PIXE impurity content and lower ask content as compared to other known carbon samples.
  • Silicon-oxide is incorporated into the carbon through the Si-containing precursors added to the gel phase.
  • a stock solution of RF is synthesized in using resorcinol, water and formaldehyde with 35% solids and a ratio of 1:2 R:F.
  • a 35% solids tetraethylorthosilane (TEOS) stock solution is mixed using ethanol as a solvent in a ratio of 1:3 R:TEOS.
  • the TEOS stock solution is slowly added to the RF stock solution and stirred 40° C. until a gel is formed.
  • the sample is sealed and heated at 70° C. After curing, the resulting gel is pyrolyzed at 600° C.
  • the SiO x /C composite can be further activated to increase porosity and accessibility to the Si.
  • the SiO x /C sample was heated to 950° C. at 20° C./min at which point the gas is switched to CO 2 and held for 1.5 hours then cooled to room temperature under nitrogen.
  • Silicon powder can be added prior to polymerization of the resin.
  • the amounts of reagents can be tailored based on the desired ratio of carbon to silicon powder in the final product.
  • An RF resin was synthesized using resorcinol, water, formaldehyde and acetic acid with 35% solids and a ratio of 1:2 R:F and 25:1 R:AA. Once the solids were fully dissolved, silicon powder was slowly added to achieve a 1:1 weight ratio carbon/silicon after pyrolysis. The silicon was further dispersed through high-energy sonication. Finally, the solution was heated to 85° C. until polymerization occurs. The resulting silicon-RF gel was then crushed and pyrolyzed under nitrogen flow at 600° C. to yield Si/C composite.
  • the gel can be freeze dried so as to retain the pore structure to benefit the silicon expansion upon lithiation.
  • the silicon powder can be in a variety of forms including, but not limited to, particles, wires, whiskers and rods. The size can range from 1 nanometer to 1 mm.
  • Silicon can be incorporated into RF sol through emulsion to fully encapsulate the silicon powder.
  • a 200:1 v/v solution of cyclohexane and SPAN80 surfactant is prepared.
  • the silicon-RF sol was prepared from example 2 through high energy sonication. The solution was added to the surfactant solution and allowed to fully polymerize at 45° C. Once the gel fully polymerized, the gel particles were removed using filter paper and pyrolyzed as in example 2 to yield Si/C composite.
  • the gel precursor can be prepared as a suspension in which the cyclohexane is substituted for mineral oil and no surfactant is added. The mineral oil is heated to 85° C. while stirring then the silicon-sol from example 2 is added and allowed to polymerize ( ⁇ 4 hrs).
  • Silicon-C nanocomposite was placed in an alumina crucible and heated in a tube furnace under nitrogen flow to 800° C. The nitrogen flow was diverted through a flask containing liquid cyclohexane. The organic cyclohexane vapor was carried for 1 hour into the hot zone of the furnace and carbonized on the surface of the silicon particles leaving behind a soft carbon coating.
  • the organic species used can be any non-oxygen bearing compound (e.g., ethylene, toluene, propane, benzene, etc.).
  • the peak temperature can be reduced or increased to allow a longer or shorter vapor phase lifetime for the organic species, respectively.
  • the dwell time at peak temperature can be reduced or increased to yield a thinner or thicker carbon coating, respectively.
  • Silicon powder and carbon powder were ground together using a Fritchmill for 15 minutes to yield a Si/C composite.
  • the average particle size of the silicon powder ranges from 10 nm-50 um while the carbon powder particle size ranges from 1 um-50 um.
  • the weight ratios of silicon-carbon range from 1:4-5:1.
  • the silicon can be in a crystalline or amorphous phase while the carbon is in an amorphous phase.
  • the resulting Si/C composite can be CVD coated as in example 4 so as to better bind contact between the silicon and carbon.
  • the SiOx/C composite from Example 1 was heated under nitrogen to 1900° C. and held for 1 hour or until the desired ratio of Si:C is achieved, then cooled to room temperature. Additional carbon can be mechanically mixed prior to reduction. Alternatively, the reaction can be carried out under hydrogen gas or in vacuum so as to better facilitate the reduction process and minimize side reactions.
  • the SiO x /C composite in Example 1 was added to Ca powder in a molar ratio of 1:1.9 SiO x :Ca and mixed until homogenous.
  • the powder was poured into alumina crucible and place into tube furnace.
  • the crucible was covered, but not sealed from gas, and heated to 720° C. at a ramp of 20° C./min under nitrogen flow and held for 1 hour.
  • the resulting Si/C composite can be further washed with nitric acid to remove excess calcium compounds.
  • the SiO x /C composite in Example 1 was added to Mg powder in a molar ratio of 1:1.9 SiO x :Mg and mixed until homogenous.
  • the powder was poured into alumina crucible and place into tube furnace.
  • the crucible was covered, but not sealed from gas, and heated to 720° C. at a ramp of 20° C./min under nitrogen flow and held for 1 hour.
  • the resulting Si/C composite can be further washed with nitric acid to remove excess magnesium compounds.
  • the granular SiOx/C material from Example 1 was placed in a non-reactive metal crucible (e.g., steel, nickel, Inconel).
  • the container was filled with calcium chloride powder and the entire container was positioned in the center of a vertical tube furnace.
  • An Inconel wire was connected to the metal crucible and extended outside the furnace (anode terminal).
  • a graphite rod (cathode terminal) connected to a steel rod was positioned in contact with the calcium chloride powder in the hot zone of the furnace.
  • the furnace was sealed and continuously purged with nitrogen gas then ramped up to 850° C. and held at which point the calcium chloride became molten.
  • the analogous reaction can be carried out in a room temperature ionic liquid in place of the molten calcium chloride.
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was dissolved in acetone (50:50). Phthalic Anhydride (25:75) was added to the solution and shaken until dissolved. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the solution and shaken. The reaction solution was placed at elevated temperature (55° C. for about 12 hr followed by curing at 120° C. for 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was dissolved in acetone (50:50). 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the solution and shaken. The reaction solution was placed at elevated temperature (55° C. for about 12 hr followed by curing at 120° C. for 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was heated to elevated temperature (85° C. unless otherwise stated) and mixed continuously. Phthalic Anhydride (25:75) was added to the viscous liquid epoxy and mixed until dissolved. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the liquid solution and mixed until solid. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ⁇ 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was heated to elevated temperature (85° C. unless otherwise stated) and mixed continuously. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the liquid solution and mixed until solid. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ⁇ 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the monolith or solvent-less process described above in samples 1-4. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water (varying amount from 1% to 40% wt/wt) was then added to the liquid solution containing a Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] and mixed. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ⁇ 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the monolith or solvent-less process described above in samples 1-5. Phthalic Anhydride (varying amount from 0% to 40% wt/wt) was then added to the liquid epoxy solution containing a Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] and mixed. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the liquid solution and mixed. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ⁇ 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • the raw materials and several iterations of the resin were analyzed with a Thermo Fischer Scientific Nicolet iS10 FTIR spectrometer with an ATR accessory.
  • the FTIR spectra of the neat epoxy resin ( ⁇ 570 MW), phosphoric acid (31.5% conc.), and the epoxy-P resin (20 wt % acid) are shown in FIGS. 30 and 31 .
  • the phosphoric acid was diluted from 85 wt % with deionized water for the safety of the instrument.
  • the FTIR spectra show that the cured resin is chemically different than the two reactants.
  • One notable difference between the neat epoxy and the epoxy-P resin is the disappearance of the epoxide bending vibration at ⁇ 910 cm ⁇ 1 .
  • FIG. 32 shows the effect of phosphoric acid loading on the epoxide content of the epoxy-P resin. With the addition of ⁇ 10% H 3 PO 4 , the remaining concentration of epoxide groups was below the instrument detection limit.
  • a sample of novalac epoxy and phosphoric acid was mixed in the melt state in a 3:1 molar ration (epoxy to phosphoric acid).
  • the resin was cured at 120° C. for 12 hour.
  • the TGA test was performed under N2 at 10° C./min ramp rate.
  • the TGA data are depicted in FIG. 33 .
  • the exotherm at 250° C. could be explained by a reaction of the phosphoric acid and remaining unreacted epoxy groups that may control resin 3-D structure resulting in a desirable carbon structure and both improved gravimetric capacity and first cycle efficiency vs. the unmodified epoxy resin.
  • Exemplary carbons produced according to the various examples above were tested for phosphorus content by TXRF spectroscopy. Carbon was synthesized from reins produced using both the solvent process (as in Examples 4, 22, 23, 26, 27) and solvent-less process (as in Examples 4, 24, 25, 26, 27) were analyzed. A Bruker S2 PICOFOX spectrometer was used for the study. Samples were prepared by milling to achieve a D(1.00) ⁇ 100 ⁇ m particle size, then making a suspension consisting of the milled carbon, ethylene glycol, and Ga as an internal standard. Aliquots were placed on optically flat quartz disks and dried, leaving a thin residue for analysis. The results of the analysis, and the amount of phosphoric acid added during resin synthesis, are summarized in the table below Table 4.
  • a Polymer resin was prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with between 300 and 600 repeating molecular units and an 85% phosphoric acid aqueous solution were mixed and cured via an extrusions process.
  • the cured polymer resin was pyrolyzed in a rotary kiln according to the methods described generally herein.
  • the hard carbon was the examined for its electrochemical properties generally according to the methods described herein. Electrochemical data is described in Table 5.
  • a polymer sol was prepared by dissolving polyphenylglycidylether-co-formaldehyde (PPGEF) polymer in acetone solvent (1:20 v/v) inside a sealed plastic container. Once the resin was dissolved, silicon powder (1:5 w/w resin to silicon) is added to the solution and dispersed via sonication followed by vortexing (shaking) The dispersed silicon/resin solution was transferred to an open container on a hot plate where it is continuously stirred (300 rpm) and heated (85° C.). At this point, phosphoric acid was added to the solution (equal to 20 wt % of the resin in solution). The solution continues to stir and heat until either solvent loss or polymerization leads to disruption of the stirring process. The silicon-gel is transferred to an oven set to 120° C. and cured for >8 hours.
  • PGEF polyphenylglycidylether-co-formaldehyde
  • a solventless preparation process can be used analogous to Example 32 without the use of acetone.
  • PPGEF resin is stirred and heated on a hot plate wherein the silicon powder is added and allowed to disperse within the resin for >1 hour.
  • phosphoric acid (20 wt % to resin) is added to react with the resin thus causing polymerization of the silicon dispersed gel. This is cured at a temperature of 120° C. for >8 hours.
  • the resin in another solventless embodiment, can be in the form of a solid rather than a liquid in this case 1:1 w/w mixture of Bisphenol A (BPA) and hexamethylentramine (HMT).
  • BPA/HMT in powder form is mechanically mixed with silicon powder (0.5:0.5:1.8 w/w/w) to form a homogeneous powder mixture. This is cured at 130° C. for 16 hours to produce the silicon-gel composite.
  • silicon incased in a polymer sol can be prepared.
  • melamine is allowed to dissolve in water through stirring and heating. Once dissolved, a formaldehyde solution is then added and stirred until the solution becomes clear. A suspension of silicon particles in water is then added to the melamine/formaldehyde solution. Next, a solution of TWEEN80 surfactant and water is then added and allowed to stir for 10 minutes. Finally, 1M HCl is added to catalyze the reaction. The mixture is then cured for 12 hours at 100° C. to produce silicon particles incased in melamine/formaldehyde polymer.
  • silicon particles incased in polymer resin can be prepared using a Resorcinol/Formaldehyde polymer.
  • Resorcinol is dissolved in water on a hot plate while stirring. Ammonium acetate and SnCl2 are added to the solution and held for 10 minutes. Glacial acetic acid is then added and the solution is mixed for 12 hours.
  • cyclohexane and SPAN80 5 wt %) are mixed and heated to 80° C.
  • Formaldehyde is added to the resorcinol solution and held for 10 minutes.
  • the Resorcinol/Formaldehyde solution is then added to the stirring and heated cyclohexane solution.
  • the resin is then cured for 4 hours at 80° C.
  • the resulting resin is filtered out and dried in an oven at 100° C. for 12 hours.
  • Pyrolysis of silicon-gels is carried out such that resins produced in Examples 32-35 are heated (@10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it is held for 1 hour and then ramped down to room temperature.
  • the silicon particles employed are sized for the appropriate application.
  • the particles can be nano-sized (i.e., nanoparticles) or micron sized, or combinations thereof.
  • the silicon particles used range in size from about 10 nm to about 50 nm or from about 50 nm to about 200 nm.
  • materials are prepared using silicon particles have a size ranging from about 10 nm to about 200 nm, from about 200 nm to about 500 nm or from about 500 nm to about 1000 nm.
  • Micron sized particles are also used for preparation of the above materials and such particles generally have a size ranging from about 1000 nm to about 1500 nm or from about 1500 nm to about 2000 nm.
  • Other exemplary procedures include use of silicon particles ranging in size from about 2000 nm to about 4000 nm or from about 4000 nm to about 6000 nm.
  • Composite-resins produced in Example 32-35 are pyrolyzed in the presence of hydrocarbon vapor.
  • the silicon-gel is heated (@ 10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it holds for 1 hour then ramps down to room temperature.
  • the nitrogen flow is first bubbled through a chamber containing liquid xylene.
  • the xylene vapors are then carried into the tube furnace hot zone containing the silicon-gel sample where the xylene vapor then decomposes on the surface of the Si/C material where it chemically deposits (CVD) carbon on the surface.
  • Alternative hydrocarbons can be used including ethylene, cyclohexane, toluene, and propane.
  • Micronization of silicon-carbon or silicone-gel is done such that material produced in examples 32-37 are milled in an automated mortar and pestle (Fritsch Mill) for 20 minutes using 15-20 deca-Newtons of downward force. The resulting material is then removed from the mill and run through a 38 micron sieve.
  • micronization techniques can be done by running the materials produced in example 1-7 through a JetMill using 120 PSI of nitrogen or air to force the granular material into the mill. The resulting material is then milled down to micron size and can be measured using a Mastersizer 3000.
  • FIG. 27 shows the electrochemical stability and behavior of an exemplary high electrochemical modifier content composite, cycled between 1 and 50 mV. As the electrochemical modifier content increases, the capacity also increases. The highest capacity is seen for the 90% electrochemical modifier loading while the most stable performance is with the 50% electrochemical modifier loading.
  • FIG. 28 depicts exemplary composites wherein the electrochemical modifier content is low (5-15%) when compared to the carbon. All of these composites display strong stability though a lower capacity when compared to the high electrochemical modifier content composites.
  • Post-carbonization surface treatments of the composite can be carried out on materials produced from examples 36-38.
  • the material is heated (@10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it holds for 1 hour then ramps down to room temperature.
  • example 10 can be carried out with additional gas during heating.
  • a material is heated (@ 10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it is held for 1 hour then ramps down to room temperature.
  • the nitrogen flow is first bubbled through a chamber containing liquid xylene.
  • the xylene vapors are then carried into the tube furnace hot zone containing the silicon-gel sample where the xylene vapor then decomposes on the surface of the Si/C material where it chemically deposits (CVD) carbon on the surface.
  • Alternative hydrocarbons can be used including methane, ethane, ethylene, cyclohexane, toluene, propane or combinations thereof
  • the composite can be synthesized via vapor phase chemical reactions.
  • a typical experiment 0.5 grams of activated carbon is placed in an alumina crucible and positioned in the center (hot zone) of a tube furnace. Upstream of the carbon is another crucible containing 6 grams of zinc metal powder. The furnace is sealed then purged continuously with nitrogen gas at ⁇ 300 cc/min flow rate. The temperature is ramped at 20° C./min to a peak temperature of 850° C. At peak temperature the gas flow is diverted through a flask containing silicon tetrachloride liquid. The silicon tetrachloride vapors are carried into the furnace where it reacts in the vapor phase with zinc vapors (produced from the molten zinc metal).
  • the zinc metal chemically reduces the silicon tetrachloride to elemental silicon, which deposits as solid nanoparticles on the surface and pores of the carbon within the hot zone of the furnace.
  • the process is allowed to continue for 1 hour at room temperature before switching the gas flow to pure nitrogen and cooling to room temperature.
  • the resulting Si/C composite is collected in the crucible at the end.
  • the composite can be using a different silicon precursor vapor and no zinc metal.
  • a typical experiment 0.5 grams of activated carbon is placed in an alumina crucible then positioned in the center (hot zone) of a tube furnace. The furnace is sealed then purged continuously with nitrogen gas at ⁇ 300 cc/min flow rate. The temperature is ramped at 20° C./min to a peak temperature of 550° C. At peak temperature the gas flow is switched to a mixed gas of 5 mol % Silane (SiH4)/argon. This gas mixture enters the hot zone of the furnace and thermally decomposes on the surface and pores of the carbon into elemental silicon nanoparticles. The reaction is allowed to continue for 1 hr before the gas flow is diverted back to pure nitrogen and then cooled to room temperature. The resulting Si/C composite is collected in the crucible at the end.
  • an epoxy-acetone solution is prepared by weighing out 10 grams of PPGEF epoxy resin into a plastic container then 10 mL of acetone is added and mixed to fully dissolve the resin.
  • 0.2 grams of iron oxide nanopowder is added to the solution and dispersed via sonication for 1 hr then vortexing for 4 hours.
  • the suspension is poured into a beaker on a hot plate where it is heated to 80° C. and stirred continuously at 300 rpm.
  • phosphoric acid is added to the solution then allowed to react. When the gelation reaction causes disruption in the stirring the gel is transferred to a convection oven where it is allowed to cure for 12 hours at 120° C.
  • An epoxy-acetone solution is prepared by weighing out 10 grams of PPGEF epoxy resin into a plastic container then 10 mL of acetone is added and mixed to fully dissolve the resin. Next 0.3 grams of manganese acetate is added to the solution and dissolved via sonication for 1 hr then vortexing for 4 hours. At this point, the solution is poured into a beaker on a hot plate where it is heated to 80° C. and stirred continuously at 300 rpm. Lastly 0.2 grams of phosphoric acid is added to the solution then allowed to react. When the gelation reaction causes disruption in the stirring the gel is transferred to a convection oven where it is allowed to cure for 12 hours at 120° C.
  • Metal carbon composite prepared using an incipient wetness technique
  • 1 grams of tin chloride is dissolved in 10 mL of acetone. This solution is gradually dripped onto the surface of milled activated carbon until the point of saturation at which point it is dried in a convection oven at 80° C. for 15 minutes. The process is continued until all of the tin chloride solution has been consumed.
  • the final tin chloride/carbon material is heated to 800° C. for 1 hr in a tube furnace under flowing nitrogen to produce the Sn/C composite.

Abstract

The present application is generally directed to composites comprising a hard carbon material and an electrochemical modifier. The composite materials find utility in any number of electrical devices, for example, in lithium ion batteries. Methods for making the disclosed composite materials are also disclosed.

Description

    BACKGROUND
  • 1. Technical Field
  • The present invention generally relates to composite carbon materials, methods for making the same and devices containing the same.
  • 2. Description of the Related Art
  • Lithium-based electrical storage devices have potential to replace devices currently used in any number of applications. For example, current lead acid automobile batteries are not adequate for next generation all-electric and hybrid electric vehicles due to irreversible, stable sulfate formations during discharge. Lithium ion batteries are a viable alternative to the lead-based systems currently used due to their capacity, and other considerations. Carbon is one of the primary materials used in both lithium secondary batteries and hybrid lithium-ion capacitors (LIC). The carbon anode typically stores lithium between layered graphite sheets through a mechanism called intercalation. Traditional lithium ion batteries are comprised of a graphitic carbon anode and a metal oxide cathode; however such graphitic anodes typically suffer from low power performance and limited capacity.
  • Silicon, Tin, and other lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers have also been proposed based on their ability to store very large amounts of lithium per unit weight. However, these materials are fundamentally limited by the substantial swelling that occurs when they are fully lithiated. This swelling and shrinkage when the lithium is removed results in an electrode that has limited cycle life and low power. The solution thus far has been to use very small amounts of alloying electrochemical modifier in a largely carbon electrode, but this approach does not impart the desired increase in lithium capacity. Finding a way to increase the alloying electrochemical modifier content in an anode composition while maintaining cycle stability is desired to increase capacity. A number of approaches have been utilized involving nano-structured alloying electrochemical modifier, blends of carbon with alloying electrochemical modifier, or deposition of alloying electrochemical modifier onto carbon using vacuum or high temperature. However none of these processes has proven to combine a scalable process that results in the desired properties.
  • Hard carbon materials have been proposed for use in lithium ion batteries, but the physical and chemical properties of known hard carbon materials are not optimized for use as anodes in lithium-based batteries. Thus, anodes comprising known hard carbon materials still suffer from many of the disadvantages of limited capacity and low first cycle efficiency. Hard carbon materials having properties optimized for use in lithium-based batteries are expected to address these deficiencies and provide other related advantages.
  • While significant advances have been made in the field, there continues to be a need in the art for improved hard carbon materials and for improvements to the approaches used for incorporating alloying electrochemical modifiers into these carbons in order to result in the desired material properties and electrochemical performance needed in electrical energy storage devices (e.g., lithium ion batteries). The present invention fulfills these needs and provides further related advantages.
  • BRIEF SUMMARY
  • In general terms, the current invention is directed to novel hard carbon materials and their composites that contain high lithium capacity alloying electrochemical modifiers with optimized lithium storage and utilization properties. The novel composite materials find utility in any number of electrical energy storage devices, for example as electrode material in lithium-based electrical energy storage devices (e.g., lithium ion batteries). Electrodes comprising the composite materials display high reversible capacity, high first cycle efficiency, high power performance or any combination thereof. While not wishing to be bound by theory, the present inventors believe that such improved electrochemical performance is related, at least in part, to the carbon materials' physical and chemical properties such as surface area, pore structure, crystallinity, surface chemistry and/or other properties, the approach that is used to deposit the alloying electrochemical modifier and/or the resulting structure of the alloying electrochemical modifier within the carbon material as discussed in more detail herein. Furthermore, certain electrochemical modifiers can be incorporated on the surface of and/or in the carbon material to further tune the desired properties.
  • Accordingly, in one embodiments the present disclosure provides a composite material having a first cycle insertion of at least 700 mAh/g and a first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation of greater than 70% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, wherein the composite material comprises a carbon material and a lithium alloying electrochemical modifier.
  • In certain embodiments, the first cycle insertion is at least 1000 mAh/g and the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 80%. In other embodiments, the first cycle insertion is at least 2400 mAh/g and the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 80%. In still other embodiments of the foregoing, the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 90%.
  • In other embodiments of any of the foregoing composites, the composite material further comprises a first cycle extraction of at least 600 mAh/g and a fifth cycle retention of greater than 99%. For example, in some embodiments the first cycle extraction is at least 1200 mAh/g.
  • In various other embodiments of the disclosed composite materials the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier is silicon, tin, germanium, nickel, aluminum, manganese, Al2O3, titanium, titanium oxide, sulfur, molybdenum, arsenic, gallium, phosphorous, selenium, antimony, bismuth, tellurium or indium or combinations thereof. For example, in some specific embodiments the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier is silicon.
  • Various forms of the composite are also provided. For example in some embodiments, the composite material comprises particles having a core-shell structure, wherein the shell comprises substantially the carbon material and the core comprises substantially the electrochemical modifier. In other embodiments, the composite material comprises particles having a core-shell structure wherein the core comprises substantially the carbon material and the shell comprises substantially the electrochemical modifier. In still other embodiments, the composite material comprises particles of the carbon material, carbon material particles encapsulating a plurality of particles of the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier.
  • In certain embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises nanoparticles. For example, in certain embodiments the electrochemical modifier comprises particles having a particle size ranging from 10 nm to 500 nm.
  • Various ratios of carbon and electrochemical modifier are present in the disclosed composite materials. In some embodiments, a ratio of carbon material to electrochemical modifier ranges from 40:1 to 1:99 on a mass basis. In other embodiments, a ratio of carbon material to electrochemical modifier ranges from 19:1 to 1:9 on a mass basis.
  • In still more embodiments, the composite material further comprises an efficiency enhancing electrochemical modifier. For example, in some embodiments the efficiency enhancing electrochemical modifier comprises phosphorus and in further embodiments the phosphorous is present in the composite material at 3-13% as measured by TXRF.
  • The presence of other elements in the composite material may affect the electrochemical performance thereof. Accordingly, in some embodiments the composite material comprises a total of less than 200 ppm of all elements having atomic numbers ranging from 11 to 92, excluding any intentionally added electrochemical modifier, as measured by TXRF.
  • In various embodiments of any of the foregoing, the carbon material is a hard carbon material.
  • In other aspects, the present disclosure is directed to a composite material having a first cycle extraction of at least 1900 mAh/g and a first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation of greater than 80% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, wherein the composite material comprises silicon and carbon material in a ratio ranging from about 8.5:1 to about 9.5:1 by weight and further comprising 3-13% phosphorus. In other related embodiments, the ratio of silicon to carbon is about 9:1.
  • Methods for preparing the composite materials are also provided. For example, in one embodiment the disclosure provides a method for preparing a composite material, the composite material comprising a carbon material and a lithium alloying electrochemical modifier, the method comprising:
  • A) copolymerizing one or more polymer precursors in the presence of the electrochemical modifier or a compound comprising the electrochemical modifier to obtain a polymer gel; and
  • B) pyrolyzing the polymer gel to obtain the composite material.
  • In further embodiments of the foregoing method, the polymer precursor comprises polyphenylglycidylether-co-formaldehyde polymer, and copolymerizing further comprises reacting the polymer precursors in the presence of phosphoric acid.
  • In other embodiments of the method, the electrochemical modifier comprises silicon. In still other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier or the compound comprising the electrochemical modifier is brought into contact with a composition comprising the polymer precursors before initiation of polymerization.
  • In different embodiments of the disclosed methods, the electrochemical modifier or the compound comprising the electrochemical modifier is brought into contact with a composition comprising the polymer precursors after initiation of polymerization.
  • In still other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier is in the form of particles, for example nanoparticles.
  • In still more embodiments, the disclosure is directed to an electrode comprising any of the composite materials described herein. Devices comprising such electrodes are also provided.
  • In more embodiments, an electrical energy storage device is provided, the device comprising:
  • a) at least one anode comprising any of the composite materials disclosed herein;
  • b) at least one cathode comprising a metal oxide; and
  • c) an electrolyte comprising lithium ions.
  • In further embodiments of the foregoing, the device is a lithium ion battery or hybrid lithium ion capacitor.
  • Use of the disclosed composite materials for storage or distribution of electrical energy is also provided.
  • These and other aspects of the invention will be apparent upon reference to the following detailed description. To this end, various references are set forth herein which describe in more detail certain background information, procedures, compounds and/or compositions, and are each hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • In the figures, identical reference numbers identify similar elements. The sizes and relative positions of elements in the figures are not necessarily drawn to scale and some of these elements are arbitrarily enlarged and positioned to improve figure legibility. Further, the particular shapes of the elements as drawn are not intended to convey any information regarding the actual shape of the particular elements, and have been solely selected for ease of recognition in the figures.
  • FIG. 1 depicts pore size distribution of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 2 shows electrochemical performance of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 3 presents pore size distributions of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 4 depicts RAMAN spectra of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 5 is a plot of an x-ray diffraction pattern of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 6 shows an example SAXS plot along with the calculation of the empirical R value for determining internal pore structure.
  • FIG. 7 presents SAXS of three exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 8 a presents FTIR spectra of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 8 b shows electrochemical performance of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 9 presents electrochemical performance of a carbon material before and after hydrocarbon surface treatment.
  • FIG. 10 is a graph showing pore size distribution of a carbon material before and after hydrocarbon surface treatment
  • FIG. 11 presents first cycle voltage profiles of exemplary carbon materials.
  • FIG. 12 is a graph showing the electrochemical stability of an exemplary carbon material compared to graphitic carbon.
  • FIG. 13 shows voltage versus specific capacity data for a silicon-carbon composite material.
  • FIG. 14 shows a TEM of a silicon particle embedded into a hard carbon particle
  • FIG. 15 depicts electrochemical performance of hard carbon materials comprising an electrochemical modifier.
  • FIG. 16 shows electrochemical performance of hard carbon materials comprising graphite.
  • FIG. 17 is a graph showing electrochemical performance of hard carbon materials comprising graphite.
  • FIG. 18 presents the differential capacity, the voltage profile and the stability of graphitic materials cycled at different voltage profiles.
  • FIG. 19 presents the differential capacity, the voltage profile and the stability of hard carbon materials cycled at different voltage profiles.
  • FIG. 20 is a graph of a wide angle XPS spectrum for an exemplary carbon material.
  • FIG. 21 presents an Auger scan using XPS methods for an exemplary carbon material having approximately 65% sp2 hybridized carbons.
  • FIG. 22 depicts a SAXS measurement, internal pore analysis and domain size of exemplary hard carbon material
  • FIG. 23 demonstrates the effect on pH as the pyrolysis temperature increases for a representative carbon material.
  • FIG. 24 shows Li:C ratio for an exemplary carbon material as a function of pH from 7 to 7.5.
  • FIG. 25 presents the capacity of an exemplary, ultrapure hard carbon.
  • FIG. 26 is another graph showing the capacity of an exemplary, ultrapure hard carbon.
  • FIG. 27 presents specific extraction capacity data for exemplary carbon-silicon composites.
  • FIG. 28 provides specific extraction capacity data for exemplary carbon-silicon composites.
  • FIG. 29 provides first cycle efficiency data.
  • FIG. 30 shows FTIR spectra of neat epoxy resin (1), diluted phosphoric acid (2) and cured epoxy-P resin (3).
  • FIG. 31 shows the spectra from FIG. 30, sized to highlight the fingerprint region.
  • FIG. 32 shows the FTIR spectra of the neat epoxy resin (5), cured epoxy-P resin with 5% acid (4), 10% acid (1), 20% acid (3), and 40% acid (2). The viewing area of the spectra is sized to illustrate the epoxide bending absorbance band at ˜910 cm-1.
  • FIG. 33 presents example TGA data for polymer resin comprising phosphoric acid demonstrating an exothermic event at about 250 C.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION
  • In the following description, certain specific details are set forth in order to provide a thorough understanding of various embodiments. However, one skilled in the art will understand that the invention may be practiced without these details. In other instances, well-known structures have not been shown or described in detail to avoid unnecessarily obscuring descriptions of the embodiments. Unless the context requires otherwise, throughout the specification and claims which follow, the word “comprise” and variations thereof, such as, “comprises” and “comprising” are to be construed in an open, inclusive sense, that is, as “including, but not limited to.” Further, headings provided herein are for convenience only and do not interpret the scope or meaning of the claimed invention.
  • Reference throughout this specification to “one embodiment” or “an embodiment” means that a particular feature, structure or characteristic described in connection with the embodiment is included in at least one embodiment. Thus, the appearances of the phrases “in one embodiment” or “in an embodiment” in various places throughout this specification are not necessarily all referring to the same embodiment. Furthermore, the particular features, structures, or characteristics may be combined in any suitable manner in one or more embodiments. Also, as used in this specification and the appended claims, the singular forms “a,” “an,” and “the” include plural referents unless the content clearly dictates otherwise. It should also be noted that the term “or” is generally employed in its sense including “and/or” unless the content clearly dictates otherwise.
  • As used herein, and unless the context dictates otherwise, the following terms have the meanings as specified below.
  • “Carbon material” refers to a material or substance comprised substantially of carbon. Carbon materials include ultrapure as well as amorphous and crystalline carbon materials. Examples of carbon materials include, but are not limited to, activated carbon, pyrolyzed dried polymer gels, pyrolyzed polymer cryogels, pyrolyzed polymer xerogels, pyrolyzed polymer aerogels, activated dried polymer gels, activated polymer cryogels, activated polymer xerogels, activated polymer aerogels and the like. “Carbon material” is also referred to herein as the “carbon component” with respect to the disclosed composites. Throughout the description herein, “carbon material” and/or “carbon component” refers to the carbon material or carbon component, respectively, in the absence of electrochemical modifier (which is typically present in the disclosed composites).
  • “Hard Carbon” refers to a non-graphitizable carbon material. At elevated temperatures (e.g., >1500° C.) a hard carbon remains substantially amorphous, whereas a “soft” carbon will undergo crystallization and become graphitic.
  • “Modified hard carbon” or “composite material” refer to material comprising both carbon and an electrochemical modifier such as a lithium alloying material, such as silicon, tin, germanium, nickel, aluminum, manganese, Al2O3, titanium, titanium oxide, sulfur, molybdenum, arsenic, gallium, phosphorous, selenium, antimony, bismuth, tellurium or indium or any other metal or semi-metal that is capable of lithium uptake. In some embodiments, the carbon and lithium alloying material are intimately integrated through chemical bonding or in other embodiments the two materials are a distinct mixture between two powders. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise an efficiency enhancer.
  • “Allotrope” refers to a material which can exists in different forms. C60, graphene, diamond, hard carbon, soft carbon, graphite, and carbon nanotubes are non-limiting examples of carbon allotropes.
  • “First cycle efficiency” refers to the percent difference in volumetric or gravimetric capacity between the initial charge and the first discharge cycle of a lithium battery. First cycle efficiency is calculated by the following formula: (F2/F1)×100), where F1 and F2 are the volumetric or gravimetric capacity of the initial lithium insertion and the first cycle lithium extraction, respectively.
  • “Electrochemical modifier” refers to any chemical element, compound comprising a chemical element or any combination of different chemical elements and compounds which enhances the electrochemical performance of a carbon material. Electrochemical modifiers can change (increase or decrease) the resistance, capacity, efficiency, power performance, stability and/or other properties of a carbon material. Electrochemical modifiers generally impart a desired electrochemical effect. In contrast, an impurity in a carbon material is generally undesired and tends to degrade, rather than enhance, the electrochemical performance of the carbon material. Examples of electrochemical modifiers within the context of the present disclosure include, but are not limited to, elements, and compounds or oxides comprising elements, in groups 12-15 of the periodic table, other elements such as silicon, tin, sulfur, and tungsten and combinations thereof. For example, electrochemical modifiers include, but are not limited to, tin, silicon, tungsten, silver, zinc, molybdenum, iron, nickel, aluminum, manganese and combinations thereof as well as oxides of the same and compounds comprising the same. In certain embodiments, the electrochemical modifier is a lithium alloying material, such as silicon, tin, germanium, nickel, aluminum, manganese, Al2O3, titanium, titanium oxide, sulfur, molybdenum, arsenic, gallium, phosphorous, selenium, antimony, bismuth, tellurium or indium or any other metal or semi-metal that is capable of lithium uptake.
  • “Efficiency enhancer” refers to a sub-class of electrochemical modifier that can increase the first cycle efficiency of a carbon material. In certain embodiments, the potency of an efficiency enhancer is dependent on the method of its incorporation into the carbon material.
  • Group 12” elements include zinc (Zn), cadmium (Cd), mercury (Hg), and copernicium (Cn).
  • Group 13” elements include boron (B), aluminum (Al), gallium (Ga), indium (In) and thallium (Tl).
  • Group 14” elements include carbon (C), silicon (Si), germanium (Ge), tin (Sn) and lead (Pb).
  • Group 15” elements include nitrogen (N), phosphorous (P), arsenic (As), antimony (Sb) and bismuth (Bi).
  • “Amorphous” refers to a material, for example an amorphous carbon material, whose constituent atoms, molecules, or ions are arranged randomly without a regular repeating pattern. Amorphous materials may have some localized crystallinity (i.e., regularity) but lack long-range order of the positions of the atoms. Pyrolyzed and/or activated carbon materials are generally amorphous.
  • “Crystalline” refers to a material whose constituent atoms, molecules, or ions are arranged in an orderly repeating pattern. Examples of crystalline carbon materials include, but are not limited to, diamond and graphene.
  • “Synthetic” refers to a substance which has been prepared by chemical means rather than from a natural source. For example, a synthetic carbon material is one which is synthesized from precursor materials and is not isolated from natural sources.
  • “Impurity” or “impurity element” refers to an undesired foreign substance (e.g., a chemical element) within a material which differs from the chemical composition of the base material. For example, an impurity in a carbon material or composite material refers to any element or combination of elements, other than carbon, which is present in the carbon material. Impurity levels are typically expressed in parts per million (ppm). Impurities do not include substances, such as electrochemical modifiers, which are purposely added to a carbon material or composite material.
  • “TXRF impurity,” “TXRF element,” “PIXE impurity” or “PIXE element” is any impurity element having an atomic number ranging from 11 to 92 (i.e., from sodium to uranium), excluding any intentionally added electrochemical modifier. The phrases “total TXRF impurity content,” “total TXRF impurity level,” “total PIXE impurity content” and “total PIXE impurity level” refer to the sum of all TXRF or PIXE impurities present in a sample, for example, a polymer gel, a carbon material or a composite material. Electrochemical modifiers are not considered TXRF PIXE impurities as they are a desired constituent of the composite materials. For example, in some embodiments an element may be added to a carbon material as an electrochemical modifier and will not be considered a TXRF or PIXE impurity, while in other embodiments the same element may not be a desired electrochemical modifier and, if present in the carbon material or composite material, will be considered a TXRF or PIXE impurity. TXRF impurity concentrations and identities may be determined by total x-ray reflection fluorescence (TXRF). PIXE impurity concentrations and identities may be determined by proton induced x-ray emission (PIXE).
  • “Ultrapure” refers to a substance having a total TXRF or PIXE impurity content of less than 0.050%. For example, an “ultrapure carbon material” is a carbon material having a total TXRF or PIXE impurity content of less than 0.050% (i.e., 500 ppm).
  • “Ash content” refers to the nonvolatile inorganic matter which remains after subjecting a substance to a high decomposition temperature. Herein, the ash content of a carbon material is calculated from the total TXRF or PIXE impurity content as measured by total x-ray reflection fluorescence, assuming that nonvolatile elements are completely converted to expected combustion products (i.e., oxides).
  • “Polymer” refers to a macromolecule comprised of two or more structural repeating units.
  • “Synthetic polymer precursor material” or “polymer precursor” refers to compounds used in the preparation of a synthetic polymer. Examples of polymer precursors that can be used in certain embodiments of the preparations disclosed herein include, but are not limited to, aldehydes (i.e., HC(═O)R, where R is an organic group), such as for example, methanal (formaldehyde); ethanal (acetaldehyde); propanal (propionaldehyde); butanal (butyraldehyde); glucose; benzaldehyde and cinnamaldehyde. Other exemplary polymer precursors include, but are not limited to, phenolic compounds such as phenol and polyhydroxy benzenes, such as dihydroxy or trihydroxy benzenes, for example, resorcinol (i.e., 1,3-dihydroxy benzene), catechol, hydroquinone, and phloroglucinol. Mixtures of two or more polyhydroxy benzenes are also contemplated within the meaning of polymer precursor.
  • “Monolithic” refers to a solid, three-dimensional structure that is not particulate in nature.
  • “Sol” refers to a colloidal suspension of precursor particles (e.g., polymer precursors), and the term “gel” refers to a wet three-dimensional porous network obtained by condensation or reaction of the precursor particles.
  • “Polymer gel” refers to a gel in which the network component is a polymer; generally a polymer gel is a wet (aqueous or non-aqueous based) three-dimensional structure comprised of a polymer formed from synthetic precursors or polymer precursors.
  • “Sol gel” refers to a sub-class of polymer gel where the polymer is a colloidal suspension that forms a wet three-dimensional porous network obtained by reaction of the polymer precursors.
  • “Polymer hydrogel” or “hydrogel” refers to a subclass of polymer gel or gel wherein the solvent for the synthetic precursors or monomers is water or mixtures of water and one or more water-miscible solvent.
  • “Acid” refers to any substance that is capable of lowering the pH of a solution. Acids include Arrhenius, Brønsted and Lewis acids. A “solid acid” refers to a dried or granular compound that yields an acidic solution when dissolved in a solvent. The term “acidic” means having the properties of an acid.
  • “Base” refers to any substance that is capable of raising the pH of a solution. Bases include Arrhenius, Brønsted and Lewis bases. A “solid base” refers to a dried or granular compound that yields basic solution when dissolved in a solvent. The term “basic” means having the properties of a base.
  • “Miscible” refers to the property of a mixture wherein the mixture forms a single phase over certain ranges of temperature, pressure, and composition.
  • “Catalyst” is a substance which alters the rate of a chemical reaction. Catalysts participate in a reaction in a cyclic fashion such that the catalyst is cyclically regenerated. The present disclosure contemplates catalysts which are sodium free. The catalyst used in the preparation of a ultrapure polymer gel as described herein can be any compound that facilitates the polymerization of the polymer precursors to form an ultrapure polymer gel. A “volatile catalyst” is a catalyst which has a tendency to vaporize at or below atmospheric pressure. Exemplary volatile catalysts include, but are not limited to, ammoniums salts, such as ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium carbonate, ammonium hydroxide, and combinations thereof.
  • “Solvent” refers to a substance which dissolves or suspends reactants (e.g., ultrapure polymer precursors) and provides a medium in which a reaction may occur. Examples of solvents useful in the preparation of the gels, ultrapure polymer gels, ultrapure synthetic carbon materials and ultrapure synthetic amorphous carbon materials disclosed herein include, but are not limited to, water, alcohols and mixtures thereof. Exemplary alcohols include ethanol, t-butanol, methanol and mixtures thereof. Such solvents are useful for dissolution of the synthetic ultrapure polymer precursor materials, for example dissolution of a phenolic or aldehyde compound. In addition, in some processes such solvents are employed for solvent exchange in a polymer hydrogel (prior to freezing and drying), wherein the solvent from the polymerization of the precursors, for example, resorcinol and formaldehyde, is exchanged for a pure alcohol. In one embodiment of the present application, a cryogel is prepared by a process that does not include solvent exchange.
  • “Dried gel” or “dried polymer gel” refers to a gel or polymer gel, respectively, from which the solvent, generally water, or mixture of water and one or more water-miscible solvents, has been substantially removed.
  • “Pyrolyzed dried polymer gel” refers to a dried polymer gel which has been pyrolyzed but not yet activated, while an “activated dried polymer gel” refers to a dried polymer gel which has been activated.
  • “Carbonizing”, “pyrolyzing”, “carbonization” and “pyrolysis” each refer to the process of heating a carbon-containing substance at a pyrolysis dwell temperature in an inert atmosphere (e.g., argon, nitrogen or combinations thereof) or in a vacuum such that the targeted material collected at the end of the process is primarily carbon.
  • “Pyrolyzed” refers to a material or substance, for example a carbon material, which has undergone the process of pyrolysis.
  • “Dwell temperature” refers to the temperature of the furnace during the portion of a process which is reserved for maintaining a relatively constant temperature (i.e., neither increasing nor decreasing the temperature). For example, the pyrolysis dwell temperature refers to the relatively constant temperature of the furnace during pyrolysis, and the activation dwell temperature refers to the relatively constant temperature of the furnace during activation.
  • “Pore” refers to an opening or depression in the surface, or a tunnel in a carbon material, such as for example activated carbon, pyrolyzed dried polymer gels, pyrolyzed polymer cryogels, pyrolyzed polymer xerogels, pyrolyzed polymer aerogels, activated dried polymer gels, activated polymer cryogels, activated polymer xerogels, activated polymer aerogels and the like. A pore can be a single tunnel or connected to other tunnels in a continuous network throughout the structure.
  • “Pore structure” refers to the layout of the surface of the internal pores within a carbon material, such as an activated carbon material. Components of the pore structure include pore size, pore volume, surface area, density, pore size distribution and pore length. Generally the pore structure of activated carbon material comprises micropores and mesopores.
  • “Pore volume” refers to the total volume of the carbon mass occupied by pores or empty volume. The pores may be either internal (not accessible by gas sorption) or external (accessible by gas sorption).
  • “Mesopore” generally refers to pores having a diameter between about 2 nanometers and about 50 nanometers while the term “micropore” refers to pores having a diameter less than about 2 nanometers. Mesoporous carbon materials comprise greater than 50% of their total pore volume in mesopores while microporous carbon materials comprise greater than 50% of their total pore volume in micropores.
  • “Surface area” refers to the total specific surface area of a substance measurable by the BET technique. Surface area is typically expressed in units of m2/g. The BET (Brunauer/Emmett/Teller) technique employs an inert gas, for example nitrogen, to measure the amount of gas adsorbed on a material and is commonly used in the art to determine the accessible surface area of materials.
  • “Electrode” refers to a conductor through which electricity enters or leaves an object, substance or region.
  • “Binder” refers to a material capable of holding individual particles of a substance (e.g., a carbon material) together such that after mixing a binder and the particles together the resulting mixture can be formed into sheets, pellets, disks or other shapes. Non-exclusive examples of binders include fluoro polymers, such as, for example, PTFE (polytetrafluoroethylene, Teflon), PFA (perfluoroalkoxy polymer resin, also known as Teflon), FEP (fluorinated ethylene propylene, also known as Teflon), ETFE (polyethylenetetrafluoroethylene, sold as Tefzel and Fluon), PVF (polyvinyl fluoride, sold as Tedlar), ECTFE (polyethylenechlorotrifluoroethylene, sold as Halar), PVDF (polyvinylidene fluoride, sold as Kynar), PCTFE (polychlorotrifluoroethylene, sold as Kel-F and CTFE), trifluoroethanol and combinations thereof.
  • “Inert” refers to a material that is not active in the electrolyte of an electrical energy storage device, that is it does not absorb a significant amount of ions or change chemically, e.g., degrade.
  • “Conductive” refers to the ability of a material to conduct electrons through transmission of loosely held valence electrons.
  • “Current collector” refers to a part of an electrical energy storage and/or distribution device which provides an electrical connection to facilitate the flow of electricity in to, or out of, the device. Current collectors often comprise metal and/or other conductive materials and may be used as a backing for electrodes to facilitate the flow of electricity to and from the electrode.
  • “Electrolyte” means a substance containing free ions such that the substance is electrically conductive. Electrolytes are commonly employed in electrical energy storage devices. Examples of electrolytes include, but are not limited to, solvents such as propylene carbonate, ethylene carbonate, butylene carbonate, dimethyl carbonate, methyl ethyl carbonate, diethyl carbonate, sulfolane, methylsulfolane, acetonitrile or mixtures thereof in combination with solutes such as tetralkylammonium salts such as LiPF6 (lithium hexafluorophosphate), LiBOB (lithium bis(oxatlato)borate, TEA TFB (tetraethylammonium tetrafluoroborate), MTEATFB (methyltriethylammonium tetrafluoroborate), EMITFB (1-ethyl-3-methylimidazolium tetrafluoroborate), tetraethylammonium, triethylammonium based salts or mixtures thereof. In some embodiments, the electrolyte can be a water-based acid or water-based base electrolyte such as mild aqueous sulfuric acid or aqueous potassium hydroxide.
  • “Elemental form” refers to a chemical element having an oxidation state of zero (e.g., metallic lead).
  • “Oxidized form” form refers to a chemical element having an oxidation state greater than zero.
  • “Skeletal density” refers to the density of the material including internal porosity and excluding external porosity as measured by helium pycnometry
  • “Lithium uptake” refers to a carbon's ability to intercalate, absorb, or store lithium as measured as a ratio between the maximum number of lithium atoms to 6 carbon atoms.
  • X-ray photoelectron spectroscopy (“XPS”) is a spectroscopic technique for quantitating a material's elemental composition and provides information on chemical state and electronic state of elements that exist within a material.
  • A. Carbon Materials
  • As noted above, traditional lithium based energy storage devices comprise graphitic anode material. The disadvantages of graphitic carbon are numerous in lithium ion batteries. For one, the graphite undergoes a phase and volume change during battery operation. That is, the material physically expands and contracts when lithium is inserted between the graphene sheets while the individual sheets physically shift laterally to maintain a low energy storage state. Secondly, graphite has a low capacity. Given the ordered and crystalline structure of graphite, it takes six carbons to store one lithium ion. The structure is not able to accommodate additional lithium. Thirdly, the movement of lithium ions is restricted to a 2D plane, reducing the kinetics and the rate capability of the material in a battery. This means that graphite does not perform well at high rates where power is needed. This power disadvantage is one of the limiting factors for using lithium ion batteries in all-electric vehicles.
  • Although hard carbon anodes for lithium-based devices have been explored, these carbon materials are generally low purity and low surface area and the known devices still suffer from poor power performance and low first cycle efficiency. The presently disclosed composite materials comprise hard carbon materials which are optimized for use in lithium-based devices and which exceed the performance characteristics of other known devices.
  • 1. Modified Hard Carbon Materials and Components Thereof
  • As noted above, the present disclosure is directed to composite materials useful as anode material in lithium-based (or sodium-based) and other electrical storage devices. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the electrochemical modifier content of a composite, electrochemical modifier structure within the composite, purity profile of the carbon, surface area of the carbon, porosity of the carbon and/or other properties of the carbon materials are related, at least in part, to its preparation method, and variation of the preparation parameters may yield composite materials having different properties. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the composite material is a pyrolyzed polymer gel with a high silicon content.
  • The disclosed composite materials improve the properties of any number of electrical energy storage devices, for example the composite materials have been shown to improve the first cycle efficiency of a lithium-based battery (see e.g., FIG. 2). Accordingly, one embodiment of the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite material has a first cycle efficiency of greater than 50% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery. For example, some embodiments provide a composite material having a surface area of greater than 50 m2/g, wherein the composite material has a first cycle efficiency of greater than 50% and a reversible capacity of at least 600 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 55%. In some other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 60%. In yet other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 65%. In still other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 70%. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 75%, and in other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 80%, greater than 90%, greater than 95%, greater than 98%, or greater than 99%. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the composite materials also comprise a surface area ranging from about 5 m2/g to about 400 m2/g. or a pore volume ranging from about 0.05 to about 1.0 cc/g or both. For example, in some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 200 m2/g to about 300 m2/g or the surface area is about 250 m2/g.
  • In other embodiments the composite material has a surface area of less than 50 m2/g, wherein the composite material has a first cycle efficiency of greater than 50% and a reversible capacity of at least 600 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 55%. In some other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 60%. In yet other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 65%. In still other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 70%. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 75%, and in other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 80%, greater than 90%, greater than 95%, greater than 98%, or greater than 99%. In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a surface area ranging from about 5 m2/g to about 400 m2/g or a pore volume ranging from about 0.05 to about 1.0 cc/g or both. For example, in some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 200 m2/g to about 300 m2/g or the surface area is about 250 m2/g.
  • The properties of the composite material (e.g., first cycle efficiency, capacity, etc.) can be determined by incorporating it into an electrode, known to those versed in the art. The composite is tested electrochemically. The methods of testing may vary depending on the carbon:electrochemical modifier composition, as known in the art. In one example, the composite material to be characterized is tested between upper and lower voltages of 1.0V and 10 mV at a current of 400 mA/g, after two formation cycles between 1.0V and 70 mV at a current of 200 mA/g, with respect to the mass of the composite material. Alternatively, the composite materials are tested by limiting the capacity at a predefined value and measuring the stability and voltage fluctuations of the composite.
  • The first cycle efficiency of the composite anode material can be determined by comparing the lithium inserted into the anode during the first cycle to the lithium extracted from the anode on the first cycle (without any ex situ prelithiation). Alternatively, the composite material can be prelithiated before the first cycle. This process of prelithiation as described in the art, may be conducted to increase the first cycle efficiency. When the insertion and extraction are equal, the efficiency is 100%. As known in the art, the anode material can be tested in a half cell, where the counter electrode is lithium metal, the electrolyte is a 1M LiPF6 1:1 ethylene carbonate: diethylcarbonate (EC:DEC), using a commercial polypropylene separator.
  • In some embodiments, the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 10% and 99.9%. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 50% and 98%. In yet other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 80% and 95%. In still other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency of the composite material is between 85% and 90%. In another embodiment the first cycle efficiency is around 80%.
  • The third cycle efficiency of the composite material can be determined by comparing the lithium inserted into the anode during the third cycle to the lithium extraction from the anode on the third cycle in a half cell. In some embodiments, the third cycle efficiency is between 90% and 100%, 95% and 100%, 99% and 99.999%, 99.95% and 99.99%.
  • In certain embodiments of the above, the composite material is used as anode material.
  • In another embodiment the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the carbon material component of the composite has a volumetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 400 mAh/cc when the carbon material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery. The volumetric capacity of the carbon materials can be calculated from multiplying the maximum gravimetric capacity (mAh/g) with the pycnometer, skeletal density (g/cc). In other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 450 mAh/cc. In some other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/cc. In yet other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 550 mAh/cc. In still other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 650 mAh/cc, and in other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/cc. In another embodiment, the volumetric capacity of the carbon component of the composite ranges from 700 to 1100 mAh/cc.
  • In another embodiment the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the carbon material component has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 150 mAh/g when the carbon material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 200 mAh/g. In some other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 300 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 400 mAh/g. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g, at least 800 mAh/g, at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g or even at least 1200 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity ranges from 1200 to 3500 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the carbon materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 550 mAh/g to about 750 mAh/g. Certain examples of any of the above carbons comprise an electrochemical modifier as described in more detail below.
  • In another embodiment the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 150 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 200 mAh/g. In some other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 300 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 400 mAh/g. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g, at least 800 mAh/g, at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g or even at least 1200 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 1200 and 3500 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the composite materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 550 mAh/g to about 750 mAh/g.
  • In another embodiment the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 400 mAh/g when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 450 mAh/g. In some other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 800 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g, at least 1200 mAh/g, at least 1300 mAh/g or even at least 1400 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 1400 and 4200 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the composite materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 1200 mAh/g to about 1600 mAh/g.
  • In another embodiment the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein the composite has a volumetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 800 mAh/cc when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, for example a lithium ion battery. The volumetric capacity of the composite materials can be calculated from multiplying the maximum gravimetric capacity (mAh/g) with the pycnometer, skeletal density (g/cc) prior to electrochemical testing. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 900 mAh/cc. In some other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 1000 mAh/cc. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 1100 mAh/cc. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 1200 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 1300 mAh/cc, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 1400 mAh/cc, at least 1500 mAh/cc, at least 1600 mAh/cc, at least 1700 mAh/cc, at least 1800 mAh/cc or even at least 1900 mAh/cc. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 2000 and 8000 mAh/cc. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is between 4000 and 7000 mAh/cc. In some particular embodiments the composite materials have a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 2500 mAh/cc to about 3500 mAh/cc. The volumetric and gravimetric capacity can be determined through the use of any number of methods known in the art, for example by incorporating into an electrode half cell with lithium metal counter electrode in a coin cell. The gravimetric specific capacity is determined by dividing the measured capacity by the mass of the electrochemically active carbon materials. The volumetric specific capacity is determined by dividing the measured capacity by the volume of the electrode, including binder and conductivity additive. Methods for determining the volumetric and gravimetric capacity are described in more detail in the Examples.
  • In addition to various electrochemical modifiers (such as lithium alloying elements), the composite materials comprise lithium metal in some embodiments, either through doping or through electrochemical cycling, in the pores of the carbon component. Lithium plating within pores is seen as beneficial to both the capacity and cycling stability of the hard carbon in some embodiments. Plating within the pores can yield novel nanofiber lithium. In some cases lithium is plated on the outside of the particle. In certain embodiments, the present inventors believe external lithium plating is detrimental to the overall performance as explained in the examples. The presence of both internal and external lithium metal may be measured by cutting a material using a focused ion beam (FIB) and a scanning electron microscope (SEM). Metallic lithium is easily detected in contrast to hard carbon in an SEM. After cycling, and when the material has lithium inserted below 0V, the carbon may be sliced and imaged. In one embodiment the carbon displays lithium in the micropores. In another embodiment the carbon displays lithium in the mesopores. In still another embodiment, the carbon displays no lithium plating on the surface of the carbon. In yet still another embodiment carbon is stored in multiple pore sizes and shapes. The material shape and pore size distribution may uniquely and preferentially promote pore plating prior to surface plating. Ideal pore size for lithium storage is explained below.
  • In certain embodiments, the particle size distribution of the composite materials is believed to contribute to power performance and/or volumetric capacity. As the packing improves, the volumetric capacity will typically increase. In one embodiment the particle size distributions are either Gaussian with a single peak in shape, bimodal, or polymodal (>2 distinct peaks). The properties of particle size of the composite can be described by the DO (smallest particle in the distribution), D50 (average particle size) and D100 (maximum size of the largest particle). The optimal combination of particle packing and performance will be some combination of the size ranges below.
  • In one embodiment the DO of the composite ranges from 1 nm to 5 microns. In another embodiment the DO of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 1 micron, 5 nm to 500 nm, 5 nm to 100 nm or 10 nm to 50 nm. In another embodiment the DO of the composite ranges from 500 to 2 microns, 750 nm to 1 micron or 1 microns to 2 microns. In still another embodiment, the DO of the composite ranges from 2 to 5 microns or even greater than 5 microns.
  • In one embodiment the D50 of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 20 microns. In another embodiment the D50 of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 1 micron, 5 nm to 500 nm, 5 nm to 100 nm or 10 nm to 50 nm. In another embodiment the D50 of the composite ranges from 500 to 2 microns, 750 nm to 1 micron or 1 microns to 2 microns. In still another embodiment, the D50 of the composite ranges from 2 to 20 microns, 3 microns to 10 microns, 4 microns to 8 microns or is greater than 20 microns.
  • In one embodiment the D100 of the composite ranges from 8 nm to 100 microns. In another embodiment the D100 of the composite ranges from 5 nm to 1 micron, 5 nm to 500 nm, 5 nm to 100 nm or 10 nm to 50 nm. In another embodiment the D100 of the composite ranges from 500 to 2 microns, 750 nm to 1 micron or 1 microns to 2 microns. In still another embodiment, the D100 of the composite ranges from 2 to 100 microns, 5 to 50 microns, 8 to 40 microns, 10 to 35 microns, 15 to 30 microns, 20 to 30 microns, about 25 microns or greater than 100 microns.
  • In still other embodiments the present disclosure provides a composite material, wherein when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device the composite material has a volumetric capacity at least 10% greater than when the lithium based energy storage device comprises a graphite electrode. In some embodiments, the lithium based energy storage device is a lithium ion battery. In other embodiments, the composite material has a volumetric capacity in a lithium based energy storage device that is at least 5% greater, at least 10% greater or at least 15% greater than the volumetric capacity of the same electrical energy storage device having a graphite electrode. In still other embodiments, the composite material has a volumetric capacity in a lithium based energy storage device that is at least 20% greater, at least 30% greater, at least 40% greater, at least 50% greater, at least 200% greater, at least 100% greater, at least 150% greater, or at least 200% greater than the volumetric capacity of the same electrical energy storage device having a graphite electrode.
  • While not wishing to be bound by theory, the present applicants believe the superior properties of the disclosed composite materials is related, at least in part, to its unique properties such as surface area, purity, pore structure, crystallinity and/or surface chemistry, etc. For example, in some embodiments the specific surface area (as measured by BET analysis or in other embodiments by using CO2 absorption) of the composite materials may be low (<50 m2/g), medium (from about 50 m2/g to about 100 m2/g) or high (>100 m2/g) or have a surface area that spans one or more of these ranges. For example, in some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 0.1 m2/g to about 50 m2/g for example from about 1 m2/g to about 20 m2/g. In other particular embodiments, the surface area ranges from about 5 m2/g to about 10 m2/g for example the surface area may be about 8 m2/g.
  • In some embodiments, the specific surface area of the composite materials is less than about 100 m2/g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 50 m2/g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 20 m2/g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 10 m2/g. In other embodiments, the specific surface area is less than about 5 m2/g.
  • In some embodiments the surface area of the composite materials ranges from about 1 m2/g to about 50 m2/g. In some other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 20 m2/g to about 50 m2/g. In yet other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 1 m2/g to about 20 m2/g, for example from about 2 m2/g to about 15 m2/g. While not limiting in any way, some embodiments which comprise a surface area ranging from about 1 m2/g to about 20 m2/g for example from about 5 m2/g to about 10 m2/g have also been found to have good first cycle efficiency (e.g., >80%).
  • Other embodiments include composite materials comprising medium surface area (from 50 to 100 m2/g). In some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 50 m2/g to about 75 m2/g. In some other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 50 m2/g to about 60 m2/g. In yet other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 60 m2/g to about 100 m2/g. In yet other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 60 m2/g to about 80 m2/g.
  • In still other embodiments, the composite materials comprise high surface area (>100 m2/g). In some embodiments the surface area ranges from about 100 m2/g to about 500 m2/g. In some other embodiments the surface area ranges from about 100 m2/g to about 200 m2/g.
  • The surface area of the composite may be modified through activation. The activation method may use steam, chemical activation, CO2 or other gasses. Methods for activation of carbon material are well known in the art.
  • The carbon material may be doped with lithium atoms, wherein the lithium is in ionic form and not in the form of lithium metal. These lithium atoms may or may not be able to be separated from the carbon. The number of lithium atoms to 6 carbon atoms can be calculated by techniques known to those familiar with the art:

  • #Li=3.6×MM/(C %×F)
  • Wherein Q is the lithium extraction capacity measured in mAh/g between the voltages of 5 mV and 2.0V versus lithium metal, MM is 72 or the molecular mass of 6 carbons, F is Faraday's constant of 96500, C % is the mass percent carbon present in the structure as measured by CHNO or XPS.
  • The material can be characterized by the ratio of lithium atoms to carbon atoms (Li:C) which, in some embodiments, ranges from about 0:6 to about 2:6. In some embodiments the Li:C ratio ranges from about 0.05:6 to about 1.9:6. In other embodiments the maximum Li:C ratio wherein the lithium is in ionic and not metallic form is 2.2:6. In certain other embodiments, the Li:C ratio ranges from about 1.2:6 to about 2:6, from about 1.3:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.6:6 to about 1.8:6 or from about 1.7:6 to about 1.8:6. In other embodiments, the Li:C ratio is greater than 1:6, greater than 1.2:6, greater than 1.4:6, greater than 1.6:6 or even greater than 1.8:6. In even other embodiments, the Li:C ratio is about 1.4:6, about 1.5:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.7:6, about 1.8:6 or about 2:6. In a specific embodiment the Li:C ratio is about 1.78:6.
  • In certain other embodiments, the carbon materials comprise an Li:C ratio ranging from about 1:6 to about 2.5:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 2.2:6 or from about 1.4:6 to about 2:6. In still other embodiments, the carbon materials may not necessarily include lithium, but instead have a lithium uptake capacity (i.e., the capability to uptake a certain quantity of lithium). While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed the lithium uptake capacity of the carbon materials contributes to their superior performance in lithium based energy storage devices. The lithium uptake capacity is expressed as a ratio of the atoms of lithium taken up by the carbon per atom of carbon. In certain other embodiments, the carbon materials comprise a lithium uptake capacity ranging from about 1:6 to about 2.5:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 2.2:6 or from about 1.4:6 to about 2:6.
  • In certain other embodiments, the lithium uptake capacity ranges from about 1.2:6 to about 2:6, from about 1.3:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.4:6 to about 1.9:6, from about 1.6:6 to about 1.8:6 or from about 1.7:6 to about 1.8:6. In other embodiments, the lithium uptake capacity is greater than 1:6, greater than 1.2:6, greater than 1.4:6, greater than 1.6:6 or even greater than 1.8:6. In even other embodiments, the Li:C ratio is about 1.4:6, about 1.5:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.6:6, about 1.7:6, about 1.8:6 or about 2:6. In a specific embodiment the Li:C ratio is about 1.78:6.
  • Different methods of doping lithium may include chemical reactions, electrochemical reactions, physical mixing of particles, gas phase reactions, solid phase reactions, and liquid phase reactions. In other embodiments the lithium is in the form of lithium metal.
  • Since the total pore volume of the carbon component of the composite may partially relate to the incorporation of large amounts of electrochemical modifier and hence the storage of lithium ions, the internal ionic kinetics, as well as the available composite/electrolyte surfaces capable of charge-transfer, this is one parameter that can be adjusted in the carbon prior to incorporation of electrochemical modifier to obtain the desired electrochemical properties in the final composite. Some embodiments include composite materials having carbons with low total pore volume (e.g., less than about 0.1 cc/g). In one embodiment, the total pore volume of the carbon without the added electrochemical modifier is less than about 0.01 cc/g. In another embodiment, the total pore volume of the carbon without electrochemical modifier is less than about 0.001 cc/g. In yet another embodiment, the total pore volume of the carbon without electrochemical modifier is less than about 0.0001 cc/g.
  • In one embodiment, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.00001 cc/g to about 0.1 cc/g, for example from about 0.0001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g.
  • In other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a total pore volume of greater than or equal to 0.1 cc/g, and in other embodiments the composite materials comprise a total pore volume less than or equal to 0.6 cc/g. In other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a total pore volume ranging from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.2 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.2 cc/g to about 0.3 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.3 cc/g to about 0.4 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.4 cc/g to about 0.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.5 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g.
  • In certain embodiments, the present invention also includes composite materials having high total pore volume, for example greater than 0.6 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 1.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 1.0 cc/g to about 1.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the composite materials ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g.
  • In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a majority (e.g., >50%) of the total pore volume residing in pores of a certain diameter. For example, in some embodiments greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 1 nm or less. In other embodiments greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 100 nm or less. In other embodiments greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 0.5 nm or less.
  • In some embodiments, the tap density of the composite materials is predictive of their electrochemical performance, for example the volumetric capacity. While not limiting in any way, the pore volume of a composite material may be related to its tap density and composite s having low pore volume are sometimes found to have high tap density (and vice versa). Accordingly, composite materials having low tap density (e.g., <0.3 g/cc), medium tap density (e.g., from 0.3 to 0.75 g/cc) or high tap density (e.g., >0.75 g/cc) are provided.
  • In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density less than 0.3 g/cc. In yet some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.05 g/cc to about 0.25 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.1 g/cc to about 0.2 g/cc.
  • In yet some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density greater than or equal to 0.3 g/cc. In yet some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.3 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.35 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.30 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.40 g/cc to about 0.50 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the composite materials comprise a medium total pore volume (e.g., from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g).
  • In yet some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density greater than about 0.5 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 2.0 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a tap density ranging from about 0.75 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc, for example from about 0.75 g/cc to about 0.95 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the composite materials comprise a low, medium or high tap density.
  • The density of the composite materials can also be characterized by their skeletal density as measured by helium pycnometry. In certain embodiments, the skeletal density of the composite materials ranges from about 1 g/cc to about 3 g/cc, for example from about 1.5 g/cc to about 2.3 g/cc. In other embodiments, the skeletal density ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 1.6 cc/g, from about 1.6 cc/g to about 1.7 cc/g, from about 1.7 cc/g to about 1.8 cc/g, from about 1.8 cc/g to about 1.9 cc/g, from about 1.9 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g, from about 2.0 cc/g to about 2.1 cc/g, from about 2.1 cc/g to about 2.2 cc/g or from about 2.2 cc/g to about 2.4 cc/g.
  • In one embodiment, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.00001 cc/g to about 0.1 cc/g, for example from about 0.0001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.001 cc/g to about 0.01 cc/g.
  • In other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a total pore volume ranging greater than or equal to 0.1 cc/g, and in other embodiments the carbon component comprises a total pore volume less than or equal to 0.6 cc/g. In other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a total pore volume ranging from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.2 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.2 cc/g to about 0.3 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.3 cc/g to about 0.4 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.4 cc/g to about 0.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.5 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g.
  • The present invention also includes composites comprising carbon components having high total pore volume, for example greater than 0.6 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 0.6 cc/g to about 1.0 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 1.0 cc/g to about 1.5 cc/g. In some other embodiments, the total pore volume of the carbon component ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g.
  • In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a majority (e.g., >50%) of the total pore volume residing in pores of a certain diameter. For example, in some embodiments greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 1 nm or less. In other embodiments greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 100 nm or less. In other embodiments greater than 50%, greater than 60%, greater than 70%, greater than 80%, greater than 90% or even greater than 95% of the total pore volume resides in pores having a diameter of 0.5 nm or less.
  • In some embodiments, the tap density of the carbon component is predictive of its ability to incorporate electrochemical modifiers and hence electrochemical performance, for example the volumetric capacity. While not limiting in any way, the pore volume of a carbon component may be related to its tap density and carbon components having low pore volume are sometimes found to have high tap density (and vice versa). Accordingly, carbon components having low tap density (e.g., <0.3 g/cc), medium tap density (e.g., from 0.3 to 0.5 g/cc) or high tap density (e.g., >0.5 g/cc) are provided as components of the composite.
  • In yet some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density greater than or equal to 0.3 g/cc. In yet some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.3 g/cc to about 0.5 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.35 g/cc to about 0.45 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.30 g/cc to about 0.40 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.40 g/cc to about 0.50 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the carbon component comprises a medium total pore volume (e.g., from about 0.1 cc/g to about 0.6 cc/g).
  • In yet some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density greater than about 0.5 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 2.0 g/cc. In some other embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.5 g/cc to about 0.75 g/cc. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises a tap density ranging from about 0.75 g/cc to about 1.0 g/cc, for example from about 0.75 g/cc to about 0.95 g/cc. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the carbon component comprises a low, medium or high total pore volume.
  • Their skeletal density as measured by helium pycnometry can also characterize the density of the carbon component. In certain embodiments, the skeletal density of the carbon component ranges from about 1 g/cc to about 3 g/cc, for example from about 1.5 g/cc to about 2.3 g/cc. In other embodiments, the skeletal density ranges from about 1.5 cc/g to about 1.6 cc/g, from about 1.6 cc/g to about 1.7 cc/g, from about 1.7 cc/g to about 1.8 cc/g, from about 1.8 cc/g to about 1.9 cc/g, from about 1.9 cc/g to about 2.0 cc/g, from about 2.0 cc/g to about 2.1 cc/g, from about 2.1 cc/g to about 2.2 cc/g or from about 2.2 cc/g to about 2.3 cc/g.
  • The properties of the carbon component can easily be measured before incorporation of the electrochemical modifier. The properties of the carbon component can also be measured by removal of the electrochemical modifier after the fact. In the case of silicon this can easily be accomplished by dissolving the silicon with a solvent that does not impact the carbon and then measuring the properties of the carbon without electrochemical modifier.
  • As discussed in more detail below, the surface functionality of the presently disclosed composite materials may be altered to obtain the desired electrochemical properties. One property which can be predictive of surface functionality is the pH of the composite materials. The presently disclosed composite materials comprise pH values ranging from less than 1 to about 14, for example less than 5, from 5 to 8 or greater than 8. In some embodiments, the pH of the composite materials is less than 4, less than 3, less than 2 or even less than 1. In other embodiments, the pH of the composite materials is between about 5 and 6, between about 6 and 7, between about 7 and 8 or between 8 and 9 or between 9 and 10. In still other embodiments, the pH is high and the pH of the composite materials ranges is greater than 8, greater than 9, greater than 10, greater than 11, greater than 12, or even greater than 13.
  • Pore size distribution of the carbon component may, in some embodiments, contribute to both the storage capacity of the composite material and the kinetics and power capability of the system as well as the ability to incorporate large amounts of electrochemical modifiers. The pore size distribution can range from micro to meso to macro (see e.g., FIG. 1) and may be either monomodal, bimodal or multimodal (i.e., may comprise one or more different distribution of pore sizes, see e.g., FIG. 3). Micropores, with average pore sizes less than 1 nm, may create additional storage sites as well as lithium (or sodium) ion diffusion paths. Graphite sheets typically are spaced 0.33 nm apart for lithium storage. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is thought that large quantities of pores of similar size may yield graphite-like structures within pores with additional hard carbon-type storage in the bulk structure. Mesopores are typically below 100 nm. These pores are ideal locations for nano particle dopants, such as metals, and provide pathways for both conductive additive and electrolyte for ion and electron conduction. In some embodiments the carbon materials comprise macropores greater than 100 nm which may be especially suited for large particle doping.
  • Pore size distribution of the composite may be important to both the storage capacity of the material and the kinetics and power capability of the system as well as the ability to incorporate large amounts of electrochemical modifiers. The pore size distribution can range from micro to meso to macro and may be either monomodal, bimodal or multimodal. In some embodiments the composite materials comprise micropores less than 100 nm which may be especially suited for lithium diffusion.
  • Accordingly, in one embodiment, the carbon material comprises a fractional pore volume of pores at or below 1 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore volume, at least 75% of the total pore volume, at least 90% of the total pore volume or at least 99% of the total pore volume. In other embodiments, the carbon material comprises a fractional pore volume of pores at or below 10 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore volume, at least 75% of the total pore volume, at least 90% of the total pore volume or at least 99% of the total pore volume. In other embodiments, the carbon material comprises a fractional pore volume of pores at or below 50 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore volume, at least 75% of the total pore volume, at least 90% of the total pore volume or at least 99% of the total pore volume.
  • In another embodiment, the carbon material comprises a fractional pore surface area of pores at or below 100 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore surface area, at least 75% of the total pore surface area, at least 90% of the total pore surface area or at least 99% of the total pore surface area. In another embodiment, the carbon material comprises a fractional pore surface area of pores at or greater than 100 nm that comprises at least 50% of the total pore surface area, at least 75% of the total pore surface area, at least 90% of the total pore surface area or at least 99% of the total pore surface area.
  • In another embodiment, the carbon material comprises pores predominantly in the range of 100 nm or lower, for example 10 nm or lower, for example 5 nm or lower. Alternatively, the carbon material comprises micropores in the range of 0-2 nm and mesopores in the range of 2-100 nm. The ratio of pore volume or pore surface in the micropore range compared to the mesopore range can be in the range of 95:5 to 5:95.
  • In some embodiments, the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 0.5 to 1000 microns. In other embodiments the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 1 to 100 microns. Still in other embodiments the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 1 to 50 microns. Yet in other embodiments, the median particle diameter for the composite materials ranges from 5 to 15 microns or from 1 to 5 microns. Still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter for the composite materials is about 10 microns. Still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter for the composite materials is less than 4, is less than 3, is less than 2, is less than 1 microns.
  • In some embodiments, the composite materials exhibit a median particle diameter ranging from 1 micron to 5 microns. In other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 5 microns to 10 microns. In yet other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 10 nm to 20 microns. Still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 20 nm to 30 microns. Yet still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 30 microns to 40 microns. Yet still in other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 40 microns to 50 microns. In other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges from 50 microns to 100 microns. In other embodiments, the median particle diameter ranges in the submicron range <1 micron.
  • In other embodiments, the carbon components are microporous (e.g., greater than 50% of pores less than 1 nm) and comprise monodisperse micropores. For example in some embodiments the carbon components are microporous, and (Dv90−Dv10)/Dv50, where Dv10, Dv50 and Dv90 refer to the pore size at 10%, 50% and 90% of the distribution by volume, is about 3 or less, typically about 2 or less, often about 1.5 or less.
  • In other embodiments, the carbon components are mesoporous (e.g., greater than 50% of pores less than 100 nm) and comprise monodisperse mesopores. For example in some embodiments, the carbon components are mesoporous and (Dv90−Dv10)/Dv50, where Dv10, Dv50 and Dv90 refer to the pore size at 10%, 50% and 90% of the distribution by volume, is about 3 or less, typically about 2 or less, often about 1.5 or less.
  • In other embodiments, the carbon components are macroporous (e.g., greater than 50% of pores greater than 100 nm) and comprise monodisperse macropores. For example in some embodiments, the carbon components are macroporous and (Dv90−Dv10)/Dv50, where Dv10, Dv50 and Dv90 refer to the pore size at 10%, 50% and 90% of the distribution by volume, is about 3 or less, typically about 2 or less, often about 1.5 or less.
  • In some other embodiments, the carbon components have a bimodal pore size distribution. For example, in some embodiments the carbon component comprise a population of micropores and a population of mesopores. In some embodiments, the ratio of micropores to mesopores ranges from about 1:10 to about 10:1, for example from about 1:3 to about 3:1.
  • In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises pores having a peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranging from 0.1 nm to 0.25 nm. In other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.25 nm to 0.50 nm. Yet in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.75 nm to 1.0 nm. Still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.1 nm to 0.50 nm. Yet still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 0.50 nm to 1.0 nm.
  • In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises pores having a peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranging from 2 nm to 10 nm. In other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 10 nm to 20 nm. Yet in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 20 nm to 30 nm. Still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 30 nm to 40 nm. Yet still in other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 40 nm to 50 nm. In other embodiments, the peak height found in the pore volume distribution ranges from 50 nm to 100 nm.
  • While not wishing to be bound by theory, the present inventors believe that the extent of disorder in the carbon component and composite materials may have an impact on the electrochemical properties of the carbon materials. For example, the data in Table 4 (see Examples) shows a possible trend between the available lithium sites for insertion and the range of disorder/crystallite size. Thus controlling the extent of disorder in the carbon component provides a possible avenue to improve the rate capability for carbons since a smaller crystallite size may allow for lower resistive lithium ion diffusion through the amorphous structure. The present invention includes embodiments which comprise both high and low levels of disorder.
  • Disorder, as recorded by RAMAN spectroscopy, is a measure of the size of the crystallites found within both amorphous and crystalline structures (M. A. Pimenta, G. Dresselhaus, M. S. Dresselhaus, L. G. Can ado, A. Jorio, and R. Saito, “Studying disorder in graphite-based systems by Raman spectroscopy,” Physical Chemistry Chemical Physics, vol. 9, no. 11, p. 1276, 2007). RAMAN spectra of exemplary carbon are shown in FIG. 4. For carbon structures, crystallite sizes (La) can be calculated from the relative peak intensities of the D and G Raman shifts (Eq 1)

  • L a(nm)=(2.4×10−104 laser R −1  (1)

  • where

  • R=I D /I G  (2)
  • The values for R and La can vary in certain embodiments, and their value may affect the electrochemical properties of the carbon materials, for example the capacity of the 2nd lithium insertion (2nd lithium insertion is related to first cycle efficiency since first cycle efficiency=(capacity at 1st lithium insertion/capacity at 2nd lithium insertion)×100). For example, in some embodiments R ranges from about 0 to about 1 or from about 0.50 to about 0.95. In other embodiments, R ranges from about 0.60 to about 0.90. In other embodiments, R ranges from about 0.80 to about 0.90. La also varies in certain embodiments and can range from about 1 nm to about 500 nm. In certain other embodiments, La ranges from about 5 nm to about 100 nm or from about 10 to about 50 nm. In other embodiments, La ranges from about 15 nm to about 30 nm, for example from about 20 to about 30 nm or from about 25 to 30 nm.
  • In a related embodiment, the electrochemical properties of the carbon component are related to the level of crystallinity as measured by X-ray diffraction (XRD). While Raman measures the size of the crystallites, XRD records the level of periodicity in the bulk structure through the scattering of incident X-rays (see e.g., FIG. 5). The present invention includes composites comprising carbon materials that are non-graphitic (crystallinity <10%) and semi-graphitic (crystallinity between 10 and 50%). The crystallinity of the carbon component ranges from about 0% to about 99%. In some embodiments, the carbon component comprises less than 10% crystallinity, less than 5% crystallinity or even less than 1% crystallinity (i.e., highly amorphous). In other embodiments, the carbon component comprises from 10% to 50% crystallinity. In still other embodiments, the carbon component comprises less than 50% crystallinity, less than 40% crystallinity, less than 30% crystallinity or even less than 20% crystallinity.
  • In a related embodiment, the electrochemical properties of the composite materials are related to the level of crystallinity as measured by X-ray diffraction (XRD). The present invention includes composite materials that are non-crystalline (crystallinity <10%) and semi-crystalline (crystallinity between 10 and 50%) and crystalline (>50%). The crystallinity of the composite materials ranges from about 0% to about 99%. In some embodiments, the carbon materials without electrochemical modifier comprise less than 10% crystallinity, less than 5% crystallinity or even less than 1% crystallinity (i.e., highly amorphous). In other embodiments, the composite materials comprise from 10% to 50% crystallinity. In still other embodiments, the composite materials comprise less than 50% crystallinity, less than 40% crystallinity, less than 30% crystallinity or even less than 20% crystallinity. In a related embodiment, the electrochemical performance of the carbon materials without electrochemical modifier are related to the empirical values, R, as calculated from Small Angle X-ray Diffraction (SAXS), wherein R=B/A and B is the height of the double layer peak and A is the baseline for the single graphene sheet as measured by SAXS.
  • SAXS has the ability to measure internal pores, perhaps inaccessible by gas adsorption techniques but capable of lithium storage. In certain embodiments, the R factor is below 1, comprising single layers of graphene. In other embodiments, the R factor ranges from about 0.1 to about 20 or from about 1 to 10. In yet other embodiments, the R factor ranges from 1 to 5, from 1 to 2, or from 1.5 to 2. In still other embodiments, the R factor ranges from 1.5 to 5, from 1.75 to 3, or from 2 to 2.5. Alternatively, the R factor is greater than 10. The SAXS pattern may also be analyzed by the number of peaks found between 10° and 40°. In some embodiments, the number of peaks found by SAXS at low scattering angles are 1, 2, 3, or even more than 3. FIGS. 6 and 7 present representative SAXS plots.
  • In certain embodiments, the organic content of either the composite materials or the carbon materials can be manipulated to provide the desired properties, for example by contacting the materials with a hydrocarbon compound such as cyclohexane and the like. Infra-red spectroscopy (FTIR) can be used as a metric to determine the organic content of both surface and bulk structures of the materials (see e.g., FIG. 8A). In one embodiment, the carbon component comprises essentially no organic material. An FTIR spectra which is essentially featureless is indicative of such embodiments (e.g., carbons B and D). In other embodiments, the carbon component comprises organic material, either on the surface or within the bulk structure. In such embodiments, the FTIR spectra generally depict large hills and valleys which indicates the presence of organic content.
  • The organic content may have a direct relationship to the electrochemical performance (FIG. 8 b) and response of the material when placed into a lithium bearing device for energy storage. Carbon components with flat FTIR signals (no organics) often display a low extraction peak in the voltage profile at 0.2 V. Well known to the art, the extract voltage is typical of lithium stripping. In certain embodiments, the carbon component comprises organic content and the lithium stripping plateau is absent or near absent.
  • The carbon component comprises varying amounts of carbon, oxygen, hydrogen and nitrogen as measured by gas chromatography CHNO analysis in various embodiments. In one embodiment, the carbon content is greater than 98 wt. % or even greater than 99.9 wt % as measured by CHNO analysis. In another embodiment, the carbon content ranges from about 10 wt % to about 99.9%, for example from about 50 to about 98 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges 90 to 98 wt. %, 92 to 98 wt % or greater than 95% of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges from 80 to 90 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges from 70 to 80 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges from 60 to 70 wt. % of the total mass.
  • The composite materials may also comprise varying amounts of carbon, oxygen, hydrogen and nitrogen as measured by gas chromatography CHNO analysis. In one embodiment, the carbon content of the composite is greater than 98 wt. % or even greater than 99.9 wt % as measured by CHNO analysis. In another embodiment, the carbon content of the composite ranges from about 10 wt % to about 99.9%, for example from about 50 to about 98 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content of the composite ranges 90 to 98 wt. %, 92 to 98 wt % or greater than 95% of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content of the composite ranges from 80 to 90 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content of the composite ranges from 70 to 80 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 60 to 70 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 50 to 60 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 40 to 50 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 30 to 40 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 20 to 30 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 10 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges of the composite from 1 to 10 wt. % of the total mass.
  • In another embodiment, the nitrogen content of the carbon component ranges from 0 to 90 wt. % based on total mass of all components in the carbon material as measured by CHNO analysis. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 10 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from 10 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from 20 to 30 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content is greater than 30 wt. %. In some more specific embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from about 1% to about 6%, while in other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from about 0.1% to about 1%. In certain of the above embodiments, the nitrogen content is based on weight relative to total weight of all components in the carbon material
  • The carbon and nitrogen content may also be measured as a ratio of C:N (carbon atoms to nitrogen atoms). In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 0.001:1 or from 1:0.001 to 1:1. In another embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 1:0.01. In yet another embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.01 to 1:1. In yet another embodiment, the content of nitrogen exceeds the content of carbon, for example the C:N ratio can range from about 0.01:1 to about 0.1:1 or from 0.1:1 to about 0.5:1.
  • The composite materials may also comprise varying amounts of carbon, oxygen, nitrogen, Cl, and Na, to name a few, as measured by XPS analysis. In one embodiment, the carbon content is greater than 98 wt. % as measured by XPS analysis. In another embodiment, the carbon content ranges from 50 to 98 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges 90 to 98 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges from 80 to 90 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges from 70 to 80 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the carbon content ranges from 60 to 70 wt. % of the total mass.
  • In other embodiments, the carbon content in the composite ranges from 10% to 99.9%, from 10% to 99%, from 10% to 98%, from 50% to 99.9%, from 50% to 99%, from 50% to 98%, from 75% to 99.9%, from 75% to 99% or from 75% to 98% of the total mass of all components in the carbon material as measured by XPS analysis
  • In another embodiment, the nitrogen content in the composite ranges from 0 to 90 wt. % as measured by XPS analysis. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 75 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 50 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 25 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 10 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content ranges from 1 to 6 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from 10 to 20 wt. % of the total mass. In yet other embodiments, the nitrogen content ranges from 20 to 30 wt. % of the total mass. In another embodiment, the nitrogen content is greater than 30 wt. %.
  • The carbon and nitrogen content may also be measured as a ratio of C:N by XPS. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio of the composite ranges from 0.001:1 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 0.01:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 0.1:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.1. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.2 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 1:1. In another embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 0.01. In yet another embodiment, the C:N ratio ranges from 1:0.01 to 1:1. In yet another embodiment, the content of nitrogen exceeds the content of carbon.
  • The carbon and phosphorus content of the composite may also be measured as a ratio of C:P by XPS. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio of the composite ranges from 0.001:1 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 0.01:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 0.1:1 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.001. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.5 to 1:0.1. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.2 to 1:0.01. In one embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 1:1. In another embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.001 to 0.01. In yet another embodiment, the C:P ratio ranges from 1:0.01 to 1:1. In yet another embodiment, the content of nitrogen exceeds the content of carbon.
  • XPS may also be used to detect individual bonds between elements. In the case of a modified carbon, the interface between the carbon and the electrochemical modifier may include an C—X bond, wherein X is the primary element that alloys with lithium (such as C—Si bond for a silicon electrochemical modifier). The presence of C—X may affect the performance of the material. This percent of C—X bonds within a composite can be characterized using XPS. In one embodiment the percent of C—X bonds as measured by XPS is between 0% and 50%. In another embodiment the percent of C—X bonds is between 0% and 10%, 0% and 5%, 0% and 3%, 0% and 2%, 0% and 1%, 1% and 2%, between 10% and 50%, or greater than 50%. In yet another embodiment, the C—X bond also produces a material in-situ that is also capable of alloying electrochemically with silicon.
  • The carbon material can include both sp3 and sp2 hybridized carbons. The percentage of sp2 hybridization can be measured by XPS using the Auger spectrum, as known in the art. It is assumed that for materials which are less than 100% sp2, the remainder of the bonds are sp3. The carbon materials range from about 1% sp2 hybridization to 100% sp2 hybridization. Other embodiments include carbon materials comprising from about 25% to about 95% sp2, from about 50%-95% sp2, from about 50% to about 75% sp2, from about 65% to about 95% sp2 or about 65% sp2.
  • The composite materials may also be created by incorporation of an electrochemical modifier selected to optimize the electrochemical performance of the non-modified carbon materials. The electrochemical modifier may be incorporated within the pore structure and/or on the surface of the carbon material or incorporated in any number of other ways. For example, in some embodiments, the composite materials comprise a coating of the electrochemical modifier (e.g., silicon or Al2O3) on the surface of the carbon materials. In some embodiments, the composite materials comprise greater than about 100 ppm of an electrochemical modifier. In certain embodiments, the electrochemical modifier is selected from iron, tin, silicon, nickel, aluminum and manganese.
  • In certain embodiments the electrochemical modifier comprises an element with the ability to lithiate from 3 to 0 V versus lithium metal (e.g. silicon, tin, sulfur). In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises metal oxides with the ability to lithiate from 3 to 0 V versus lithium metal (e.g. iron oxide, molybdenum oxide, titanium oxide). In still other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises elements which do not lithiate from 3 to 0 V versus lithium metal (e.g. aluminum, manganese, nickel, metal-phosphates). In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises a non-metal element (e.g. fluorine, nitrogen, hydrogen). In still other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises any of the foregoing electrochemical modifiers or any combination thereof (e.g. tin-silicon, nickel-titanium oxide).
  • In certain embodiments, the electrochemical modifier is an efficiency enhancer, such as phosphorous. In other embodiments, the composite comprises a lithium alloying element and an efficiency enhancer, such as phosphorous.
  • The electrochemical modifier may be provided in any number of forms. For example, in some embodiments the electrochemical modifier comprises a salt. In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises one or more elements in elemental form, for example elemental iron, tin, silicon, nickel or manganese. In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises one or more elements in oxidized form, for example iron oxides, tin oxides, silicon oxides, nickel oxides, aluminum oxides or manganese oxides.
  • In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises iron. In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises tin. In other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises silicon. In some other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises nickel. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises aluminum. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises manganese. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises Al2O3. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises titanium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises titanium oxide. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises lithium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises sulfur. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises phosphorous. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises molybdenum. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises germanium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises arsenic. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises gallium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises phosphorous. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises selenium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises antimony. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises bismuth. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises tellurium. In yet other embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises indium.
  • Accordingly, in some embodiments the composite materials comprise a second carbon allotrope such as, but not limited to, graphite, amorphous carbon (soft and hard), diamond, C60, carbon nanotubes (e.g., single and/or multi-walled), graphene and carbon fibers. In some embodiments, the second carbon form is graphite. In other embodiments, the second form is soft carbon. The ratio of carbon material (e.g., hard carbon) to second carbon allotrope can be tailored to fit any desired electrochemical application. The second carbon allotrope is considered the electrochemical modifier of the hard carbon if and only if the second allotrope exhibits alloying behavior with lithium ions during an electrochemical reaction.
  • In certain embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope in the composite materials ranges from about 0.01:1 to about 100:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:1 to about 10:1 or about 5:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:10 to about 10:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:5 to about 5:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:3 to about 3:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to second carbon allotrope ranges from about 1:2 to about 2:1.
  • Multiple carbon allotropes can be combined within a single composite to further improve electrochemical performance. For example, a hard carbon can be blended with both graphite and soft carbon to change the density as well as the capacity or first cycle efficiency. The three or more carbon allotropes will have a synergistic effect, creating a unique structure and performance. In certain embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes present in the composite material ranges from about 0.01:1 to about 100:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:1 to about 10:1 or about 5:1. In other embodiments the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:10 to about 10:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:5 to about 5:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:3 to about 3:1. In other embodiments, the mass ratio of hard carbon to the sum of the masses for all other carbon allotropes in the composite material ranges from about 1:2 to about 2:1.
  • The electrochemical properties of the composite materials can be modified, at least in part, by the amount of the electrochemical modifier in the composite material. In some of these embodiments, the electrochemical modifier is an alloying material such as silicon, tin, indium, aluminum, germanium or gallium, for example silicon. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the composite material comprises at least 0.10%, at least 0.25%, at least 0.50%, at least 1.0%, at least 5.0%, at least 10%, at least 25%, at least 50%, at least 75%, at least 90%, at least 95%, at least 99% or at least 99.5% of the electrochemical modifier. For example, in some embodiments, the composite materials comprise between 0.5% and 99.5% carbon and between 0.5% and 99.5% electrochemical modifier. In another embodiment, the composite material comprises 70%-99% silicon, for example between 75% and 95%, for example between 80% and 95%. The percent of the electrochemical modifier is calculated on weight percent basis (wt %). In some other more specific embodiments, the electrochemical modifier comprises iron, tin, silicon, nickel and manganese. In a different embodiment, the composite material comprises 70%-99% silicon, for example between 75% and 95%, for example between 80% and 95%.
  • In still other embodiments, the composite materials comprise carbon and silicon, wherein the silicon is present in about 1% to about 75% by weight of composite material. For example, in some embodiments the silicon content ranges from about 1% to about 10% or from about 3% to about 7%. In still other embodiments, the silicon content ranges from about 40% to about 60%, for example about 45% to about 55%.
  • In still other embodiments, the composite materials comprise carbon and silicon, wherein the silicon is present in about 65% to about 85% by weight of composite material. For example, in some embodiments the silicon content ranges from about 70% to about 80% or from about 72% to about 78%. In still other embodiments, the silicon content ranges from about 80% to about 95%, for example about 85% to about 95%.
  • The unmodified carbon materials have purities not previously obtained with hard carbon materials. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the high purity of the unmodified carbon materials contributes to the superior electrochemical properties of the same. In some embodiments, the unmodified carbon material comprises low total TXRF impurities (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier). Thus, in some embodiments the total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of all other TXRF elements in the carbon material (as measured by proton induced x-ray emission) is less than 1000 ppm. In other embodiments, the total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of all other TXRF elements in the carbon material is less than 800 ppm, less than 500 ppm, less than 300 ppm, less than 200 ppm, less than 150 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 25 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm or less than 1 ppm.
  • In addition to low content of undesired TXRF impurities, the carbon component may comprise high total carbon content. In some examples, in addition to carbon, the carbon material may also comprise oxygen, hydrogen, nitrogen and an optional electrochemical modifier. In some embodiments, the material comprises at least 75% carbon, 80% carbon, 85% carbon, at least 90% carbon, at least 95% carbon, at least 96% carbon, at least 97% carbon, at least 98% carbon or at least 99% carbon on a weight/weight basis. In some other embodiments, the carbon material comprises less than 10% oxygen, less than 5% oxygen, less than 3.0% oxygen, less than 2.5% oxygen, less than 1% oxygen or less than 0.5% oxygen on a weight/weight basis. In other embodiments, the carbon material comprises less than 10% hydrogen, less than 5% hydrogen, less than 2.5% hydrogen, less than 1% hydrogen, less than 0.5% hydrogen or less than 0.1% hydrogen on a weight/weight basis. In other embodiments, the carbon material comprises less than 5% nitrogen, less than 2.5% nitrogen, less than 1% nitrogen, less than 0.5% nitrogen, less than 0.25% nitrogen or less than 0.01% nitrogen on a weight/weight basis. The oxygen, hydrogen and nitrogen content of the disclosed carbon materials can be determined by combustion analysis. Techniques for determining elemental composition by combustion analysis are well known in the art.
  • The total ash content of an unmodified carbon material may, in some instances, have an effect on the electrochemical performance of a carbon material. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of the carbon material ranges from 0.1% to 0.001% weight percent ash, for example in some specific embodiments the ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of the carbon material is less than 0.1%, less than 0.08%, less than 0.05%, less than 0.03%, than 0.025%, less than 0.01%, less than 0.0075%, less than 0.005% or less than 0.001%.
  • In other embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 500 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.08%. In further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 300 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.05%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 200 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.05%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 200 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.025%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 100 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.02%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 50 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of less than 0.01%.
  • In other embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier, such as silicon) of greater than 500 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 0.08%. In further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 5000 ppm and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 0.5%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 1% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 0.5%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 2% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 1%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 3% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 2%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 4% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 3%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 5% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 4%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 6% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 5%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 7% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 6%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 8% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 7%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 9% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 8%. In other further embodiments, the composite material comprises a total TXRF impurity content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 10% and an ash content (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) of greater than 9%.
  • The amount of individual TXRF impurities present in the disclosed composite materials can be determined by total x-ray fluorescence. Individual TXRF impurities may contribute in different ways to the overall electrochemical performance of the disclosed composite materials. Thus, in some embodiments, the level of sodium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 500 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of magnesium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of aluminum present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of silicon present in the composite material is less than 500 ppm, less than 300 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of phosphorous present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of sulfur present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 30 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of chlorine present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of potassium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, or less than 1 ppm. In other embodiments, the level of calcium present in the composite material is less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In some embodiments, the level of chromium present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In other embodiments, the level of iron present in the composite material is less than 50 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In other embodiments, the level of nickel present in the composite material is less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In some other embodiments, the level of copper present in the composite material is less than 140 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 40 ppm, less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 4 ppm, less than 3 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In yet other embodiments, the level of zinc present in the composite material is less than 20 ppm, less than 10 ppm, less than 5 ppm, less than 2 ppm or less than 1 ppm. In yet other embodiments, the sum of all other TXRF impurities (excluding any intentionally included electrochemical modifier) present in the composite material is less than 1000 ppm, less than 500 pm, less than 300 ppm, less than 200 ppm, less than 100 ppm, less than 50 ppm, less than 25 ppm, less than 10 ppm or less than 1 ppm. As noted above, in some embodiments other impurities such as hydrogen, oxygen and/or nitrogen may be present in levels ranging from less than 10% to less than 0.01%.
  • In some embodiments, the composite material comprises undesired TXRF impurities near or below the detection limit of the proton induced x-ray emission analysis. For example, in some embodiments the unmodified composite material comprises less than 50 ppm sodium, less than 15 ppm magnesium, less than 10 ppm aluminum, less than 8 ppm silicon, less than 4 ppm phosphorous, less than 3 ppm sulfur, less than 3 ppm chlorine, less than 2 ppm potassium, less than 3 ppm calcium, less than 2 ppm scandium, less than 1 ppm titanium, less than 1 ppm vanadium, less than 0.5 ppm chromium, less than 0.5 ppm manganese, less than 0.5 ppm iron, less than 0.25 ppm cobalt, less than 0.25 ppm nickel, less than 0.25 ppm copper, less than 0.5 ppm zinc, less than 0.5 ppm gallium, less than 0.5 ppm germanium, less than 0.5 ppm arsenic, less than 0.5 ppm selenium, less than 1 ppm bromine, less than 1 ppm rubidium, less than 1.5 ppm strontium, less than 2 ppm yttrium, less than 3 ppm zirconium, less than 2 ppm niobium, less than 4 ppm molybdenum, less than 4 ppm, technetium, less than 7 ppm rubidium, less than 6 ppm rhodium, less than 6 ppm palladium, less than 9 ppm silver, less than 6 ppm cadmium, less than 6 ppm indium, less than 5 ppm tin, less than 6 ppm antimony, less than 6 ppm tellurium, less than 5 ppm iodine, less than 4 ppm cesium, less than 4 ppm barium, less than 3 ppm lanthanum, less than 3 ppm cerium, less than 2 ppm praseodymium, less than 2 ppm, neodymium, less than 1.5 ppm promethium, less than 1 ppm samarium, less than 1 ppm europium, less than 1 ppm gadolinium, less than 1 ppm terbium, less than 1 ppm dysprosium, less than 1 ppm holmium, less than 1 ppm erbium, less than 1 ppm thulium, less than 1 ppm ytterbium, less than 1 ppm lutetium, less than 1 ppm hafnium, less than 1 ppm tantalum, less than 1 ppm tungsten, less than 1.5 ppm rhenium, less than 1 ppm osmium, less than 1 ppm iridium, less than 1 ppm platinum, less than 1 ppm silver, less than 1 ppm mercury, less than 1 ppm thallium, less than 1 ppm lead, less than 1.5 ppm bismuth, less than 2 ppm thorium, or less than 4 ppm uranium.
  • In some embodiments, the composite material comprises undesired TXRF impurities near or below the detection limit of the proton induced x-ray emission analysis. In some specific embodiments, the unmodified composite material comprises less than 100 ppm sodium, less than 300 ppm silicon, less than 50 ppm sulfur, less than 100 ppm calcium, less than 20 ppm iron, less than 10 ppm nickel, less than 140 ppm copper, less than 5 ppm chromium and less than 5 ppm zinc as measured by TXRF. In other specific embodiments, the composite material comprises less than 50 ppm sodium, less than 30 ppm sulfur, less than 100 ppm silicon, less than 50 ppm calcium, less than 10 ppm iron, less than 5 ppm nickel, less than 20 ppm copper, less than 2 ppm chromium and less than 2 ppm zinc.
  • In other specific embodiments, the composite material comprises less than 50 ppm sodium, less than 50 ppm silicon, less than 30 ppm sulfur, less than 10 ppm calcium, less than 2 ppm iron, less than 1 ppm nickel, less than 1 ppm copper, less than 1 ppm chromium and less than 1 ppm zinc.
  • In some other specific embodiments, the composite material comprises less than 100 ppm sodium, less than 50 ppm magnesium, less than 50 ppm aluminum, less than 10 ppm sulfur, less than 10 ppm chlorine, less than 10 ppm potassium, less than 1 ppm chromium and less than 1 ppm manganese.
  • In certain of the foregoing embodiments, and other embodiments described herein, the impurity content is measured by PIXE, rather than TXRF.
  • In certain embodiments, the composite material comprises carbon and two or more different electrochemical modifiers. In embodiments, the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and one or more electrochemical modifiers selected from: phosphorus, nitrogen, sulfur, boron and aluminum. In certain embodiments, the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and 1-20% (by weight) of a Group 13 element or combinations thereof. In other certain embodiments, the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and 1-20% (by weight) of a Group 15 element, or combinations thereof. In other certain embodiments, the composite material comprises carbon, silicon and 1-20% (by weight) of lithium, sodium, or potassium, or combinations thereof.
  • The composite material may include various surface treatments or properties in order to further improve the electrochemical performance as defined by capacity, stability and/or power performance. In one embodiment the composite (e.g., the individual composite particles) is covered by an ionically conductive polymer with a thickness ranging from about 1 nm to about 10 microns. In another embodiment the composite is covered by a ceramic protective coating with a thickness ranging from about 1 nm to about 10 microns. In yet another embodiment the composite is covered by an organic film with a thickness ranging from about 1 nm to about 10 microns. The thickness can be measured with a variety of techniques known in the art such as but not limited to XPS sputtering, FIB/SEM or SIMS.
  • B. Preparation Methods
  • Any of the above described materials can be prepared via a variety of processes including sol gel, emulsion/suspension, solvent free (solid state, melt/liquid state, vapor state). Exemplary methods are described below.
  • The carbon component can be prepared by a method disclosed herein, for example, in some embodiments the carbon material is prepared by a method comprising pyrolyzing a polymer gel as disclosed herein. The carbon materials may also be prepared by pryolyzing a substance such as chitosan. The carbon materials can be prepared by any number of methods described in more detail below.
  • Numerous methods are available for the incorporation of an electrochemical modifier into carbon. The composite may be formed through a gas phase deposition of an electrochemical modifier onto the carbon. The composite may be synthesized through mechanical mixing or milling of two distinct solids. Electrochemical modifiers can also be incorporated during the polymerization stage, into the polymer gel or into the pyrolyzed or activated carbon materials. Methods for preparation of carbon materials are described in more detail below.
  • 1. Polymer Gels
  • Polymer gels are intermediates in the preparation of the disclosed composite materials. As such, the physical and chemical properties of the polymer gels contribute to, and are predictive of, the properties of the carbon materials. Polymer gels used for preparation of the composite materials are included within the scope of certain aspects of the present invention.
  • Methods for preparation of certain carbon materials are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 7,723,262 and 8,293,818; and U.S. patent application Ser. Nos. 12/829,282; 13/046,572; 13/250,430; 12/965,709; 13/336,975 and 13/486.731, the full disclosures of which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entireties for all purposes. Accordingly, in one embodiment the present disclosure provides a method for preparing any of the carbon materials or polymer gels described above. The carbon materials may synthesized through pyrolysis of either a single precursor (such as chitosan) or from a complex resin, formed using a sol-gel method using polymer precursors such as phenol, resorcinol, urea, melamine, etc. in water, ethanol, methanol, etc. with formaldehyde. The resin may be acid or basic, and possibly contain a catalyst. The pyrolysis temperature and dwell time may be optimized as described below.
  • In some embodiments, the methods comprise preparation of a polymer gel by a sol gel process, condensation process or crosslinking process involving monomer precursor(s) and a crosslinking agent, two existing polymers and a crosslinking agent or a single polymer and a crosslinking agent, followed by pyrolysis of the polymer gel. The polymer gel may be dried (e.g., freeze dried) prior to pyrolysis; however drying is not required and in some embodiments is not desired. The sol gel process provides significant flexibility such that an electrochemical modifier can be incorporated at any number of steps. In one embodiment, a method for preparing a polymer gel comprising an electrochemical modifier is provided. In another embodiment, methods for preparing pyrolyzed polymer gels are provided. Details of the variable process parameters of the various embodiments of the disclosed methods are described below.
  • The target carbon properties can be derived from a variety of polymer chemistries provided the polymerization reaction produces a resin/polymer with the necessary carbon backbone. Different polymer families include novolacs, resoles, acrylates, styrenics, ureathanes, rubbers (neoprenes, styrene-butadienes, etc.), nylons, etc. The preparation of any of these polymer resins can occur via a number of different processes including sol gel, emulsion/suspension, solid state, solution state, melt state, etc. for either polymerization and crosslinking processes.
  • The polymer gels may be prepared by a sol gel process. For example, the polymer gel may be prepared by co-polymerizing one or more polymer precursors in an appropriate solvent. In one embodiment, the one or more polymer precursors are copolymerized under acidic conditions. In some embodiments, a first polymer precursor is a phenolic compound and a second polymer precursor is an aldehyde compound. In one embodiment, of the method the phenolic compound is phenol, resorcinol, catechol, hydroquinone, phloroglucinol, or a combination thereof and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde, acetaldehyde, propionaldehyde, butyraldehyde, benzaldehyde, cinnamaldehyde, or a combination thereof. In a further embodiment, the phenolic compound is resorcinol, phenol or a combination thereof, and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde. In yet further embodiments, the phenolic compound is resorcinol and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde. Other polymer precursors include nitrogen containing compounds such as melamine, urea and ammonia. In some cases the precursors include silicon containing compounds such as silanes (silane, dimethyl silane, diethylsilane, chlorosilane, chloromethyl silane, chloroethyl silane, dichloro silane, dichlorodimethyl silane, dichlorodiethyl silane, diphenylsilane, tristrimethylsilyl silane) siloxane, silica, silicon carbide.
  • In some embodiments, the electrochemical modifier is incorporated as a metal salt into the mixture from which the gel resin is produced. In some embodiments, the metal salt dissolved into the mixture from which the gel resin is produced is soluble in the reaction mixture. In this case, the mixture from which the gel resin is produced may contain an acid and/or alcohol which improves the solubility of the metal salt. The metal-containing polymer gel can be optionally freeze dried, followed by pyrolysis. Alternatively, the metal-containing polymer gel is not freeze dried prior to pyrolysis.
  • In some embodiments the electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the material as a polymer. For example, the organic or carbon containing polymer, RF (resorcinol-formaldehyde) for example, is copolymerized with the polymer, which contains the electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier-containing polymer contains silicon. In one embodiment the polymer is tetraethylorthosiliane (TEOS). In one embodiment, a TEOS solution is added to the RF solution prior to or during polymerization. In another embodiment the polymer is a polysilane with organic side groups. In some cases these side groups are methyl groups, in other cases these groups are phenyl groups, in other cases the side chains include phenyl, pyrrole, acetate, vinyl, siloxane fragments. In some cases the side chain includes a group 14 element (silicon, germanium, tin or lead). In other cases the side chain includes a group 13 element (boron, aluminum, boron, gallium, indium). In other cases the side chain includes a group 15 element (nitrogen, phosphorous, arsenic). In other cases the side chain includes a group 16 element (oxygen, sulfur, selenium).
  • In another embodiment the electrochemical modifier is a silole. In some cases it is a phenol-silole or a silafluorene. In other cases it is a poly-silole or a poly-silafluorene. In some cases the silicon is replaced with germanium (germole or germafluorene), tin (stannole or stannaflourene) nitrogen (carbazole) or phosphorous (phosphole, phosphafluorene). In all cases the heteroatom containing material can be a small molecule, an oligomer or a polymer. Phosphorous atoms may or may not be also bonded to oxygen.
  • In certain embodiments the heteroatom containing polymer is a physical mixture with the carbon polymer. In another case it is a copolymer. In another case a block or multi-block copolymer. In other cases it is in the polymer side chain, main chain or a small molecule used to crosslink the carbon polymers. Heteroatoms include but are not limited to Group 14 elements (Si, Ge, Sn, Pb), Group 15 elements (N, P, As, Sb), Group 16 elements (O, S, Se, Te).
  • In another embodiment the electrochemical modifier is a silicon dendrimer. In one case it is a first generation dendrimer. In another case it is a higher generation dendrimer. In some embodiments the polymer and dendrimer form a mixture. In other embodiments the dendrimer is covalently bonded to the polymer. In other embodiments the dendrimer is ionically bonded to the polymer.
  • In some embodiments the polymerization reaction contains phosphorous. In certain other embodiments, the phosphorus is in the form of phosphoric acid. In certain other embodiments, the phosphorus can be in the form of a salt, wherein the anion of the salt comprises one or more phosphate, phosphite, phosphide, hydrogen phosphate, dihydrogen phosphate, hexafluorophosphate, hypophosphite, polyphosphate, or pyrophosphate ions, or combinations thereof. In certain other embodiments, the phosphorus can be in the form of a salt, wherein the cation of the salt comprises one or more phosphonium ions. The non-phosphate containing anion or cation pair for any of the above embodiments can be chosen for those known and described in the art. In the context, exemplary cations to pair with phosphate-containing anions include, but are not limited to, ammonium, tetraethylammonium, and tetramethylammonium ions. In the context, exemplary anions to pair with phosphate-containing cations include, but are not limited to, carbonate, dicarbonate, and acetate ions.
  • In some cases the crosslinker is important because of its chemical and electrochemical properties. In other cases the crosslinker is important because it locks in the polymer geometry. In other cases both polymer geometry and chemical composition are important.
  • The crosslinker can react at either low or high temperatures. In some cases a portion of the reaction will occur at low temperatures with the rest of the reaction occurring at higher temperatures. Both extent of crosslinking and reaction kinetics can be measured by a variety of chemical techniques (TGA, FTIR, NMR, XRD, etc.) and physical techniques (indentation, tensile testing, modulus, hardness, etc.).
  • In some cases it will be favorable to have the electrochemical modifier and/or crosslinker evenly distributed throughout the initial co-polymer—a homogenous mixture. In other cases it is important to have an uneven distribution of crosslinker and/or electrochemical modified throughout the initial co-polymer.
  • The structure of the polymer precursors is not particularly limited, provided that the polymer precursor is capable of reacting with another polymer precursor or with a second polymer precursor to form a polymer. Polymer precursors include, but are not limited to, amine-containing compounds, alcohol-containing compounds and carbonyl-containing compounds. In some embodiments the polymer precursors are selected from an alcohol, a phenol, a polyalcohol, a sugar, an alkyl amine, an aromatic amine, an aldehyde, a ketone, a carboxylic acid, an ester, a urea, an acid halide, an alkene, an alkyne, an acrylate, an epoxide and an isocyanate.
  • Various monomers, molecular components, oligomers and polymeric materials may be combined to make a variety of polymers including, novolacs, resoles, novolac epoxides (comprised of one or more of phenol, resorcinol, formaldehyde, epichlorohydrin, bisphenol-A, bisphenol-F, epoxide), rubbers (isoprene, styrene-butadiene, styrene-butadiene-styrene, isobutylene, polyacrylate rubber, ethylenene-acrylate rubber, bromo-isobutylene, isoprene, polybutadiene, chloro isobutadiene isoprene, polychloroprene, epichlorohydrin, ethylene propylene, ethylene propylene diene monomer, polyether urethane, perfluorocarbon rubber, fluorosilicone, hydrogenated nitrile butadiene, acrylonitrile butadiene, polyurethane), nylons (including nylon-6; nylon-6,6; nylon-6,9; nylon-6,10; nylon-6,12; nylon-11, nylon-12; and nylon-4,6), acrylates (methylacrylate, ethyl acrylate, 2-Chloroethyl-vinyl ether, 2-Ethylehexyl acrylate, hydroyethyl methacrylate, butyl acrylate, butyl methacrylate, acrylonitrile), polystyrene, and polyurethanes (composed of ethylene glycol, diethylene glycol, triethylene glycol, tetraethylene glycol, propylene glycol, tripropylene glycol, 1,3-propanediol, 1,3-butanediol, 1,4-butanediol, neopentyl glycol, 1,6-hexanediol, ethanolamine, diethanolamine, methyldiethanolamine, pehnyldiethanolamine, glycerol, trimethylolpropane, 1,2,6-hexanetriol, triethanolamine, pentaerythritol, diethyltoluenediamine, dimethylthiotoluenediamine).
  • In some cases the polymer precursor materials include (a) alcohols, phenolic compounds, and other mono- or polyhydroxy compounds and (b) aldehydes, ketones, and combinations thereof. Representative alcohols in this context include straight chain and branched, saturated and unsaturated alcohols. Suitable phenolic compounds include polyhydroxy benzene, such as a dihydroxy or trihydroxy benzene. Representative polyhydroxy benzenes include resorcinol (i.e., 1,3-dihydroxy benzene), catechol, hydroquinone, and phloroglucinol. Mixtures of two or more polyhydroxy benzenes can also be used. Phenol (monohydroxy benzene) can also be used. Representative polyhydroxy compounds include sugars, such as glucose, and other polyols, such as mannitol. Aldehydes in this context include: straight chain saturated aldehydes such as methanal (formaldehyde), ethanal (acetaldehyde), propanal (propionaldehyde), butanal (butyraldehyde), and the like; straight chain unsaturated aldehydes such as ethenone and other ketenes, 2-propenal (acrylaldehyde), 2-butenal (crotonaldehyde), 3 butenal, and the like; branched saturated and unsaturated aldehydes; and aromatic-type aldehydes such as benzaldehyde, salicylaldehyde, hydrocinnamaldehyde, and the like. Suitable ketones include: straight chain saturated ketones such as propanone and 2 butanone, and the like; straight chain unsaturated ketones such as propenone, 2 butenone, and 3-butenone (methyl vinyl ketone) and the like; branched saturated and unsaturated ketones; and aromatic-type ketones such as methyl benzyl ketone (phenylacetone), ethyl benzyl ketone, and the like. The polymer precursor materials can also be combinations of the precursors described above.
  • In one embodiment, the method comprises use of a first and second polymer precursor, and in some embodiments the first or second polymer precursor is a carbonyl containing compound and the other of the first or second polymer precursor is an alcohol containing compound. In some embodiments, a first polymer precursor is a phenolic compound and a second polymer precursor is an aldehyde compound (e.g., formaldehyde). In one embodiment, of the method the phenolic compound is phenol, resorcinol, catechol, hydroquinone, phloroglucinol, or a combination thereof; and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde, acetaldehyde, propionaldehyde, butyraldehyde, benzaldehyde, cinnamaldehyde, or a combination thereof. In a further embodiment, the phenolic compound is resorcinol, phenol or a combination thereof, and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde. In yet further embodiments, the phenolic compound is resorcinol and the aldehyde compound is formaldehyde. In some embodiments, the polymer precursors are alcohols and carbonyl compounds (e.g., resorcinol and aldehyde) and they are present in a ratio of about 0.5:1.0, respectively.
  • In some embodiments, one polymer precursor is an alcohol-containing species and another polymer precursor is a carbonyl-containing species. The relative amounts of alcohol-containing species (e.g., alcohols, phenolic compounds and mono- or poly-hydroxy compounds or combinations thereof) reacted with the carbonyl containing species (e.g. aldehydes, ketones or combinations thereof) can vary substantially. In some embodiments, the ratio of alcohol-containing species to aldehyde species is selected so that the total moles of reactive alcohol groups in the alcohol-containing species is approximately the same as the total moles of reactive carbonyl groups in the aldehyde species. Similarly, the ratio of alcohol-containing species to ketone species may be selected so that the total moles of reactive alcohol groups in the alcohol containing species is approximately the same as the total moles of reactive carbonyl groups in the ketone species. The same general 1:1 molar ratio holds true when the carbonyl-containing species comprises a combination of an aldehyde species and a ketone species.
  • In other embodiments, the polymer precursor is a urea or an amine containing compound. For example, in some embodiments the polymer precursor is urea or melamine. Other embodiments include polymer precursors selected from isocyanates or other activated carbonyl compounds such as acid halides and the like.
  • In some embodiments of the methods described herein, the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 5:1 to about 2000:1 or the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 20:1 to about 200:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 25:1 to about 100:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 5:1 to about 10:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of phenolic precursor to catalyst is from about 100:1 to about 5:1.
  • In the specific embodiment wherein one of the polymer precursors is resorcinol and another polymer precursor is formaldehyde, the resorcinol to catalyst ratio can be varied to obtain the desired properties of the resultant polymer gel and carbon materials. In some embodiments of the methods described herein, the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 10:1 to about 2000:1 or the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 20:1 to about 200:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 25:1 to about 100:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 5:1 to about 10:1. In further embodiments, the molar ratio of resorcinol to catalyst is from about 100:1 to about 5:1.
  • The total solids content in the solution or suspension prior to polymer gel formation can be varied. The weight ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.05 to 1 to about 0.70 to 1. Alternatively, the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.15 to 1 to about 0.6 to 1. Alternatively, the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.15 to 1 to about 0.35 to 1. Alternatively, the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.25 to 1 to about 0.5 to 1. Alternatively, the ratio of resorcinol to water is from about 0.3 to 1 to about 0.35 to 0.6.
  • Examples of solvents useful in the preparation of the polymer gels disclosed herein include but are not limited to water or alcohols such as, for example, ethanol, t butanol, methanol or combinations thereof as well as aqueous mixtures of the same. Such solvents are useful for dissolution of the polymer precursor materials, for example dissolution of the phenolic compound. In addition, in some processes such solvents are employed for solvent exchange in the polymer gel (prior to freezing and drying), wherein the solvent from the polymerization of the precursors, for example, resorcinol and formaldehyde, is exchanged for a pure alcohol. In one embodiment of the present application, a polymer gel is prepared by a process that does not include solvent exchange.
  • Suitable catalysts in the preparation of the polymer gels include volatile basic catalysts that facilitate polymerization of the precursor materials into a monolithic polymer. The catalyst can also comprise various combinations of the catalysts described above. In embodiments comprising phenolic compounds, such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 200:1 phenolic compound:catalyst. For example, in some specific embodiments such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 10:1 phenolic compound:catalyst.
  • In some embodiments, the gel polymerization process is performed under catalytic conditions. Accordingly, in some embodiments, the method comprises admixing a catalyst with the solvent-free mixture. In some embodiments, the catalyst is a solid at room temperature and pressure.
  • In some embodiments, the catalyst is a liquid at room temperature and pressure. In some embodiments, the catalyst is a liquid at room temperature and pressure that does not provide dissolution of one or more of the other polymer precursors.
  • In some embodiments, the catalyst comprises a basic volatile catalyst. For example, in one embodiment, the basic volatile catalyst comprises ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium acetate, ammonium hydroxide, or combinations thereof. In a further embodiment, the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium carbonate. In another further embodiment, the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium acetate.
  • The molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor (e.g., phenolic compound) may have an effect on the final properties of the polymer gel as well as the final properties of the carbon materials. Thus, in some embodiments such catalysts are used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 2000:1 polymer precursor:catalyst. In some embodiments, such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 10:1 to 400:1 polymer precursor:catalyst. For example in other embodiments, such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 100:1 polymer precursor:catalyst. For example, in some embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 400:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 100:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 50:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor is about 10:1. In certain of the foregoing embodiments, the polymer precursor is a phenolic compound such as resorcinol or phenol.
  • In still other embodiments, the method comprises admixing an acid with the solvent-free mixture. In certain embodiments, the acid is a solid at room temperature and pressure. In some embodiments, the acid is a liquid at room temperature and pressure. In some embodiments, the acid is a liquid at room temperature and pressure that does not provide dissolution of one or more of the other polymer precursors.
  • The acid may be selected from any number of acids suitable for the polymerization process. For example, in some embodiments the acid is acetic acid and in other embodiments the acid is oxalic acid. In further embodiments, the acid is mixed with the first or second solvent in a ratio of acid to solvent of 99:1, 90:10, 75:25, 50:50, 25:75, 20:80, 10:90 or 1:90. In other embodiments, the acid is acetic acid and the first or second solvent is water. In other embodiments, acidity is provided by adding a solid acid.
  • The total content of acid in the mixture can be varied to alter the properties of the final product. In some embodiments, the acid is present from about 1% to about 50% by weight of mixture. In other embodiments, the acid is present from about 5% to about 25%. In other embodiments, the acid is present from about 10% to about 20%, for example about 10%, about 15% or about 20%.
  • In certain embodiments, the polymer precursor components are blended together and subsequently held for a time and at a temperature sufficient to achieve polymerization. One or more of the polymer precursor components can have particle size less than about 20 mm in size, for example less than 10 mm, for example less than 7 mm, for example, less than 5 mm, for example less than 2 mm, for example less than 1 mm, for example less than 100 microns, for example less than 10 microns. In some embodiments, the particle size of one or more of the polymer precursor components is reduced during the blending process.
  • The blending of one or more polymer precursor components in the absence of solvent can be accomplished by methods described in the art, for example ball milling, jet milling, Fritsch milling, planetary mixing, and other mixing methodologies for mixing or blending solid particles while controlling the process conditions (e.g., temperature). The mixing or blending process can be accomplish before, during, and/or after (or combinations thereof) incubation at the reaction temperature.
  • Reaction parameters include aging the blended mixture at a temperature and for a time sufficient for the one or more polymer precursors to react with each other and form a polymer. In this respect, suitable aging temperature ranges from about room temperature to temperatures at or near the melting point of one or more of the polymer precursors. In some embodiments, suitable aging temperature ranges from about room temperature to temperatures at or near the glass transition temperature of one or more of the polymer precursors. For example, in some embodiments the solvent free mixture is aged at temperatures from about 20° C. to about 600° C., for example about 20° C. to about 500° C., for example about 20° C. to about 400° C., for example about 20° C. to about 300° C., for example about 20° C. to about 200° C. In certain embodiments, the solvent free mixture is aged at temperatures from about 50 to about 250° C.
  • The reaction duration is generally sufficient to allow the polymer precursors to react and form a polymer, for example the mixture may be aged anywhere from 1 hour to 48 hours, or more or less depending on the desired result. Typical embodiments include aging for a period of time ranging from about 2 hours to about 48 hours, for example in some embodiments aging comprises about 12 hours and in other embodiments aging comprises about 4-8 hours (e.g., about 6 hours).
  • In certain embodiments, an electrochemical modifier is incorporated during the above described polymerization process. For example, in some embodiments, an electrochemical modifier in the form of metal particles, metal paste, metal salt, metal oxide or molten metal can be dissolved or suspended into the mixture from which the gel resin is produced
  • Exemplary electrochemical modifiers for producing the composite materials may fall into one or more than one of the chemical classifications listed in Table 1.
  • TABLE 1
    Exemplary Electrochemical Modifiers
    for Producing Composite Materials
    Chemical Classification Example Precursor Materials
    Saccharides Chitin
    Chitosan
    Glucose
    Sucrose
    Fructose
    Cellulose
    Biopolymers Lignin
    Proteins Gelatin
    Amines and Ureas Urea
    Melamine
    Halogen Salts LiBr
    NaCl
    KF
    Nitrate Salts NaNO3
    LiNO3
    Carbides SiC
    CaC2
    Metal Containing Aluminum isoproproxide
    Compounds Manganese Acetate
    Nickel Acetate
    Iron Acetate
    Tin Chloride
    Silicon Chloride
    Hydrocarbons Propane
    Butane
    Ethylene
    Cyclohexane
    Methane
    Benzene
    Ethane
    Hexane
    Octane
    Pentane
    Alcohols Isopropanol
    Ethanol
    Methanol
    Butanol
    Ethylene Glycol
    Xylitol
    Menthol
    Phosphate Phytic Acid
    Compounds H3PO3
    NH4H2PO3
    Na3PO3
    Ketones Acetone
    Ethyl Methyl Ketone
    Acetophenone
    Muscone
    Polymers TEOS
    Etc.
    Silicons Silico(powders, nanoparticles, nanotubes, etc.
    Polycrystalline silicon
    Nanocrystalline silicon
    Amorphous silicon
    Porous silicon
    Silicyne
    Black silicon
  • Electrochemical modifiers can be combined with a variety of polymer systems through either physical mixing or chemical reactions with latent (or secondary) polymer functionality. Examples of latent polymer functionality include, but are not limited to, epoxide groups, unsaturation (double and triple bonds), acid groups, alcohol groups, amine groups, basic groups. Crosslinking with latent functionality can occur via heteroatoms (e.g. vulcanization with sulfur, acid/base/ring opening reactions with phosphoric acid), reactions with organic acids or bases (described above), coordination to transition metals (including but not limited to Ti, Cr, Mn, Fe, Co, Ni, Cu, Zn, Zr, Nb, Mo, Ag, Au), ring opening or ring closing reactions (rotaxanes, spiro compounds, etc.).
  • Polymerization to form a polymer gel can be accomplished by various means described in the art and may include addition of an electrochemical modifier. For instance, polymerization can be accomplished by incubating suitable polymer precursor materials, and optionally an electrochemical modifier, in the presence of a suitable catalyst for a sufficient period of time. The time for polymerization can be a period ranging from minutes or hours to days, depending on the temperature (the higher the temperature the faster, the reaction rate, and correspondingly, the shorter the time required). The polymerization temperature can range from room temperature to a temperature approaching (but lower than) the boiling point of the starting solution. For example, in some embodiments the polymer gel is aged at temperatures from about 20° C. to about 120° C., for example about 20° C. to about 100° C. Other embodiments include temperature ranging from about 30° C. to about 90° C., for example about 45° C. or about 85° C. In other embodiments, the temperature ranges from about 65° C. to about 80° C., while other embodiments include aging at two or more temperatures, for example about 45° C. and about 75-85° C. or about 80-85° C.
  • Electrochemical modifiers can also be added to the polymer system through physical blending. Physical blending can include but is not limited to melt blending of polymers and/or co-polymers, the inclusion of discrete particles, chemical vapor deposition of the electrochemical modifier and coprecipitation of the electrochemical modifier and the main polymer material.
  • In another embodiment the electrochemical modifier is a particle. The particles of electrochemical modifier can be added with differing particle size distributions. In one embodiment the electrochemical modifier particles have a D50 of 10 nm or 50 nm or 100 nm or 150 nm or 200 nm or 500 nm or 1 um or 1.5 um or 2 um or 3 um or 5 um or 10 um or 20 um or 40 um or up to 50 um, or up to 100 um. In some embodiments the polymer and particle form a mixture. In other embodiments the particle is covalently bonded to the polymer. In other embodiments the particle is ionically bonded to the polymer. In some cases the particle is silicon, in other cases the particles are a different Group 14 elements (Ge, Sn, Pb), Group 15 elements (P, As, Sb), Group 16 elements (S, Se, Te). In some cases the particle is comprised of a single element, in other cases it is comprised of a mixture of two or more elements.
  • Electrochemical modifier particles can be dispersed in the organic polymer solution or pre-polymer in a variety of ways. In one embodiment, the particles are dispersed by sonication. In another embodiment, the particles are dispersed by mixing. In another embodiment, the particles are dispersed by modifying the surface chemistry of the particles or the pH of the solution. In another embodiment, the particles are dispersed by use of a surfactant. In one embodiment, the surfactant is SPAN 80. In another embodiment the particles are dispersed in an emulsion or suspension. In one embodiment the surfactant is used in combination with a hydrocarbon solvent. In one embodiment, the hydrocarbon is cyclohexane. In one embodiment the hydrocarbon is mineral oil. In another embodiment the hydrocarbon is vegetable oil.
  • In some instances the electrochemical modifier can be added via a metal salt solution. The metal salt solution or suspension may comprise acids and/or alcohols to improve solubility of the metal salt. In yet another variation, the polymer gel (either before or after an optional drying step) is contacted with a paste comprising the electrochemical modifier. In yet another variation, the polymer gel (either before or after an optional drying step) is contacted with a metal or metal oxide sol comprising the desired electrochemical modifier.
  • In addition to the above exemplified electrochemical modifiers, the composite materials may comprise one or more additional forms (i.e., allotropes) of carbon. In this regard, it has been found that inclusion of different allotropes of carbon such as graphite, amorphous carbon, diamond, C60, carbon nanotubes (e.g., single and/or multi-walled), graphene and/or carbon fibers into the composite materials is effective to optimize the electrochemical properties of the composite materials in certain embodiments. The various allotropes of carbon can be incorporated into the carbon materials during any stage of the preparation process described herein. For example, during the solution phase, during the gelation phase, during the curing phase, during the pyrolysis phase, during the milling phase, or after milling. In some embodiments, the second carbon form is incorporated into the composite material by adding the second carbon form before or during polymerization of the polymer gel as described in more detail herein. The polymerized polymer gel containing the second carbon form is then processed according to the general techniques described herein to obtain a carbon material containing a second allotrope of carbon.
  • In some embodiments the organic polymer and the electrochemical modifier have different solvents, ratios of solvents, mixtures of solvents, catalysts type, catalyst ratios, solvent pH, type of acid, or base.
  • In certain embodiments, by changing either the relative solids concentration of the carbon containing polymer solution and/or the relative solids concentration of the electrochemical modifier containing polymer solution, the electrochemical modifier content of the final composite can be varied. In one embodiment the solids concentration of the organic polymer solution can be varied between 1% to 99% solids or from 10% to 90% solids, or from 20% to 80% solids or from 20% to 50% or from 30% to 40% solids. In one embodiment the solids concentration of the polymer solution is 35%. In one embodiment the solids concentration of the electrochemical modifier polymer solution can be varied between 1% to 99% solids or from 10% to 90% solids, or from 20% to 80% solids or from 20% to 50% or from 30% to 40% solids. In one embodiment the solids concentration of the electrochemical modifier solution is 35%. In one embodiment the electrochemical modifier is a TEOS polymer is mixed with ethanol. In other embodiments, the TEOS polymer is mixed with acetone, or isopropyl alcohol.
  • Changing the ratio of organic polymer to the electrochemical modifier polymer solutions in any given mixture may alter the final ratio of the carbon to electrochemical modifier in the final composite. In one embodiment the ratio of organic polymer to electrochemical modifier polymer is about 10:1 or 9:1 or 8:1 or 7:1 or 6:1 or 5:1 or 4:1 or 3:1 or 2:1, or 1:1, or 1:2, or 1:3 or 1:4 or 1:5, or 1:6 or 1:7 or 1:8 or 1:9 or 1:10.
  • In one embodiment the organic polymer/electrochemical modifier polymer solution is heated until a gel is formed. In one embodiment a TEOS/RF solution is heated until a gel is formed. In one embodiment the heating is carried out in a sealed container. In one embodiment the heating is carried out in a polymer reactor. For example, a stirred polymer reactor. In one embodiment the solution is heated in an emulsion, or in an inverse emulsion or in a suspension. The temperature at which gelation takes place is known to impact the structure of the polymer and can be modified to control the structure of the final composite material. In one embodiment the gel is formed at 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C or 110 C or 120 C or 130 C. In one embodiment the gel is formed in a two-step reaction. For example one temperature to cause the organic polymer to gel and a different temperature to cause the electrochemical modifier polymer to gel. In one embodiment the two step polymerization is carried out at 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C or 110 C or 120 C or 130 C and then the second step is carried out at 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C or 110 C or 120 C or 130 C. In some embodiments the organic polymer is fully gelled and then a electrochemical modifier polymer solution is added through a solvent exchange to dope the organic polymer. In some embodiments the electrochemical modifier polymer is fully gelled and then an organic polymer solution is added through a solvent exchange to dope the electrochemical modifier polymer.
  • In some embodiments, an optional electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the polymer gel after the polymerization step, for example either before or after an optional drying and before pyrolyzing polymer gel. In some other embodiments, the polymer gel (either before or after and optional drying and prior to pyrolysis) is impregnated with electrochemical modifier by immersion in a metal salt solution or suspension or particles. In some embodiments, the particle comprises micronized silicon powder. In some embodiments, the particles are comprised of nanoparticles of silicon. In some embodiments, the particles are comprised of nanotubes of silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of polycrystalline silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of nanocrystalline silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of amorphous silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of porous silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of silicyne. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprised of black silicon. In certain embodiments, the particles are comprise a mixture of two or more different forms of silicon as exemplified above.
  • In some embodiments, the particle is tin. In still other embodiments, the particle is a combination of silicon, tin, carbon, or any oxides. Particles of electrochemical modifier can be added in different ratios to alter the electrochemical performance of the final composite. The electrochemical modifier can be added to create a specific ratio of carbon to electrochemical modifier after the polymer has been pyrolyzed and this ratio can range from 10:1-1:10. In one embodiment this ratio is 10:1 or 9:1 or 8:1 or 7:1 or 6:1 or 5:1 or 4:1 or 3:1 or 2:1, or 1:1, or 1:2, or 1:3 or 1:4 or 1:5, or 1:6 or 1:7 or 1:8 or 1:9 or 1:10. The particles of electrochemical modifier can be added with differing particle size distributions. In one embodiment the electrochemical modifier particles have a D50 of 10 nm or 50 nm or 100 nm or 150 nm or 200 nm or 500 nm or 1 um or 1.5 um or 2 um or 3 um or 5 um or 10 um. In some embodiments the electrochemical modifier is added prior to polymerization of the polymer solution. In some embodiments the electrochemical modifier is added at a point where the polymer solution is pre-polymerized or partially polymerized by heating to an elevated temperature such as 40 C or 50 C or 60 C or 70 C or 80 C or 90 C or 100 C to create a partially cross linked network.
  • The sol gel polymerization process is generally performed under catalytic conditions. Accordingly, in some embodiments, preparing the polymer gel comprises co-polymerizing one or more polymer precursors in the presence of a catalyst. In some embodiments, the catalyst comprises a basic volatile catalyst. For example, in one embodiment, the basic volatile catalyst comprises ammonium carbonate, ammonium bicarbonate, ammonium acetate, ammonium hydroxide, or combinations thereof. In a further embodiment, the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium carbonate. In another further embodiment, the basic volatile catalyst is ammonium acetate.
  • The molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor (e.g., phenolic or silicon based compound) may have an effect on the final properties of the polymer gel as well as the final properties of the carbon materials. Thus, in some embodiments such catalysts are used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 2000:1 polymer precursor compound:catalyst. In some embodiments, such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 10:1 to 400:1 polymer precursor compound:catalyst. For example in other embodiments, such catalysts can be used in the range of molar ratios of 5:1 to 100:1 polymer precursor compound:catalyst. For example, in some embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 400:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 100:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 50:1. In other embodiments the molar ratio of catalyst to polymer precursor compound is about 10:1.
  • The reaction solvent is another process parameter that may be varied to obtain the desired properties (e.g., surface area, porosity, purity, etc.) of the polymer gels and composite materials. In some embodiments, the solvent for preparation of the polymer gel is a mixed solvent system of water and a miscible co-solvent. For example, in certain embodiments the solvent comprises a water miscible acid. Examples of water miscible acids include, but are not limited to, propionic acid, acetic acid, and formic acid. In further embodiments, the solvent comprises a ratio of water-miscible acid to water of 99:1, 90:10, 75:25, 50:50, 25:75, 10:90 or 1:90. In other embodiments, acidity is provided by adding a solid acid to the reaction solvent.
  • In some other embodiments of the foregoing, the solvent for preparation of the polymer gel is acidic. For example, in certain embodiments the solvent comprises acetic acid. For example, in one embodiment, the solvent is 100% acetic acid. In other embodiments, a mixed solvent system is provided, wherein one of the solvents is acidic. For example, in one embodiment of the method the solvent is a binary solvent comprising acetic acid and water. In further embodiments, the solvent comprises a ratio of acetic acid to water of 99:1, 90:10, 75:25, 50:50, 25:75, 20:80, 10:90 or 1:90. In other embodiments, acidity is provided by adding a solid acid to the reaction solvent.
  • One embodiment of the present disclosure is a method for preparing polymer materials following a polymerization process in the absence of solvent. In one embodiment, the method comprises heating polymer gel particles that were formed in absence of solvent to obtain a carbon material, wherein the polymer has been prepared by a process comprising:
  • a) blending a mixture of solid and/or liquid polymer precursors; and
  • b) aging the mixture at a temperature and for a time sufficient to produce a solvent-free polymer network; and
  • In some embodiments, the solvent can be present at a level of less than 80% of the total mass of polymer to be processed into carbon, for example less than 70% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 60% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 50% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 40% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 30% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 20% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 10% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 1% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 0.1% of the total mass of polymer to be processed, less than 0.01% of the total mass of polymer to be processed.
  • The process can also occur in the melt state. Monomer or polymer components are heated above their melting point and then react to form an altered small molecule, a higher molecular weight thermoplastic or a crosslinked thermoset.
  • Another embodiment of the present disclosure provides a method for making polymer particles in gel form via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • a) preparing a reactant mixture comprising a monomer component comprising one or more phenolic compounds, one or more crosslinking compounds, and a carrier fluid; and
  • b) polymerizing the one or more phenolic compounds with the one or more crosslinking compounds,
  • wherein the carrier fluid comprises a surfactant in a concentration equal to or greater than the critical micelle concentration and the volume average particle size (Dv, 50) of the polymer particles is less than or equal to 1 mm.
  • In another embodiment, the disclosure provides a method for making polymer particles in gel form via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • a) preparing a reactant mixture comprising a monomer component comprising one or more phenolic compounds, one or more crosslinking compounds, and a carrier fluid; and
  • b) polymerizing the one or more phenolic compounds with the one or more crosslinking compounds,
  • wherein the carrier fluid comprises 50 wt % or more of cyclohexane, based on the total weight of the carrier fluid, and the volume average particle size (Dv, 50) of the polymer particles is less than or equal to 1 mm.
  • In still other embodiments, the disclosure is directed to a method for making polymer particles in gel form via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • a) preparing a reactant mixture comprising a monomer component comprising one or more phenolic compounds, one or more crosslinking compounds, and a carrier fluid; and
  • b) polymerizing the one or more phenolic compounds with the one or more crosslinking compounds,
  • wherein the carrier fluid comprises 50 wt % or more of cyclohexane, based on the total weight of the carrier fluid, and the volume average particle size (Dv, 50) of the polymer particles is greater than or equal to 1 mm.
  • In another embodiment the present application provides a method for preparing a condensation polymer gel via an emulsion or suspension process, the method comprising:
  • a) preparing a mixture comprising a continuous phase and a polymer phase, wherein the polymer phase comprises one or more polymer precursors and an optional solvent; and
  • b) aging the mixture at a temperature and for a time sufficient for the one or more polymer precursors to react with each other and form a condensation polymer gel.
  • In another embodiment, the disclosed methods include preparing a dried condensation polymer gel, the method comprises drying a condensation polymer gel, wherein the condensation polymer gel has been prepared by an emulsion or suspension process comprising:
  • a) preparing a mixture comprising a continuous phase and a polymer phase, wherein the polymer phase comprises one or more polymer precursors and an optional solvent; and
  • b) aging the mixture at a temperature and for a time sufficient for the one or more polymer precursors to react with each other and form a condensation polymer gel.
  • In yet other embodiments, the invention provides a method for preparing a carbon material, the method comprising heating condensation polymer gel particles to obtain a carbon material, wherein the condensation polymer gel particles have been prepared by a process comprising:
  • a) preparing a mixture comprising a continuous phase and a polymer phase, wherein the polymer phase comprises one or more polymer precursors and an optional solvent; and
  • b) aging the mixture at a temperature and for a time sufficient for the one or more polymer precursors to react with each other and form a condensation polymer gel.
  • The condensation polymer gel may be used without drying or the methods may further comprise drying the condensation polymer gel. In certain embodiments of the foregoing methods, the polymer gel is dried by freeze drying. The polymer formed in the emulsion or suspension can also be formed via an addition, free radical, or living polymerization method.
  • The methods are useful for preparation of condensation polymer gels and/or carbon materials having any number of various pore structures. In this regard, Applications have discovered that the pore structure can be controlled by variation of any number of process parameters such as continuous phase type, stir rate, temperature, aging time, etc. In some embodiments, the condensation polymer gel is microporous, and in other embodiments the condensation polymer gel is mesoporous. In certain other embodiments, the condensation polymer gel comprises a pore structure having a mixture of microporous and mesoporous pores.
  • In related embodiments, the carbon material is microporous or the carbon material is mesoporous. In other embodiments, the carbon material comprises a pore structure comprised of micropores, mesopores or macropores, or a combination thereof
  • The polymer phase may be prepared by admixing the one or more polymer precursors and the optional solvent, and in some examples the mixture is prepared by admixing the continuous phase and the polymer phase. The method includes embodiments wherein the mixture is an emulsion, while in other embodiments the mixture is a suspension.
  • For example, in some embodiments the continuous phase and the polymer phase are not miscible with each other, and the mixture is an emulsion. While in other exemplary methods the continuous phase and the polymer phase are not soluble in each other, and the mixture is a suspension. In other examples, the polymer phase is aged prior to preparation of the mixture, and the mixture is an emulsion and/or a suspension upon combination of the continuous phase and the polymer phase.
  • In other different aspects, both the continuous phase and the polymer phase are soluble in each other (i.e., miscible). In some variations of this embodiment, the continuous phase and polymer phase are miscible initially but the polymer phase is aged such that it becomes immiscible with the continuous phase and the mixture becomes a suspension upon aging.
  • The polymer phase may be prepared by admixing the one or more polymer precursors and the optional solvent. In some embodiments, the polymer phase is “pre-reacted” prior to mixing with the continuous phase such the polymer precursors are at least partially polymerized. In other embodiments, the polymer precursors are not pre-reacted. In certain other embodiments, the method is a continuous process. For example, the polymer precursors may be continuously mixed with a continuous phase and the final condensation polymer gel may be continuously isolated from the mixture.
  • A single polymer precursor may be used or the methods may comprise use of two or more different polymer precursors. The structure of the polymer precursors is not particularly limited, provided that the polymer precursor is capable of reacting with another polymer precursor or with a second polymer precursor to form a polymer.
  • 2. Creation of Polymer Gel Particles
  • A monolithic polymer gel can be physically disrupted to create smaller particles according to various techniques known in the art. The resultant polymer gel particles generally have an average diameter of less than about 30 mm, for example, in the size range of about 1 mm to about 25 mm, or between about 1 mm to about 5 mm or between about 0.5 mm to about 10 mm. Alternatively, the size of the polymer gel particles can be in the range below about 1 mm, for example, in the size range of about 10 to 1000 microns. Techniques for creating polymer gel particles from monolithic material include manual or machine disruption methods, such as sieving, grinding, milling, or combinations thereof. Such methods are well-known to those of skill in the art. Various types of mills can be employed in this context such as roller, bead, and ball mills and rotary crushers and similar particle creation equipment known in the art.
  • In other embodiments, the polymer gel particles are in the range of 0.1 microns to 2.5 cm, from about 0.1 microns to about 1 cm, from about 1 micron to about 1000 microns, from about 1 micron to about 100 microns, from about 1 micron to about 50 microns, from about 1 micron to about 25 microns or from about 1 microns to about 10 microns. In other embodiments, the polymer gel particles are in the range of about 1 mm to about 100 mm, from about 1 mm to about 50 mm, from about 1 mm to about 25 mm or from about 1 mm to about 10 mm.
  • In an embodiment, a roller mill is employed. A roller mill has three stages to gradually reduce the size of the gel particles. The polymer gels are generally very brittle and are not damp to the touch. Consequently they are easily milled using this approach; however, the width of each stage must be set appropriately to achieve the targeted final mesh. This adjustment is made and validated for each combination of gel recipe and mesh size. Each gel is milled via passage through a sieve of known mesh size. Sieved particles can be temporarily stored in sealed containers.
  • In one embodiment, a rotary crusher is employed. The rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about ⅛th inch. In another embodiment, the rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about ⅜th inch. In another embodiment, the rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about ⅝th inch. In another embodiment, the rotary crusher has a screen mesh size of about ⅜th inch.
  • Milling can be accomplished at room temperature according to methods well known to those of skill in the art. Alternatively, milling can be accomplished cryogenically, for example by co-milling the polymer gel with solid carbon dioxide (dry ice) particles.
  • In one embodiment the polymer gel particles are formed by emulsion/suspension. As described above, a mixture of organic polymer solution can be mixed with electrochemical modifier particles, for example, through sonication or other methods. The mixture can then be stirred or further sonicated into a solution or continuous phase that is used to create an emulsion or suspension or an inverse emulsion. In one embodiment, the continuous phase contains cyclohexane. In one embodiment, the continuous phase contains a surfactant. In one embodiment, the continuous phase contains SPAN 80 as a surfactant. In one embodiment, the continuous phase contains mineral oil. In one embodiment, the continuous phase contains vegetable oil. In one embodiment, the continuous phase is largely free of cyclohexane. The ratio of surfactant can be modified to control the formation of particles. In one embodiment, the continuous phase has a ratio of surfactant to continuous phase of 200:1 v/v. In one embodiment, the continuous phase has a ratio of surfactant to continuous phase of 2000:1 v/v.
  • 3. Soaking or Treatment of Polymer Gels
  • The organic polymer gels described above, can be further soaked or treated for the inclusion of an optional electrochemical modifier. The inclusion of the electrochemical modifier may change both the electrochemical properties of the final product when used in a lithium battery and/or change the physical/chemical properties of the material.
  • In some embodiments, an electrochemical modifier is added through a liquid phase soaking or solvent exchange. The solvent used may be the same or different than that used in the polymer gel process. Generally, for soaking, wet polymer gels are weighed and placed into a larger container. A solution containing a solvent and a precursor for electrochemical modification is combined with the wet polymer gel to form a mixture. The mixture is left to soak at a set stir rate, temperature and time. Upon completion, the excess solvent is decanted from the mixture. In other embodiments, the optional electrochemical modifier is added through a vapor phase.
  • In some embodiments, the precursor may be soluble in the solvent. For precursors that are soluble in the chosen solvent, in some embodiments, the solution may be unsaturated, saturated, or super saturated. In other embodiments, the precursor may be insoluble and therefore suspended in the solvent.
  • In some embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 20 to 30° C. In other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 30 to 40° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 40 to 50° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 50 to 60° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 60 to 70° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 70 to 80° C. In yet other embodiments, the soak temperature ranges from 80 to 100° C.
  • In some embodiments, the soak time (the period of time between the combination of the wet polymer gel and the solution and the decanting of the excess liquid) is from about 0 hours to about 5 hours. In other embodiments, the soak time ranges from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, between about 30 minute and 90 minutes, and between about 40 minutes and 60 minutes. In yet other embodiments, the soak time is between about from about 0 hours to about 10 hours, from about 0 hours to about 20 hours, from about 10 hours to about 100 hours, from about 10 hours to about 15 hours, or from about 5 hours to about 10 hours.
  • In some embodiments, the stir rate is between 0 and 10 rpm. In other embodiments, the stir rate is between 10 and 15 rpm, between 15 and 20 rpm, between 20 and 30 rpm, between 30 and 50 rpm, between 50 and 100 rpm, between 100 and 200 rpm, between 200 and 1000 rpm, or greater than 1000 rpm. In yet other embodiments, the mixture undergoes no artificial agitation.
  • 4. Carbon Materials and Composites
  • The polymer gels described above, can be further processed to obtain the desired composite materials. Such processing includes, for example, pyrolysis. Generally, in the pyrolysis process, wet polymer gels are weighed and placed in a rotary kiln. The temperature ramp is set at 10° C. per minute, the dwell time and dwell temperature are set; cool down is determined by the natural cooling rate of the furnace. The entire process is usually run under an inert atmosphere, such as a nitrogen environment. However, in certain embodiments, the gas may be a hydrocarbon listed in table 1, such as methane, or ammonia. Pyrolyzed samples are then removed and weighed. Other pyrolysis processes are well known to those of skill in the art.
  • In some embodiments, an optional electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the carbon material after pyrolysis of the polymer gel. For example, the electrochemical modifier can be incorporated into the pyrolyzed polymer gel by contacting the pyrolyzed polymer gel with the electrochemical modifier, for example, colloidal metal, molten metal, metal salt, metal paste, metal oxide or other sources of metals. In one embodiment molten tin as an electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the pyrolyzed organic polymer during or after pyrolysis. In one embodiment tin chloride as an electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the pyrolyzed organic polymer during or after pyrolysis. In one embodiment, tin chloride is in the form of tin tetrachloride. In one embodiment silicon chloride as an electrochemical modifier is incorporated into the pyrolyzed organic polymer during or after pyrolysis. In one embodiment, tin chloride is in the form of silicon tetrachloride
  • In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • Pyrolysis may also be carried out more slowly than described above. For example, in one embodiment the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 480 minutes. In other embodiments, the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 240 minutes.
  • In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 850° C. to about 1050° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C.
  • In some embodiments, the pyrolysis dwell temperature is varied during the course of pyrolysis. In one embodiment, the pyrolysis is carried out in a rotary kiln with separate, distinct heating zones. The temperature for each zone is sequentially decreased from the entrance to the exit end of the rotary kiln tube. In one embodiment, the pyrolysis is carried out in a rotary kiln with separate distinct heating zones, and the temperature for each zone is sequentially increased from entrance to exit end of the rotary kiln tube.
  • In yet other embodiments, the surface of the composite may be modified during pyrolysis due to the thermal breakdown of solid, liquid or gas precursors. Theses precursors may include any of the chemicals listed in Table 1. In one embodiment the precursors may be introduced prior to pyrolysis under room temperature conditions. In a second embodiment, the precursors may be introduced while the material is at an elevated temperature during pyrolysis. In a third embodiment, the precursors may be introduced post-pyrolysis. Multiple precursors or a mixture of precursors for chemical and structural modification may also be used. In one embodiment a reducing gas is used to reduce the electrochemical modifier into its elemental form. In one embodiment, the reducing gas is hydrogen. In one embodiment, the reducing gas is ammonia. In one embodiment, the reducing gas is hydrogen sulfide. In one embodiment, the reducing gas is carbon monoxide.
  • The composite may also undergo an additional heat treatment step to help change the surface functionality. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 850° C. to about 1050° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 800° C. to about 1100° C.
  • In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 300 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • Pyrolysis may also be carried out more slowly than described above. For example, in one embodiment the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 480 minutes. In other embodiments, the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 240 minutes.
  • In one embodiment the composite may also undergo a heat treatment under a volatile gas, such as a hydrocarbon listed in Table 1. Wishing not to be bound by theory, the hydrocarbon or volatile gas may decompose or react on the surface of the composite when exposed to elevated temperatures. The volatile may leave behind a thin layer, such as a soft carbon, covering the surface of the composite. In one embodiment the material comprising an electrochemical modifier is subjected to coating with soft carbon layer. In one embodiment silicon powders are coated with soft carbon to form a composite. In another embodiment tin powder is coated with soft carbon to form a composite.
  • In one embodiment the gas may be piped in directly from a compressed tank. In another embodiment the gas may originate through the heating of a liquid and the mixing of an inert carrier gas using a bubbler technique commonly known in the art. In another embodiment, as solid or liquid may be placed upstream of the sample and decompose into a volatile gas, which then reacts with the carbon in the hot zone.
  • In one embodiment the vapor deposition may be completed under a static gas environment. In another embodiment the vapor deposition may be completed in a dynamic, gas flowing environment but wherein the carbon is static. In yet another embodiment, the vapor deposition may be completed under continuous coating, wherein the gas and the carbon are flowing through a hot zone. In still yet another embodiment the vapor deposition may be completed under continuous coating, wherein the gas and the carbon are flowing through a hot zone, but where the gas is flowing counter current to the solid carbon. In another embodiment the carbon is coated by chemical vapor deposition while rotating in a rotatory kiln.
  • The composite may also undergo a vapor deposition through the heating of a volatile gas at different temperatures. In some embodiments the electrochemical modifier is incorporated during the pyrolysis or high temperature treatment by a gas phase deposition of the desired compounds. In one embodiment the gas phase contains silicon. For example, in one embodiment the silicon is conveyed in the form of silane gas. In another embodiment, the silicon is conveyed in the form of trichlorosilane gas. In one embodiment the silicon containing gas is combined with nitrogen gas. In some embodiments the gas stream contains phospine, diborane, or arsine. In one embodiment the gas contains tin. In another embodiment the gas comprises vaporized elemental tin. In one embodiment the gas phase deposition of electrochemical modifier is performed in a kiln or in a fluidized bed. The pressure of the deposition can be modified to create a near vacuum condition. In some embodiments vapor deposition temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1000° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 800° C. to about 900° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 900° C. to about 1100° C., from about 950° C. to about 1050° C. or about 1000° C.
  • The composite may also undergo a vapor deposition through the heating of a volatile gas for different dwell times. In some embodiments, vapor deposition dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 5 hours, from about 10 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • The thickness of the layer of carbon deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition can be measured by HRTEM. In one embodiment the thickness of the layer is less than 0.1 nm, less than 0.5 nm, less than 1 nm, or less than 2 nm. In other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 1 nm and 100 nm. In yet other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 0.1 nm and 50 nm. In still other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 1 nm and 50 nm. In still other embodiments the thickness of the carbon layer deposited by vapor deposition of hydrocarbon decomposition measured by HRTEM is between 2 nm and 50 nm, for example between about 10 nm and 25 nm.
  • 5. One-Step Polymerization/Pyrolysis Procedure
  • A composite material may also be synthesized through a one-step polymerization/pyrolysis method. In general, the polymer is formed during the pyrolysis temperature ramp. The precursors are placed into a rotary kiln with an inert nitrogen atmosphere. The precursors will undergo polymerization within the kiln during the temperature ramp. There may or may not be an intermediate dwell time to allow for complete polymerization. After polymerization is complete, the temperature is once again increased, where the polymer undergoes pyrolysis as previously described.
  • In some embodiments the precursors comprise a saccharide, protein, or a biopolymer. Examples of saccharides include, but are not limited to chitin, chitosan, and lignin. A non-limiting example of a protein is animal derived gelatin. In other embodiments, the precursors may be partially polymerized prior to insertion into the kiln. In yet other embodiments, the precursors are not fully polymerized before pyrolysis is initiated.
  • The intermediate dwell time may vary. In one embodiment, no intermediate dwell time exists. In another embodiment, the dwell time ranges from about 0 to about 10 hrs. In yet another embodiment, the dwell time ranges from about 0 to about 5 hrs. In yet other embodiments, the dwell time ranges from about 0 to about 1 hour.
  • The intermediate dwell temperature may also vary. In some embodiments, the intermediate dwell temperature ranges from about 100 to about 600° C., from about 150 to about 500° C., or from about 350 to about 450° C. In other embodiments, the dwell temperature is greater than about 600° C. In yet other embodiments, the intermediate dwell temperature is below about 100° C.
  • The material will undergo pyrolysis to form carbon containing composite, as previously described. In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • Pyrolysis may also be carried out more slowly than described above. For example, in one embodiment the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 480 minutes. In other embodiments, the pyrolysis is carried out in about 120 to 240 minutes.
  • In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 650° C. to 1800° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 1200° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 850° C. to about 1050° C. In other embodiments pyrolysis dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to about 1200° C.
  • After pyrolysis the surface area of the carbon as measured by nitrogen sorption may vary between 0 and 500 m2/g, 0 and 250 m2/g, 5 and 100 m2/g, 5 and 50 m2/g. In other embodiments, the surface area of the carbon as measured by nitrogen sorption may vary between 250 and 500 m2/g, 300 and 400 m2/g, 300 and 350 m2/g, 350 and 400 m2/g.
  • 6. Reduction of Electrochemical Modifier to Elemental Form
  • In certain embodiments, the composite comprises carbon and an electrochemical modifier in elemental form. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier comprises elemental silicon. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier comprises elemental Tin. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier comprises elemental Germanium. In certain embodiments, it is preferable to incorporate the electrochemical modifier into the organic matrix in the form of an oxide or oxygen-containing compound followed by subsequent reduction of the oxide to elemental or essentially oxygen free electrochemical modifier. In the case of silicon, silicon oxides can be used to form a composite and then reduced to elemental silicon. In one embodiment the silicon comprises poly-crystalline silicon. In one embodiment, the silicon comprises crystalline silicon.
  • In one embodiment the reduction is carried out using carbothermal reduction. In one embodiment, the carbon is supplied to the reaction from the carbon in the composite material. In one embodiment the reaction is carried out in a reducing atmosphere as described above. The carbothermal reduction involves a heat treatment step under an inert atmosphere. In one embodiment the atmosphere comprises nitrogen or argon. In one embodiment, the reaction is carried out under a vacuum. In another embodiment, the atmosphere contains a reducing gas as described above. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1000° C. to 2200° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1500° C. to about 2000° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 1600° C. to about 1900° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature is about 1900° C. The heat treatment step is carried out with a dwell temperature for a specific period of time. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • In one embodiment the reduction is carried out in an alkaline environment. In one embodiment reduction is magnesiothermal reduction. In another embodiment the reduction is calciothermal reduction. In one embodiment the reduction is carried out using beryllium or strontium, or barium. In the case of magnesiothermal calciothermal, or other alkaline reductions, the amount of material to be reduced can be varied against the amount of alkaline reducing agent. For example the molar ration of SiO2 to alkaline reducing agent can be varied depending on the reaction conditions, completeness of reaction desired, and other reducing agents such as carbon or gases present. In one embodiment, the ratio of SiO2:Alkaline is 1:1. In one embodiment, the ratio of SiO2:Alkaline is 1:1.9. In one embodiment, the ratio of SiO2:Alkaline is 1:3. In the case of alkaline reducing agents, the composite material comprising electrochemical modifier to be reduced is milled and mixed with powdered alkaline reducing agent.
  • The alkaline reduction involves a heat treatment step under a controlled atmosphere. In one embodiment the atmosphere comprises nitrogen or argon. In one embodiment, the reaction is carried out under a vacuum. In another embodiment, the atmosphere contains a reducing gas as described above. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 500° C. to 2400° C. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 600° C. to 1500° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 600° C. to about 1000° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature ranges from about 700° C. to about 800° C. In other embodiments heat treatment dwell temperature is about 725° C. The heat treatment step is carried out with a dwell temperature for a specific period of time. In some embodiments, heat treatment dwell time (the period of time during which the sample is at the desired temperature) is from about 0 minutes to about 180 minutes, from about 10 minutes to about 120 minutes, from about 30 minutes to about 100 minutes, from about 40 minutes to about 80 minutes, from about 45 to 70 minutes or from about 50 to 70 minutes.
  • In another embodiment, the reduction is carried out by electrochemical reduction. In this case, the electrochemical modifier to be reduced to elemental form is arranged in a high temperature electrochemical cell as the anode in an electrochemical cell. In this high temperature electrochemical cell, the cathode is typically graphite but other highly stable electrically conductive compounds can be used. In one embodiment, the anode is a graphite rod. In one embodiment, the graphite rode is in electrical contact with a metal current collector and a power supply. This type of arrangements requires a high temperature electrolyte such a molten salt. In one embodiment, the electrolyte is calcium chloride. In one embodiment, the electrolyte is sodium chloride. In one embodiment, the electrolyte is a low temperature ionic liquid. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier to be reduced is placed in a metal crucible, which is in turn in electrical connection with a power supply. In one embodiment, the crucible comprises nickel. In another embodiment, the crucible is inconel. In another embodiment, the crucible comprises stainless steel. In another embodiment, the metal crucible containing the material to be reduced is filled with salt, and placed in the hot zone of a furnace in a controlled atmosphere and heated to a known temperature to melt the salt into an ionically conductive molten salt. In one embodiment, the atmosphere comprises nitrogen. In one embodiment, the dwell temperature of the furnace is 25 C or 50 C or 100 C or 200 C or 300 C or 400 C, or 500 C or 600 C or 700 C or 800 C or 850 C or 900 C or 950 C or 1000 C. In one embodiment, the temperature is above the melting point of the salt to be used. In one embodiment the furnace is held at the dwell temperature for a period of time required to fully melt the salt. In one embodiment, the dwell time is 30 minutes. In one embodiment, the dwell time is 60 minutes. After the dwell time has elapsed the power supply connected to the electrochemical cell is set to a potential necessary to reduce the electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment, the potential is 2.8V. In one embodiment, the current on the power supply is monitored. In one embodiment, power supply is turned off when the current stops decreasing. In one embodiment, the furnace is cooled, the crucible is removed and the salt is rinsed off of the reduced material with water.
  • 7. Modification of Solid Phases to Produce Composite
  • Numerous methods are available for the incorporation of an electrochemical modifier into carbon. The composite may be formed through a gas phase deposition of an electrochemical modifier onto the carbon. The composite may be synthesized through mechanical mixing or milling of two distinct solids.
  • In one embodiment, both the carbon and the electrochemical modifier are in solid form. The form factor for both the solid carbon and/or the solid electrochemical modifier may be presented in any shape, such as, but not limited to a monolith, a powder, a rod, a wire, a sheet, or a tube. The two populations of materials may be combined to create a unique composite, whose physical and electrochemical properties are defined in the previous section. In one embodiment the two distinct populations are combined to make a composite prior to the fabrication of electrodes for testing. In another embodiment the composite is two distinct populations included independently into an electrode, if the two materials exhibit the same physical and electrochemical characteristics of a composite if combined prior to electrode fabrication.
  • The carbon solid may include multiple populations of carbon allotropes, such as graphite, soft carbon and graphene. The additional carbon allotropes are considered an electrochemical modifier if they alloy with lithium during electrochemical lithiations. Ratio of populations of allotropes are described in the previous section.
  • Methods of combination of multiple populations of powders to create a unique composite, known to those in the art, include but are not limited to mechanical milling (described in more detail below) such as jet milling, bead milling and ball milling, in process manufacturing techniques such as flow diversion, or techniques wherein the optimal composite is formed during electrode fabrication.
  • The carbon solid prior to gas phase growth of an electrochemical modifier may be considered ultrapure. The carbon solid may have any properties of the proposed composite as described in the previous section. The gas phase techniques may include thin film techniques known to those in the art, such as atomic layer deposition (ALD), chemical vapor deposition (CVD) and physical layer deposition (PLD). Gas phase precursors for the electrochemical modifier include, but are not limited to silane and all silane derivatives such as polysilanes, silicon tetrachloride, tin chloride, tetrakis-(dimethylamido)titanium, and tetrikis-(ethylamido)titanium.
  • The time for gas phase deposition of the electrochemical modifier on the carbon solid may impact the thickness of the silicon layer and ultimately the performance of the composite. In one embodiment the time of deposition is between 5 mins and 5 hours. In another embodiment the time of deposition is between 15 minutes and 60 minutes. In yet another embodiment the time of deposition if between 60 minutes and 4 hours, 2 hour an 3 hours or 2.5 hours.
  • The temperature for gas phase deposition of the electrochemical modifier on the carbon solid may impact the thickness of the silicon layer and ultimately the performance of the composite. In one embodiment the temperature of deposition is between 200 C and 1200 C. In another embodiment the temperature of deposition is between 300 C and 600 C, 400 C and 550 C, and 450 C and 500 C. In yet another embodiment the temperature of deposition if between 600 C and 1200 C, 600 C and 1000 C, 650 C and 800 C, 700 C and 750 C.
  • In one embodiment the composite is formed through a gas phase interaction with a silicon solid. The silicon solid may be any allotrope of known silicon and may have specific properties prior to gas phase growth of carbon. The
  • 8. Mechanical Milling to Combine Electrochemical Modifier with Carbon
  • Electrochemical modifiers can be incorporated with a pure carbon material by milling the two materials together using high-energy milling. Milling can create micronized and in some cases nanometer sized particles which are intimately combined by co-milling or by combination after milling. In one embodiment, the carbon component comprises hard carbon. In one embodiment, the carbon component comprises graphite. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier comprises silicon. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier comprises tin. Alternate forms of milling techniques can be used to mill the materials. In one embodiment, the milling technique is jet milling. In one embodiment, the milling technique is Fritch-milling. In one embodiment, the milling technique is ball milling. In one embodiment, the milling technique is high-energy ball milling.
  • In certain milling techniques, the residence time of the material in the mill can be varied to alter the result. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 10 seconds. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 30 seconds. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 1 minute. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 5 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 10 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 15 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 20 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 30 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 45 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is about 60 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 90 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 120 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 180 minutes. In one embodiment, the residence time is 240 minutes.
  • The ratio of carbon to electrochemical modifier can be varied to create a material with different properties, such as capacity. The ratio can vary from 1:5 to 5:1. In one embodiment, the ratio is 1:5 or 1:4 or 1:3 or 1:2 or 1:1 or 2:1 or 3:1 or 4:1 or 5:1. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier can be used in a crystalline form. In one embodiment, electrochemical modifier can be used in an amorphous form.
  • The milling technique can be modified to create different particle size distributions. The D50 of the particle size distribution of the carbon can be varied independently or with the D50 of the particle size distribution of the electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 0.1 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 0.2 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 0.5 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 1 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 3 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 5 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 8 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 10 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 15 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 20 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 30 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 40 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 50 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 70 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 100 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 150 um. In one embodiment the D50 of the particle size distribution of either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is about 200 um.
  • Alternately, after milling, the composite can be coated with carbon using vapor phase deposition as described above.
  • C. Form Factor of Electrochemical Modifier Relative to Carbon
  • The techniques described above can be used to create different arrangements and layouts of both carbon and electrochemical modifier. The above techniques are capable of creating a wide variety of formats of carbon, electrochemical modifier and their arrangement relative to each other. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is porous. In one embodiment, the electrochemical modifier is inside the pores of the carbon, for example encapsulated in the carbon. In one embodiment the carbon is inside the pores of the electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is arranged in a core-shell format. In one embodiment, the core is carbon. In other embodiments, the core is the electrochemical modifier, such as silicon or another lithium alloying element. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 5 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 10 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 30 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 50 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 100 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 200 nm. In one embodiment, the shell thickness is about 300 nm. In one embodiment, the core is electrochemical modifier. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is arranged in a rod. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier comprises foam. In one embodiment either the carbon or the electrochemical modifier is arranged in a tube. In one embodiment, the tube is hollow or in some embodiments the tube is filled with either carbon or electrochemical modifier. In still other embodiments, the composite is a physical blend of particles of the carbon component and particles of the electrochemical modifier.
  • In some embodiments, the electrochemical modifier is a coating on the surface of the carbon material. The properties of the electrochemical modifier coated onto the carbon may influence various important electrochemical metrics such as power performance and cycle life. In one embodiment, the thickness of the electrochemical modifier coating on the surface of the carbon is ranges from 1 to 10000 nm. In another embodiment the thickness ranges from 1 to 100 nm, 1, 50 nm, 1 to 10 nm, 10 to 20 nm. In yet another embodiment the thickness ranges from 100 to 1000 nm, 100 to 500 nm, 200 to 400 nm, 500 to 750 nm. In still another embodiment the thickness ranges from 1000 to 10000 nm, 1000 to 5000, or greater than 10000 nm. Examples of methods and conditions of synthesis are described in more detail below.
  • D. Characterization of Polymer Gels and Carbon Materials
  • The structural properties of the final carbon material and intermediate polymer gels may be measured using Nitrogen sorption at 77K, a method known to those of skill in the art. The final performance and characteristics of the finished carbon material is important, but the intermediate products (both dried polymer gel and pyrolyzed, but not activated, polymer gel), can also be evaluated, particularly from a quality control standpoint, as known to those of skill in the art. The Micromeretics ASAP 2020 is used to perform detailed micropore and mesopore analysis, which reveals a pore size distribution from 0.35 nm to 50 nm in some embodiments. The system produces a nitrogen isotherm starting at a pressure of 10−7 atm, which enables high resolution pore size distributions in the sub 1 nm range. The software generated reports utilize a Density Functional Theory (DFT) method to calculate properties such as pore size distributions, surface area distributions, total surface area, total pore volume, and pore volume within certain pore size ranges.
  • The impurity and optional electrochemical modifier content of the carbon materials can be determined by any number of analytical techniques known to those of skill in the art. One particular analytical method useful within the context of the present disclosure is total x-ray reflection fluorescence (TXRF). Another analytical method useful within the context of the present disclosure is proton induced x-ray emission (PIXE). These techniques are capable of measuring the concentration of elements having atomic numbers ranging from 11 to 92 at low ppm levels. Accordingly, in one embodiment the concentration of electrochemical modifier, as well as all other elements, present in the carbon materials is determined by TXRF analysis. In other embodiments the concentration of electrochemical modifier, as well as all other elements, present in the carbon materials is determined by PIXE analysis.
  • E. Devices Comprising the Composite Materials
  • The disclosed composite materials can be used as electrode material in any number of electrical energy storage and distribution devices. For example, in one embodiment the present disclosure provides a lithium-based electrical energy storage device comprising an electrode prepared from the disclosed composite materials. Such lithium based devices are superior to previous devices in a number of respects including gravimetric and volumetric capacity and first cycle efficiency. Electrodes comprising the disclosed composite materials are also provided.
  • Accordingly, in one embodiment, the present disclosure provides an electrical energy storage device comprising:
  • a) at least one anode comprising a composite material disclosed herein;
  • b) at least one cathode comprising a metal oxide; and
  • c) an electrolyte comprising lithium ions;
  • wherein the electrical energy storage device has a first cycle efficiency of at least 70% and a reversible capacity of at least 500 mAh/g with respect to the mass of the hard carbon material. In other embodiments, the efficiency is measured at a current density of about 100 mA/g with respect to the mass of the active hard carbon material in the anode. In still other embodiments, the efficiency is measured at a current density of about 1000 mA/g with respect to the mass of the active hard carbon material in the anode.
  • In some embodiments the properties of the device are tested electrochemically between upper and lower voltages of 3V and −20 mV, respectively. In other embodiments the lower cut-off voltage is between 50 mV and −20 mV, between 0V and −15 mV, or between 10 mV and 0V. Alternatively, the device is tested at a current density of 40 mA/g with respect to the mass of carbon material.
  • The composite material may be any of the composite materials described herein. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 55%. In some other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 60%. In yet other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 65%. In still other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 70%. In other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 75%, and in other embodiments, the first cycle efficiency is greater than 80%, greater than 90%, greater than 95%, greater than 98%, or greater than 99%. In some embodiments of the foregoing, the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 300 m2/g. In other embodiments, the composite material comprises a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g. In still other embodiments of the foregoing, the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 50 m2/g and a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g.
  • In another embodiment of the foregoing electrical energy storage device, the electrical energy storage device has a volumetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity) of at least 400 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 450 mAh/cc. In some other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/cc. In yet other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 550 mAh/cc. In still other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/cc. In other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 650 mAh/cc, and in other embodiments, the volumetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/cc.
  • In another embodiment of the device, the device has a gravimetric capacity (i.e., reversible capacity, based on mass of composite) of at least 150 mAh/g. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 200 mAh/g. In some other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 300 mAh/g. In yet other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 400 mAh/g. In still other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 500 mAh/g. In other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 600 mAh/g, and in other embodiments, the gravimetric capacity is at least 700 mAh/g, at least 800 mAh/g, at least 900 mAh/g, at least 1000 mAh/g, at least 1100 mAh/g or even at least 1200 mAh/g. In some particular embodiments the device has a gravimetric capacity ranging from about 550 mAh/g to about 750 mAh/g.
  • The cycle stability of the material is in part determined by the relative amount that the composite material swells when it takes on lithium. The most stable materials have a very low percent expansion relative to the original dimensions of a particle or electrode. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 0.5%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 1%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 2%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 3%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 4%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 5%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 7%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 10%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 15%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 20%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 30%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 50%. In one embodiment, the percent expansion of the composite is about 100%.
  • The cycle stability of the composite material can be defined as the number of cycle a device is cycled until the capacity reaches 80% of the initial reversible capacity. In one embodiment the stability of the composite in a device is between 100 and 1000000 cycles. In another embodiment the cycle stability is between 100 and 5000 cycles, 200 and 1000 cycles, 300 and 1000 cycles. In yet another embodiment the cycle stability of the composite material is between 5000 and 1000000 cycles, 5000 and 100000, 5000 and 10000, or greater than 1000000 cycles.
  • The kinetics of charge and discharge of a composite material in a device can further be measured by power performance. In one embodiment the power density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 W/kg, 200 and 800 W/kg, 200 and 450 W/kg, 300 and 400 W/kg. In another embodiment the power density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 W/L, 100 and 500 W/L, 200 to 500 W/L, 300 to 450 W/L, greater than 1000 W/L.
  • The energy density of a device comprising the composite material can be defined both volumetrically and gravimetrically. In one embodiment the energy density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 Wh/kg, 200 and 800 Wh/kg, 200 and 450 Wh/kg, 300 and 400 Wh/kg. In another embodiment the energy density of a device made with the composite material is between 100 and 1000 Wh/L, 100 and 500 Wh/L, 200 to 500 Wh/L, 300 to 450 Wh/L, greater than 1000 Wh/L.
  • Some of the capacity may be due to surface loss/storage, structural intercalation or storage of lithium within the pores. Structural storage is defined as capacity inserted above 50 mV vs Li/Li while lithium pore storage is below 50 mV versus Li/Li+ but above the potential of lithium plating. In one embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:10 and 10:1. In another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:5 and 1:10. In yet another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:2 and 1:4. In still yet another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1:1.5 and 1:2. In still another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is 1:1. The ratio of capacity stored through intercalation may be greater than that of pore storage in a device. In another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 10:1 and 5:1. In yet another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 2:1 and 4:1. In still yet another embodiment, the storage capacity ratio of a device between structural intercalation and pore storage is between 1.5:1 and 2:1.
  • Due to structural differences, lithium plating may occur at different voltages. The voltage of lithium plating is defined as when the voltage increases despite lithium insertion at a slow rate of 20 mA/g. In one embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is 0V. In another embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is between 0V and −5 mV. In yet another embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is between −5 mV and −10 mV. In still yet another embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is between −10 mV and −15 mV. In still another embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g ranges from −15 mV to −20 mV. In yet another embodiment the voltage of lithium plating of a device collected in a half-cell versus lithium metal at a current density of 20 mA/g is below −20 mV.
  • In some embodiments of the foregoing, the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 300 m2/g. In other embodiments, the composite material comprises a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g. In still other embodiments of the foregoing, the composite material comprises a surface area of less than about 300 m2/g and a pore volume of less than about 0.1 cc/g.
  • In yet still another embodiment of the foregoing electrical energy storage device, the electrical energy storage device has a volumetric capacity at least 5% greater than the same device which comprises a graphite electrode instead of an electrode comprising the disclosed composite material. In still other embodiments, the electrical energy storage device has a gravimetric capacity that is at least 10% greater, at least 20% greater, at least 30% greater, at least 40% greater or at least 50% than the gravimetric capacity of the same electrical energy storage device having a graphite electrode.
  • Embodiments wherein the cathode comprises a material other than a metal oxide are also envisioned. For example, in another embodiment, the cathode comprises a sulfur-based material rather than a metal oxide. In still other embodiments, the cathode comprises a lithium containing metal-phosphate. In still other embodiments, the cathode comprises lithium metal. In still other embodiments, the cathode is a combination of two or more of any of the foregoing materials. In still other embodiments, the cathode is an air cathode.
  • For ease of discussion, the above description is directed primarily to lithium based devices; however the disclosed carbon materials find equal utility in sodium based devices and such devices (and related composite materials) are included within the scope of the invention.
  • The following examples are provided for purpose of illustration and not limitation.
  • EXAMPLES
  • The polymer gels, pyrolyzed cryogels, carbon materials and composite materials disclosed herein may be prepared according to the following exemplary procedures. Chemicals were obtained from commercial sources at reagent grade purity or better and were used as received from the supplier without further purification.
  • Unless indicated otherwise, the following conditions were generally employed for preparation of the carbon materials and precursors. Phenolic compound and aldehyde were reacted in the presence of a catalyst in a binary solvent system (e.g., water and acetic acid). The molar ratio of phenolic compound to aldehyde was typically 0.5 to 1. For monolith procedures, the reaction was allowed to incubate in a sealed container at temperatures of up to 85° C. for up to 24 h. The resulting polymer hydrogel contained water, but no organic solvent; and was not subjected to solvent exchange of water for an organic solvent, such as t-butanol. The polymer hydrogel monolith was then physically disrupted, for example by grinding, to form polymer hydrogel particles having an average diameter of less than about 5 mm.
  • The wet polymer hydrogel was typically pyrolyzed by heating in a nitrogen atmosphere at temperatures ranging from 800-1200° C. for a period of time as specified in the examples. Specific pyrolysis conditions were as described in the following examples.
  • Where appropriate, impregnation of the carbon materials with electrochemical modifiers was accomplished by including a source of the electrochemical modifier in the polymerization reaction or contacting the carbon material, or precursors of the same (e.g., polymer hydrogel, dried polymer hydrogel, pyrolyzed polymer gel, etc.), with a source of the electrochemical modifier as described more fully above and exemplified below.
  • Example 1 Monolith Preparation of Wet Polymer Gel
  • Polymer gels were prepared using the following general procedure. A polymer gel was prepared by polymerization of resorcinol and formaldehyde (0.5:1) in water and acetic acid (75:25) and ammonium acetate (RC=10, unless otherwise stated). The reaction mixture was placed at elevated temperature (incubation at 45° C. for about 6 h followed by incubation at 85° C. for about 24 h) to allow for gellation to create a polymer gel. Polymer gel particles were created from the polymer gel and passed through a 4750 micron mesh sieve. In certain embodiments the polymer is rinsed in a urea or polysaccharide solution. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed such treatment may either impart surface functionality or alter the bulk structure of the carbon and improve the electrochemical characteristics of the carbon materials.
  • Example 2 Alternative Monolith Preparation of Wet Polymer Gel
  • Alternatively to Example 1, polymer gels were also prepared using the following general procedure. A polymer gel was prepared by polymerization of urea and formaldehyde (1:1.6) in water (3.3:1 water:urea) and formic acid. The reaction mixture was stirred at room temperature until gellation to create a white polymer gel. Polymer gel particles were created through manually crushing.
  • The extent of crosslinking of the resin can be controlled through both the temperature and the time of curing. In addition, various amine containing compounds such as urea, melamine and ammonia can be used. One of ordinary skill in the art will understand that the ratio of aldehyde (e.g., formaldehyde) to solvent (e.g., water) and amine containing compound can be varied to obtain the desired extent of cross linking and nitrogen content.
  • Example 3 Post-Gel Chemical Modification
  • A nitrogen containing hard carbon was synthesized using a resorcinol-formaldehyde gel mixture in a manner analogous to that described in Example 1. About 20 mL of polymer solution was obtained (prior to placing solution at elevated temperature and generating the polymer gel). The solution was then stored at 45° C. for about 5 h, followed by 24 h at 85° C. to fully induce cross-linking. The monolith gel was broken mechanically and milled to particle sizes below 100 microns. The gel particles were then soaked for 16 hours in a 30% saturated solution of urea (0.7:1 gel:urea and 1.09:1 gel:water) while stirring. After the excess liquid was decanted, the resulting wet polymer gel was allowed to dry for 48 hours at 85° C. in air then pyrolyzed by heating from room temperature to 1100° C. under nitrogen gas at a ramp rate of 10° C. per min to obtain a hard carbon containing the nitrogen electrochemical modifier.
  • In various embodiments of the above method, the gel particles are soaked for about 5 minutes to about 100 hrs, from about 1 hour to about 75 hours, from about 5 hours to about 60 hours, from about 10 hours to 50 hours, from about 10 hours to 20 hours from about 25 hours to about 50 hours, or about 40 hours. In certain embodiments the soak time is about 16 hours.
  • The drying temperature may be varied, for example from about room temperature (e.g. about 20-25 C) to about 100 C, from about 25 C to about 100 C, from about 50 to about 90 C, from about 75 C to about 95 C, or about 85 C.
  • Ratio of the polymer gel to the soak composite (e.g., a compound such as urea, melamine, ammonia, sucrose etc. or any of the compounds listed in table 1) can also be varied to obtain the desired result. The ratio of gel to nitrogen containing compound ranges from about 0.01:1 to about 10:1, from about 0.1:1 to about 10:1, from about 0.1:1 to about 5:1, from about 1:1 to about 5:1, from about 0.2:1 to about 1:1 or from about 0.4:1 to about 0;9:1.
  • The ratio of gel to water can also range from about 0.01:1 to about 10:1, from about 0.5:1 to about 1.5:1, from about 0.7:1 to about 1.2:1 or from about 0.9:1 to about 1.1:1.
  • Various solvents such as water, alcohols, oils and/or ketones may be used for soaking the polymer gel as described above. Various embodiments of the invention include polymer gels which have been prepared as described above (e.g., contain nitrogen as a result of soaking in a nitrogen containing compound) as well as carbon materials prepared from the same (which also contain nitrogen). Methods according to the general procedure described above are also included within the scope of the invention.
  • The concentration of the soak composite in the solvent in which it is soaked may be varied from about 5% to close to 100% by weight. In other embodiments, the concentration ranges from about 10% to about 90%, from about 20% to about 85%, from about 25% to about 85%, from about 50% to about 80% or from about 60% to about 80%, for example about 70%.
  • While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believe that in certain embodiments the gel may undergo further cross linking while being soaked in the solution containing a compound from Table I.
  • Example 4 Preparation of Pyrolyzed Carbon Material from Wet Polymer Gel
  • Wet polymer gel prepared according to Examples 1-3 was pyrolyzed by passage through a rotary kiln at 1100° C. with a nitrogen gas flow of 200 L/h. The weight loss upon pyrolysis was about 85%.
  • The surface area of the pyrolyzed dried polymer gel was examined by nitrogen surface analysis using a surface area and porosity analyzer. The measured specific surface area using the standard BET approach was in the range of about 150 to 200 m2/g. The pyrolysis conditions, such as temperature and time, are altered to obtain hard carbon materials having any number of various properties.
  • In certain embodiments, the carbon after pyrolysis is rinsed in either a urea or polysaccharide solution and re-pyrolyzed at 600° C. in an inert nitrogen atmosphere. In other embodiments, the pyrolysis temperature is varied to yield varying chemical and physical properties of the carbon.
  • The wet gel may also be pyrolyzed in a non-inert atmosphere such as ammonia gas. A 5 gram sample first purged under a dynamic flow of 5% ammonia/95% N2 volume mixture. The sample is then heated to 900° C. under the ammonia/N2 flow. The temperature is held for 1 hour, wherein the gas is switched to pure nitrogen for cool down. The material is not exposed to an oxygen environment until below 150° C.
  • Example 5 Micronization of Hard Carbon Via Jet Milling
  • Carbon material prepared according to Example 2 was jet milled using a Jet Pulverizer Micron Master 2 inch diameter jet mill. The conditions comprised about 0.7 lbs of activated carbon per hour, nitrogen gas flow about 20 scf per min and about 100 psi pressure. The average particle size after jet milling was about 8 to 10 microns.
  • Example 6 Post-Carbon Surface Treatment
  • The 1st cycle lithiation efficiency of the resulting hard carbon from example 5 can be improved via a non-oxygen containing hydrocarbon (from Table 1) treatment of the surface. In a typical embodiment the micronized/milled carbon is heated to 800° C. in a tube furnace under flowing nitrogen gas. At peak temperature the gas is diverted through a flask containing liquid cyclohexane. The cyclohexane then pyrolyzes on the surface of the hard carbon. FIG. 9 shows the superior electrochemical performance of the surface treated hard carbon. The modified pore size distribution is shown in FIG. 10. Exemplary surface areas of untreated and hydrocarbon treated hard carbon materials are presented in Table 2.
  • TABLE 2
    Carbon Surface Area's Before and After
    Surface Treatment with Hydrocarbons
    BET surface area (m2/g) BET surface area (m2/g)
    Before surface treatment After surface treatment
    Carbon A 275 0.580
    Carbon B 138 0.023
  • Example 7 Properties of Various Hard Carbons
  • Carbon materials were prepared in a manner analogous to those described in the above Examples and their properties measured. The electrochemical performance and certain other properties of the carbon samples are provided in Table 3. The data in Table 3 show that the carbons with surface area ranging from about 200 to about 700 m2/g and pore volumes ranging from about 0.1 to about 0.7 cc/g) had the best 1st cycle efficiency and reversible capacity (Qrev).
  • TABLE 3
    Certain Properties of Exemplary Hard Carbon Materials
    Properties
    Specific
    Skeletal Surface Total Pore Tap
    Density Area Volume Density
    Sample (g/cc) (m2/g) (cc/g) (g/cc) pH
    Carbon
    1 3.6 0.003  0.528
    Carbon 2 2.02 11.4 0.000882 0.97
    Carbon 3 241.7 0.11
    Carbon 4 1.44 338 0.14 7.038
    Carbon 5 705 0.57 0.44 3.8
    Carbon 6 1.89 1618 1.343 0.18 8.98
    Carbon 7 2.28 1755 0.798 0.36 5.41
    Electrochemical Performances
    Q(initial) mAh/g Q(rev) mAh/g 1st cycle eff. (%)
    Carbon 1 171 111 64
    Carbon 2 679 394 58
    Carbon 3 807 628 78
    Carbon 4 325 208 64
    Carbon 5 1401 566 40
    Carbon 6 1564 242 15
    Carbon 7 1366 314 23
  • The pore size distribution of exemplary hard carbons is provided in FIG. 1, which shows that hard carbon materials having pore size distributions ranging from microporous to mesoporous to macroporous can be obtained. The data also shows that the pore structure may also determine the packing and volumetric capacities of the material when used in a device. FIG. 2 depicts storage of lithium per unit volume of the device as a function of cycle number. The data from FIG. 2 correlates well with the data from FIG. 1. The two microporous materials display the highest volumetric capacity, possibly due to a higher density material. The mesoporous material has the third highest volumetric capacity while the macroporous material has the lowest volumetric capacity. While not wishing to be bound by theory, it is believed that the macroporous materials create empty spaces within the device, void of carbon for energy storage.
  • The particle size and particle size distribution of the hard carbon materials may affect the carbon packing efficiency and may contribute to the volumetric capacity of electrodes comprising the carbon materials. The particle size distribution of two exemplary hard carbon materials is presented in FIG. 3. Thus both single Gaussian and bimodal particle size distributions can be obtained. Other particle size distributions can be obtained by altering the synthetic parameters and/or through post processing such as milling or grinding.
  • As noted above, the crystallite size (La) and range of disorder may have an impact on the performance, such as energy and power density, of a hard carbon anode. Disorder, as determined by RAMAN spectroscopy, is a measure of the size of the crystallites found within both amorphous and crystalline structures (M. A. Pimenta, G. Dresselhaus, M. S. Dresselhaus, L. G. Can ado, A. Jorio, and R. Saito, “Studying disorder in graphite-based systems by Raman spectroscopy,” Physical Chemistry Chemical Physics, vol. 9, no. 11, p. 1276, 2007). RAMAN spectra for exemplary hard carbon examples are depicted in FIG. 4, while crystallite sizes and electrochemical properties are listed in table 4. Data was collected with the wavelength of the light at 514 nm.
  • TABLE 4
    Crystallite size and electrochemical properties for DOE carbons
    Carbon
    2nd Lithium insertion
    Sample R La (nm) (mAh/g)
    Carbon A 0.6540 25.614 380
    Carbon B 0.908 18.45 261
    Carbon C 0.8972 18.67 268
    Carbon D 0.80546 20.798 353
  • The data in Table 4 shows a possible trend between the available lithium sites for insertion and the range of disorder/crystallite size. This crystallite size may also affect the rate capability for carbons since a smaller crystallite size may allow for lower resistive lithium ion diffusion through the amorphous structure. Due to the possible different effects that the value of disorder has on the electrochemical output, this present invention includes embodiments having high and low levels of disorder.
  • TABLE 5
    Example results of CHNO analysis of carbons
    Sample C H N O C:N Ratio
    Carbon A 80.23 <0.3 14.61 3.44 1:1.82 
    Carbon B 79.65 <0.3 6.80 7.85 1:0.085
    Carbon C 84.13 <0.3 4.87 6.07 1:0.058
    Carbon D 98.52 <0.3 0.43 <0.3  1:0.0044
    Carbon E 94.35 <0.3 1.76 <3.89 1:0.019
  • The data in Table 5 shows possible compositions of hard carbons as measured by CHNO analysis. The nitrogen content may be added either in the polymer gel synthesis (Carbon A and B), during soaking of the wet polymer gel (Carbon C), or after carbon synthesis. It is possible that the nitrogen content or the C:N ratio may create a different crystalline or surface structure, allowing for the reversible storage of lithium ions. Due to the possible different effects nitrogen content may play in lithium kinetics, the present invention includes embodiments having both low and high quantities of nitrogen.
  • The elemental composition of the hard carbon may also be measured through XPS. FIG. 20 shows a wide angle XPS for an outstanding, unique carbon. The carbon has 2.26% nitrogen content, 90.55% carbon with 6.90% oxygen content. FIG. 21 uses Auger to indicate an sp2/sp3 hybridization percent concentration of 65%.
  • Exemplary carbon materials were also analyzed by X-ray diffraction (XRD) to determine the level of crystallinity (see FIG. 5). While Raman measures the size of the crystallites, XRD records the level of periodicity in the bulk structure through the scattering of incident X-rays. This invention include embodiments which are non-graphitic (crystallinity <10%) and semi-graphitic (crystallinity between 10 and 50%). In FIG. 5, the broad, dull peaks are synonymous with amorphous carbon, while sharper peaks indicate a higher level of crystal structure. Materials with both sharp and broad peaks are labeled as semi-graphitic. In addition to XRD, the bulk structure of the carbon materials is also characterized by hardness or Young's Elastic modulus.
  • For structural analysis, the carbon material may also be analyzed using Small Angle X-ray Diffraction (SAXS) (see FIGS. 6 and 7). Between 10° and 40°, the scattering angle is an indication of the number of stacked graphene sheets present within the bulk structure. For a single graphene sheet (N=1), the SAXS response is a simple negative sloping curve. For a double graphene stack (N=2), the SAXS is a single peak at ˜22° with a baseline at 0°. Initial test of a carbon indicates a mixed-bulk structure of both single layer graphene sheets and double stacked graphene layers. The percentage of single-double layers can be calculated from an empirical value (R) that compares the intensities of the single (A) and double component (B). Since lithium is stored within the layers, the total reversible capacity can be optimized by tailoring the internal carbon structure. Example SAXS of exemplary carbons is depicted in FIG. 7. Notice that single, double, and even tri-layer features are present in some of the carbons.
  • Not being bound by theory SAXS may also be used to measure the internal pore size distribution of the carbon. FIG. 22 shows the SAXS curve and the pore size distribution for pore smaller than 16 nm. In this example, the nitrogen containing carbon has between 0.5 and 1% of pores below 1 nm in radius.
  • As discussed in more detail above, the surface chemistry (e.g., presence of organics on the carbon surface) is a parameter that is adjusted to optimize the carbon materials for use in the lithium-based energy storage devices. Infra-red spectroscopy (FTIR) can be used as a metric to determine both surface and bulk structures of the carbon materials when in the presence of organics. FIG. 8 a depicts FTIR spectra of certain exemplary carbons of the present disclosure. In one embodiment, the FTIR is featureless and indicates a carbon structure void of organics (e.g., carbons B and D). In another embodiment, the FTIR depicts large hills and valleys relating to a high level of organic content (e.g., carbons A and C).
  • As shown in FIG. 8 b, presence of organics may have a direct relationship on the electrochemical performance and response of the carbon material when incorporated into an electrode in a lithium bearing device for energy storage. Accordingly, in some embodiments the carbon material comprises organic functionality as determined by FTIR analysis. The samples with flat FTIR signals (no organics) display a low extraction peak in the voltage profile at 0.2 V. Well known to the art, the extract voltage is typical of lithium stripping. The lithium stripping plateau is absent in the two FTIR samples that display organic curves in FTIR.
  • The pH of the carbon can also be controlled through the pyrolysis temperature. FIG. 23 shows pH as the pyrolysis temperature increases. Not being bound by theory, as the temperature of pyrolysis is increased, the surface functionality and the pH of the carbon will rise, becoming more basic. Tailoring the pH can be accomplished post-pyrolysis through heat treatment or an additional pyrolysis step.
  • The material may also be characterized as the Li:C ratio, wherein there is no metallic lithium present. FIG. 24 shows an unexpected result wherein the maximum ratio of Li:C possible without the presence of metallic lithium is greater than 1.6 for a carbon between the pH values of 7 and 7.5.
  • FIG. 11 shows 1st cycle voltage profiles for three exemplary carbons containing between 1.5% and 6% nitrogen, prepared as described above. As the data shows, the total capacity and operating voltage can be tailored to the desired application. Carbon A has been tuned to have lowest gravimetric capacity upon extraction, though it is superior of all of the carbons in energy density due to the plateau close to zero. Carbon B has a smaller plateau but a larger gravimetric capacity than A. Carbon C is advantageous for vehicular applications due to its sloping voltage profile. This sloping profile allows for easy gauging of the state-of-charge (SOC) of the battery, which is difficult with flat plateaus.
  • FIG. 12 shows the gravimetric capacity of an exemplary embodiment compared to the theoretical maximum capacity of traditional commercial graphite versus lithium metal, thus demonstrating that the presently disclosed carbon materials represent an improvement over previously known materials. The solid points represent lithium insertion while the open points represent lithium extraction. The carbon is both ultra-pure with a low percentage of impurities as measured by PIXE and with 1.6% nitrogen content and where the maximum atomic Li:C ratio without the presence of metallic lithium is 1.65:6.
  • FIGS. 25 and 26 shows the capacity of an exemplary, ultrapure hard carbon as measured by a third party laboratory. The material shows excellent efficiency, capacity and rate capability. The material can be described as having 1.6% nitrogen content and where the maximum atomic Li:C ratio without the presence of metallic lithium is 1.65:6.
  • Example 8 Incorporation of Electrochemical Modifiers into Carbon Materials
  • Silicon was incorporated into the carbon structure by mixing silicon powder directly with the gel prior to polymerization. After pyrolysis, the silicon was found to be encased in carbon matrix. The silicon powder may be nano-sized (<1 micron) or micron-sized (between 1 and 100 microns). In an alternative embodiment, the silicon-carbon composite was prepared by mechanically mixing for 10 minutes in a mortar and pestel, 1:1 by weight micronized silicon (−325 mesh) powder and micronized microporous non-activated carbon. For electrochemical testing the silicon-carbon powder was mixed into a slurry with the composition 80:10:10 (silicon-carbon:conductivity enhancer (carbon black):binder (polyvinylidene fluoride)) in n-methyl pyrrolidone solvent then coated onto a copper current collector. Other embodiments may utilize nano (<100 nm) silicon powder. FIG. 13 depicts the voltage vs. specific capacity (mass relative to silicon) for this silicon-carbon composite. FIG. 14 shows a TEM of a silicon particle embedded into a hard carbon particle.
  • A resorcinol-formaldehyde-iron composite gel was prepared by combining resorcinol, 37 wt % formaldehyde solution, methanol, and iron acetate in the weight ratio 31:46:19:4 until all components were dissolved. The mixture was kept at 45° C. for 24 hours until polymerization was complete. The gel was crushed and pyrolyzed at 650° C. for 1 hr in flowing nitrogen gas. Iron or manganese containing carbon materials are prepared in an analogous manner by use of nickel acetate or manganese acetate, respectively, instead of iron. Different pyrolysis temperatures (e.g., 900° C., 1000° C., etc.) may also be used. Table 6 summarizes physical properties of metal doped carbon composites as determined by BET/porosimetry nitrogen physisorption. FIG. 15 shows the modification to the electrochemical voltage profile with the addition of Ni-doping. Notice that both the shape of the voltage profile and the capacity can be tailored depending on the dopant, the quantity, and the processing conditions.
  • TABLE 6
    Physical properties of Metal-Doped composite based on data
    obtained by BET/porosimetry nitrogen physisorption.
    BET surface area Pore Volume Average Pore Size
    (m2/g) (cm3/g) (angstroms)
    439 0.323 29
  • Example 9 Incorporation of Electrochemical Modifier During Polymerization of Polymer Gel
  • A resorcinol-formaldehyde gel mixture is prepared in a manner analogous to that described in Example 1. About 20 mL of polymer solution is obtained (prior to placing solution at elevated temperature and generating the polymer gel). To this solution, about 5 mL of a saturated solution containing a salt of an electrochemical modifier is added. The solution is then stored at 45° C. for about 5 h, followed by 24 h at 85° C. to fully induce the formation of a polymer gel containing the electrochemical modifier. This gel is disrupted to create particles, and the particles are frozen in liquid nitrogen.
  • The resulting wet polymer gel is then pyrolyzed by heating from room temperature to 850° C. under nitrogen gas at a ramp rate of 20° C. per min to obtain a hard carbon containing the electrochemical modifier.
  • Example 10 Incorporation of Alternate Phase Carbon During Polymerization of Polymer Gel
  • A resorcinol-formaldehyde gel was prepared as in Example 1 but during the solution phase (before addition of formaldehyde) graphite powder (99:1 w/w resorcinol/graphite) was added while stirring. The solution was continually stirred until gellation occurred at which point the resin was allowed to cure at 85° C. for 24 hours followed by pyrolysis (10° C./min ramp rate) at 1100° C. for 1 hour in flowing nitrogen. The electrochemical performance typical of this material is seen in FIGS. 16 and 17. This material is extremely unique as it shows both hard carbon and graphite phases during lithiation and delithiation.
  • Example 11 Optimal Voltage Window for Hard Carbon Performance
  • The material from Example 3 is tested in lithium ion battery half-cells as previously described. The anode electrode of an 88:2:10 composition (hard carbon:conductive additive:PVDF polymer binder) on 18 micron thick copper foil. The laminate thickness is 40 microns after calendaring.
  • Cells are tested at 40 mA/g relative to the mass of hard carbon active material using a symmetric charge and discharge galvanostatic profile, with a 2-hour low voltage hold. One voltage window is set between 2.0V and 5 mV versus Li/Li+. A second voltage window is set between 2.0V and −15 mV versus Li/Li+. For comparison, identical cells were assembled using a graphite electrode. FIG. 18 compares the performance of the two cells using different lower voltage cut-offs for graphite. It is well known that graphite performs poorly when cycled below zero volts due to lithium plating and irreversible capacity. Notice that the capacity of graphite with a 0 V cut-off window displays stable cycling. However, when the voltage window is widened to −15 mV, the reversible capacity is actually lower and unstable.
  • FIG. 19 compares the performance of the hard carbon two cells using different lower voltage cut-offs for graphite. Both the differential capacities and the voltage profiles show that the insertion mechanism for lithium is identical for both voltage windows. The cycling stability plot indicates that a negative voltage cut-off provides a 25% increase in capacity with no stability losses. This is drastically different than the graphite, where the capacity was lower and unstable. It is clear that hard carbons do not undergo the same detrimental lithium plating as in graphite. This may be due to the change in overpotential for lithium plating, associated with the insertion of lithium into the pores of the hard carbon anode material.
  • Example 12 Purity Analysis of Ultrapure Synthetic Carbon
  • The ultrapure synthetic activated carbon samples were examined for their impurity content via proton induced x-ray emission (PIXE). PIXE is an industry standard, high sensitive and accurate measurement for simultaneous elemental analysis by excitation of the atoms in a sample to produce characteristic X-rays which are detected and their intensities identified and quantitated. PIXE capable of detection of all elements with atomic numbers ranging from 11 to 92 (i.e., from sodium to uranium).
  • As seen in Table 7, the ultrapure synthetic activated carbons according to the instant disclosure have a lower PIXE impurity content and lower ask content as compared to other known carbon samples.
  • TABLE 7
    Purity Analysis of Ultrapure Synthetic Activated Carbon & Comparison Carbons
    Impurity (Imp.) Concentration (PPM)
    Imp. Sample 1 Sample 2 Sample 3 Sample 4 Sample 5 Sample 6 Sample 7
    Na  ND* ND ND ND ND 353.100 ND
    Mg ND ND ND ND ND 139.000 ND
    Al ND ND ND ND ND 63.850 38.941
    Si 53.840 92.346 25.892  17.939  23.602  34.670 513.517
    P ND ND ND ND ND ND 59.852
    S ND ND ND ND ND 90.110 113.504
    Cl ND ND ND ND ND 28.230 9.126
    K ND ND ND ND ND 44.210 76.953
    Ca 21.090 16.971 6.141 9.299 5.504 ND 119.804
    Cr ND ND ND ND ND 4.310 3.744
    Mn ND ND ND ND ND ND 7.552
    Fe  7.582  5.360 1.898 2.642 1.392 3.115 59.212
    Ni  4.011  3.389 0.565 ND ND 36.620 2.831
    Cu 16.270 15.951 ND ND ND 7.927 17.011
    Zn  1.397  0.680 1.180 1.130 0.942 ND 2.151
    Total 104.190  134.697  35.676  31.010  31.44  805.142 1024.198
    (% Ash)  (0.018)  (0.025) (<0.007)  (0.006) (0.006) (0.13) (0.16)
    *ND = not detected by PIXE analysis
  • Example 13 Incorporation of Silicon Using Polymer Precursors
  • Silicon-oxide is incorporated into the carbon through the Si-containing precursors added to the gel phase. A stock solution of RF is synthesized in using resorcinol, water and formaldehyde with 35% solids and a ratio of 1:2 R:F. In a separate beaker, a 35% solids tetraethylorthosilane (TEOS) stock solution is mixed using ethanol as a solvent in a ratio of 1:3 R:TEOS. The TEOS stock solution is slowly added to the RF stock solution and stirred 40° C. until a gel is formed. The sample is sealed and heated at 70° C. After curing, the resulting gel is pyrolyzed at 600° C. for 1 hr under nitrogen flow to yield the resulting SiOx/C composite. Additionally, the SiOx/C composite can be further activated to increase porosity and accessibility to the Si. To activate, the SiOx/C sample was heated to 950° C. at 20° C./min at which point the gas is switched to CO2 and held for 1.5 hours then cooled to room temperature under nitrogen.
  • Example 14 Incorporation of Silicon Powder to Polymer Gel
  • Silicon powder can be added prior to polymerization of the resin. The amounts of reagents can be tailored based on the desired ratio of carbon to silicon powder in the final product. An RF resin was synthesized using resorcinol, water, formaldehyde and acetic acid with 35% solids and a ratio of 1:2 R:F and 25:1 R:AA. Once the solids were fully dissolved, silicon powder was slowly added to achieve a 1:1 weight ratio carbon/silicon after pyrolysis. The silicon was further dispersed through high-energy sonication. Finally, the solution was heated to 85° C. until polymerization occurs. The resulting silicon-RF gel was then crushed and pyrolyzed under nitrogen flow at 600° C. to yield Si/C composite. Alternatively, the gel can be freeze dried so as to retain the pore structure to benefit the silicon expansion upon lithiation. The silicon powder can be in a variety of forms including, but not limited to, particles, wires, whiskers and rods. The size can range from 1 nanometer to 1 mm.
  • Example 15 Encapsulation of Silicon Powder in Polymer Gel by Emulsion/Suspension
  • Silicon can be incorporated into RF sol through emulsion to fully encapsulate the silicon powder. A 200:1 v/v solution of cyclohexane and SPAN80 surfactant is prepared. The silicon-RF sol was prepared from example 2 through high energy sonication. The solution was added to the surfactant solution and allowed to fully polymerize at 45° C. Once the gel fully polymerized, the gel particles were removed using filter paper and pyrolyzed as in example 2 to yield Si/C composite. Alternatively, the gel precursor can be prepared as a suspension in which the cyclohexane is substituted for mineral oil and no surfactant is added. The mineral oil is heated to 85° C. while stirring then the silicon-sol from example 2 is added and allowed to polymerize (˜4 hrs).
  • Example 16 Surface Passivation of Si—C Nanocomposite
  • Silicon-C nanocomposite was placed in an alumina crucible and heated in a tube furnace under nitrogen flow to 800° C. The nitrogen flow was diverted through a flask containing liquid cyclohexane. The organic cyclohexane vapor was carried for 1 hour into the hot zone of the furnace and carbonized on the surface of the silicon particles leaving behind a soft carbon coating. Alternatively the organic species used can be any non-oxygen bearing compound (e.g., ethylene, toluene, propane, benzene, etc.). In another embodiment, the peak temperature can be reduced or increased to allow a longer or shorter vapor phase lifetime for the organic species, respectively. In another embodiment, the dwell time at peak temperature can be reduced or increased to yield a thinner or thicker carbon coating, respectively.
  • Example 17 Si—C Nanocomposite Synthesis by High-Energy Mechanical Grinding
  • Silicon powder and carbon powder were ground together using a Fritchmill for 15 minutes to yield a Si/C composite. The average particle size of the silicon powder ranges from 10 nm-50 um while the carbon powder particle size ranges from 1 um-50 um. The weight ratios of silicon-carbon range from 1:4-5:1. The silicon can be in a crystalline or amorphous phase while the carbon is in an amorphous phase. Alternatively the resulting Si/C composite can be CVD coated as in example 4 so as to better bind contact between the silicon and carbon.
  • Example 18 Si—C Nanocomposite Synthesis by Carbothermal Reduction
  • The SiOx/C composite from Example 1 was heated under nitrogen to 1900° C. and held for 1 hour or until the desired ratio of Si:C is achieved, then cooled to room temperature. Additional carbon can be mechanically mixed prior to reduction. Alternatively, the reaction can be carried out under hydrogen gas or in vacuum so as to better facilitate the reduction process and minimize side reactions.
  • Example 19 Si—C Nanocomposite Synthesis by Calciothermal Reduction
  • The SiOx/C composite in Example 1 was added to Ca powder in a molar ratio of 1:1.9 SiOx:Ca and mixed until homogenous. The powder was poured into alumina crucible and place into tube furnace. The crucible was covered, but not sealed from gas, and heated to 720° C. at a ramp of 20° C./min under nitrogen flow and held for 1 hour. The resulting Si/C composite can be further washed with nitric acid to remove excess calcium compounds.
  • Example 20 Si—C Nanocomposite Synthesis by Magnesiothermal Reduction
  • The SiOx/C composite in Example 1 was added to Mg powder in a molar ratio of 1:1.9 SiOx:Mg and mixed until homogenous. The powder was poured into alumina crucible and place into tube furnace. The crucible was covered, but not sealed from gas, and heated to 720° C. at a ramp of 20° C./min under nitrogen flow and held for 1 hour. The resulting Si/C composite can be further washed with nitric acid to remove excess magnesium compounds.
  • Example 21 Si—C Nanocomposite Synthesis by Electrochemical Reduction
  • The granular SiOx/C material from Example 1 was placed in a non-reactive metal crucible (e.g., steel, nickel, Inconel). The container was filled with calcium chloride powder and the entire container was positioned in the center of a vertical tube furnace. An Inconel wire was connected to the metal crucible and extended outside the furnace (anode terminal). A graphite rod (cathode terminal) connected to a steel rod was positioned in contact with the calcium chloride powder in the hot zone of the furnace. The furnace was sealed and continuously purged with nitrogen gas then ramped up to 850° C. and held at which point the calcium chloride became molten. After ˜30 minutes at peak temperature a constant voltage of 2.8V was applied to the terminals using a DC power supply. The current was monitored over time and the reaction was complete when the current no longer decreased. After cooling, the resulting Si/C sample was removed from the furnace and rinsed in distilled water to remove calcium compounds. Alternatively, the analogous reaction can be carried out in a room temperature ionic liquid in place of the molten calcium chloride.
  • Example 22 Monolith Preparation of Polymer Gel with Hardening Agent
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was dissolved in acetone (50:50). Phthalic Anhydride (25:75) was added to the solution and shaken until dissolved. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the solution and shaken. The reaction solution was placed at elevated temperature (55° C. for about 12 hr followed by curing at 120° C. for 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Example 23 Monolith Preparation of Polymer Gel without Hardening Agent
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was dissolved in acetone (50:50). 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the solution and shaken. The reaction solution was placed at elevated temperature (55° C. for about 12 hr followed by curing at 120° C. for 6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Example 24 Solvent-Less Preparation of Polymer Gel with Hardening Agent
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was heated to elevated temperature (85° C. unless otherwise stated) and mixed continuously. Phthalic Anhydride (25:75) was added to the viscous liquid epoxy and mixed until dissolved. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the liquid solution and mixed until solid. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ≧6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Example 25 Solvent-Less Preparation of Polymer Gel without Hardening Agent
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with 340-570 repeating molecular units was heated to elevated temperature (85° C. unless otherwise stated) and mixed continuously. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the liquid solution and mixed until solid. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ≧6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Example 26 Preparation of Polymer Gel with Varying Phosphorus Content
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the monolith or solvent-less process described above in samples 1-4. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water (varying amount from 1% to 40% wt/wt) was then added to the liquid solution containing a Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] and mixed. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ≧6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Example 27 Preparation of Polymer Gel with Varying Hardening Agent Content
  • Polymer resins were prepared using the monolith or solvent-less process described above in samples 1-5. Phthalic Anhydride (varying amount from 0% to 40% wt/wt) was then added to the liquid epoxy solution containing a Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] and mixed. 85% (wt/wt) Phosphoric Acid in water was then added to the liquid solution and mixed. The solid resin product was placed at elevated temperature (120° C. for ≧6 hr) to allow for the resin to crosslink.
  • Example 28 Resin Characterization by Fourier Transform Infrared Spectroscopy
  • The raw materials and several iterations of the resin were analyzed with a Thermo Fischer Scientific Nicolet iS10 FTIR spectrometer with an ATR accessory. The FTIR spectra of the neat epoxy resin (˜570 MW), phosphoric acid (31.5% conc.), and the epoxy-P resin (20 wt % acid) are shown in FIGS. 30 and 31. Note that the phosphoric acid was diluted from 85 wt % with deionized water for the safety of the instrument. The FTIR spectra show that the cured resin is chemically different than the two reactants. One notable difference between the neat epoxy and the epoxy-P resin is the disappearance of the epoxide bending vibration at ˜910 cm−1. This observation provides significant evidence of the crosslinking of the epoxy molecules through reaction between the phosphoric acid and the epoxide functional group. FIG. 32 shows the effect of phosphoric acid loading on the epoxide content of the epoxy-P resin. With the addition of ≧10% H3PO4, the remaining concentration of epoxide groups was below the instrument detection limit.
  • Example 29 Resin Characterization by TGA
  • A sample of novalac epoxy and phosphoric acid was mixed in the melt state in a 3:1 molar ration (epoxy to phosphoric acid). The resin was cured at 120° C. for 12 hour. The TGA test was performed under N2 at 10° C./min ramp rate. The TGA data are depicted in FIG. 33. The exotherm at 250° C. could be explained by a reaction of the phosphoric acid and remaining unreacted epoxy groups that may control resin 3-D structure resulting in a desirable carbon structure and both improved gravimetric capacity and first cycle efficiency vs. the unmodified epoxy resin.
  • Example 30 Determination of Carbon Phosphorous Content by TXRF
  • Exemplary carbons produced according to the various examples above were tested for phosphorus content by TXRF spectroscopy. Carbon was synthesized from reins produced using both the solvent process (as in Examples 4, 22, 23, 26, 27) and solvent-less process (as in Examples 4, 24, 25, 26, 27) were analyzed. A Bruker S2 PICOFOX spectrometer was used for the study. Samples were prepared by milling to achieve a D(1.00) <100 μm particle size, then making a suspension consisting of the milled carbon, ethylene glycol, and Ga as an internal standard. Aliquots were placed on optically flat quartz disks and dried, leaving a thin residue for analysis. The results of the analysis, and the amount of phosphoric acid added during resin synthesis, are summarized in the table below Table 4.
  • TABLE 4
    Tunability of Phosphorous Content
    Sample P Content in HC (%)
    Carbon 12a 6.45
    Carbon 12b 5.21
    Carbon 12c 2.9
    Carbon 12d 9.34
    Carbon 12e 4.01
    Carbon 12f 11.67
    Carbon 12g 7.28
    Carbon 12h 4.73
    Carbon 12i 8.29
    Carbon 12j 5.37
    Carbon 12k 12.99
    Carbon 12l 7.16
  • Example 31 Preparation of Hard Carbon from Polymer Gel at Large Scale
  • A Polymer resin was prepared using the following general procedure. A Poly[(phenol glycidyl ether)-(co-formaldehyde)] with between 300 and 600 repeating molecular units and an 85% phosphoric acid aqueous solution were mixed and cured via an extrusions process.
  • The cured polymer resin was pyrolyzed in a rotary kiln according to the methods described generally herein.
  • The hard carbon was the examined for its electrochemical properties generally according to the methods described herein. Electrochemical data is described in Table 5.
  • TABLE 5
    1st Cycle 1st Cycle 1st Cycle
    Insertion Extraction Efficiency
    Sample (mAh/g) (mAh/g) (%)
    Carbon 16a 761 619 81.3
  • Example 32 Preparation of Composite Resin with Solvent
  • A polymer sol was prepared by dissolving polyphenylglycidylether-co-formaldehyde (PPGEF) polymer in acetone solvent (1:20 v/v) inside a sealed plastic container. Once the resin was dissolved, silicon powder (1:5 w/w resin to silicon) is added to the solution and dispersed via sonication followed by vortexing (shaking) The dispersed silicon/resin solution was transferred to an open container on a hot plate where it is continuously stirred (300 rpm) and heated (85° C.). At this point, phosphoric acid was added to the solution (equal to 20 wt % of the resin in solution). The solution continues to stir and heat until either solvent loss or polymerization leads to disruption of the stirring process. The silicon-gel is transferred to an oven set to 120° C. and cured for >8 hours.
  • Example 33 Alternative Preparation of Composite Resin without Solvent
  • Alternatively, a solventless preparation process can be used analogous to Example 32 without the use of acetone. In this process, PPGEF resin is stirred and heated on a hot plate wherein the silicon powder is added and allowed to disperse within the resin for >1 hour. At this point, phosphoric acid (20 wt % to resin) is added to react with the resin thus causing polymerization of the silicon dispersed gel. This is cured at a temperature of 120° C. for >8 hours.
  • Example 34 Alternative Solvent-Less Synthesis of Composite Resin
  • In another solventless embodiment, the resin can be in the form of a solid rather than a liquid in this case 1:1 w/w mixture of Bisphenol A (BPA) and hexamethylentramine (HMT). In this process, BPA/HMT in powder form is mechanically mixed with silicon powder (0.5:0.5:1.8 w/w/w) to form a homogeneous powder mixture. This is cured at 130° C. for 16 hours to produce the silicon-gel composite.
  • Example 35 Preparation of Composite Resin Using Encapsulation Techniques
  • In another embodiment, silicon incased in a polymer sol can be prepared. In this process melamine is allowed to dissolve in water through stirring and heating. Once dissolved, a formaldehyde solution is then added and stirred until the solution becomes clear. A suspension of silicon particles in water is then added to the melamine/formaldehyde solution. Next, a solution of TWEEN80 surfactant and water is then added and allowed to stir for 10 minutes. Finally, 1M HCl is added to catalyze the reaction. The mixture is then cured for 12 hours at 100° C. to produce silicon particles incased in melamine/formaldehyde polymer.
  • Other embodiments of silicon particles incased in polymer resin can be prepared using a Resorcinol/Formaldehyde polymer. Resorcinol is dissolved in water on a hot plate while stirring. Ammonium acetate and SnCl2 are added to the solution and held for 10 minutes. Glacial acetic acid is then added and the solution is mixed for 12 hours. In a separated vessel, cyclohexane and SPAN80 (5 wt %) are mixed and heated to 80° C. Formaldehyde is added to the resorcinol solution and held for 10 minutes. The Resorcinol/Formaldehyde solution is then added to the stirring and heated cyclohexane solution. The resin is then cured for 4 hours at 80° C. The resulting resin is filtered out and dried in an oven at 100° C. for 12 hours.
  • Example 36 Preparation of Pyrolyzed Composite Through Thermal Processing
  • Pyrolysis of silicon-gels is carried out such that resins produced in Examples 32-35 are heated (@10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it is held for 1 hour and then ramped down to room temperature.
  • In variations of the above procedure, the silicon particles employed (for example in Examples 32-35) are sized for the appropriate application. For example the particles can be nano-sized (i.e., nanoparticles) or micron sized, or combinations thereof. For example, in some variations of the above procedures, the silicon particles used range in size from about 10 nm to about 50 nm or from about 50 nm to about 200 nm. In more variations of the above, materials are prepared using silicon particles have a size ranging from about 10 nm to about 200 nm, from about 200 nm to about 500 nm or from about 500 nm to about 1000 nm. Micron sized particles are also used for preparation of the above materials and such particles generally have a size ranging from about 1000 nm to about 1500 nm or from about 1500 nm to about 2000 nm. Other exemplary procedures include use of silicon particles ranging in size from about 2000 nm to about 4000 nm or from about 4000 nm to about 6000 nm.
  • Example 37 In-Situ Surface Modification During Pyrolysis
  • Composite-resins produced in Example 32-35 are pyrolyzed in the presence of hydrocarbon vapor. The silicon-gel is heated (@ 10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it holds for 1 hour then ramps down to room temperature. During this process the nitrogen flow is first bubbled through a chamber containing liquid xylene. The xylene vapors are then carried into the tube furnace hot zone containing the silicon-gel sample where the xylene vapor then decomposes on the surface of the Si/C material where it chemically deposits (CVD) carbon on the surface. Alternative hydrocarbons can be used including ethylene, cyclohexane, toluene, and propane.
  • Example 38 Size Reduction of Composite Through Micronization Techniques
  • Micronization of silicon-carbon or silicone-gel is done such that material produced in examples 32-37 are milled in an automated mortar and pestle (Fritsch Mill) for 20 minutes using 15-20 deca-Newtons of downward force. The resulting material is then removed from the mill and run through a 38 micron sieve.
  • Other embodiments of micronization techniques can be done by running the materials produced in example 1-7 through a JetMill using 120 PSI of nitrogen or air to force the granular material into the mill. The resulting material is then milled down to micron size and can be measured using a Mastersizer 3000.
  • Example 39 Electrochemical Performance of Composites Comprising High Electrochemically Modifier Content
  • FIG. 27 shows the electrochemical stability and behavior of an exemplary high electrochemical modifier content composite, cycled between 1 and 50 mV. As the electrochemical modifier content increases, the capacity also increases. The highest capacity is seen for the 90% electrochemical modifier loading while the most stable performance is with the 50% electrochemical modifier loading.
  • Example 40 Electrochemical Performance of Composites Comprising Low Electrochemically Modifier Content
  • There may be instances wherein a higher capacity is not needed in favor of a slight performance enhancement. FIG. 28 depicts exemplary composites wherein the electrochemical modifier content is low (5-15%) when compared to the carbon. All of these composites display strong stability though a lower capacity when compared to the high electrochemical modifier content composites.
  • Example 41 Post-Pyrolysis Composite Surface Modifications
  • Post-carbonization surface treatments of the composite can be carried out on materials produced from examples 36-38. The material is heated (@10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it holds for 1 hour then ramps down to room temperature.
  • Other embodiments of example 10 can be carried out with additional gas during heating. For this process, a material is heated (@ 10° C./min) in a tube furnace under a flow (300 cc/min) of nitrogen gas to a temperature of 1050° C. where it is held for 1 hour then ramps down to room temperature. During this process the nitrogen flow is first bubbled through a chamber containing liquid xylene. The xylene vapors are then carried into the tube furnace hot zone containing the silicon-gel sample where the xylene vapor then decomposes on the surface of the Si/C material where it chemically deposits (CVD) carbon on the surface. Alternative hydrocarbons can be used including methane, ethane, ethylene, cyclohexane, toluene, propane or combinations thereof
  • Example 42 Si—C Nanocomposite Synthesis by Silicon Vapor Deposition
  • The composite can be synthesized via vapor phase chemical reactions. In a typical experiment 0.5 grams of activated carbon is placed in an alumina crucible and positioned in the center (hot zone) of a tube furnace. Upstream of the carbon is another crucible containing 6 grams of zinc metal powder. The furnace is sealed then purged continuously with nitrogen gas at ˜300 cc/min flow rate. The temperature is ramped at 20° C./min to a peak temperature of 850° C. At peak temperature the gas flow is diverted through a flask containing silicon tetrachloride liquid. The silicon tetrachloride vapors are carried into the furnace where it reacts in the vapor phase with zinc vapors (produced from the molten zinc metal). The zinc metal chemically reduces the silicon tetrachloride to elemental silicon, which deposits as solid nanoparticles on the surface and pores of the carbon within the hot zone of the furnace. The process is allowed to continue for 1 hour at room temperature before switching the gas flow to pure nitrogen and cooling to room temperature. The resulting Si/C composite is collected in the crucible at the end.
  • The composite can be using a different silicon precursor vapor and no zinc metal. In a typical experiment 0.5 grams of activated carbon is placed in an alumina crucible then positioned in the center (hot zone) of a tube furnace. The furnace is sealed then purged continuously with nitrogen gas at ˜300 cc/min flow rate. The temperature is ramped at 20° C./min to a peak temperature of 550° C. At peak temperature the gas flow is switched to a mixed gas of 5 mol % Silane (SiH4)/argon. This gas mixture enters the hot zone of the furnace and thermally decomposes on the surface and pores of the carbon into elemental silicon nanoparticles. The reaction is allowed to continue for 1 hr before the gas flow is diverted back to pure nitrogen and then cooled to room temperature. The resulting Si/C composite is collected in the crucible at the end.
  • Example 43 Multi-Allotrope Nanocomposite Synthesis by Through Particle Inclusion in Resin
  • In a typical synthesis, 4 grams of PPGEF resin is added to a 60 mL PP bottle along with 13 mL of acetone and then completely dissolved. One gram of silicon powder added and dispersed in the epoxy solution. One gram of graphite powder is added to the epoxy/silicon solution. The mixture is sonicated for 10 minutes followed by vortexing for 10 minutes. The mixture is poured into a beaker with a stir bar then placed on a hot plate and heated to 80° C. while stirring (300 rpm). 0.560 mL of 85% w/w phosphoric acid is added and completely dissolved in the acetone mixture. The mixture is continuously stirred and heated until gelation occurs as evidenced by a disruption in the stirring (solidification). The resulting resin is cured at 60° C. for >12 hours then increased to 120° C. for an additional 12 hours. The material can be subsequently pyrolyzed using optimal conditions to give superior performance.
  • Example 44 Incorporation of Iron Oxide in Composite Resin
  • In a typical experiment an epoxy-acetone solution is prepared by weighing out 10 grams of PPGEF epoxy resin into a plastic container then 10 mL of acetone is added and mixed to fully dissolve the resin. Next 0.2 grams of iron oxide nanopowder is added to the solution and dispersed via sonication for 1 hr then vortexing for 4 hours. At this point, the suspension is poured into a beaker on a hot plate where it is heated to 80° C. and stirred continuously at 300 rpm. Lastly 0.2 grams of phosphoric acid is added to the solution then allowed to react. When the gelation reaction causes disruption in the stirring the gel is transferred to a convection oven where it is allowed to cure for 12 hours at 120° C.
  • Example 45 Incorporation of Manganese in Composite Resin
  • An epoxy-acetone solution is prepared by weighing out 10 grams of PPGEF epoxy resin into a plastic container then 10 mL of acetone is added and mixed to fully dissolve the resin. Next 0.3 grams of manganese acetate is added to the solution and dissolved via sonication for 1 hr then vortexing for 4 hours. At this point, the solution is poured into a beaker on a hot plate where it is heated to 80° C. and stirred continuously at 300 rpm. Lastly 0.2 grams of phosphoric acid is added to the solution then allowed to react. When the gelation reaction causes disruption in the stirring the gel is transferred to a convection oven where it is allowed to cure for 12 hours at 120° C.
  • Example 45 Metal-Carbon Composite
  • Metal carbon composite prepared using an incipient wetness technique In a typical synthesis 1 grams of tin chloride is dissolved in 10 mL of acetone. This solution is gradually dripped onto the surface of milled activated carbon until the point of saturation at which point it is dried in a convection oven at 80° C. for 15 minutes. The process is continued until all of the tin chloride solution has been consumed. The final tin chloride/carbon material is heated to 800° C. for 1 hr in a tube furnace under flowing nitrogen to produce the Sn/C composite.
  • Example 47 Summary of Electrochemical Performance of Composites
  • TABLE 6
    Electrochemical Performance of Representative Composites
    1st 1st 1st 5th
    ΔQ Full Cyc. Cycle Cycle Cycle Spec.
    Vol. Cap. Cell vs. Ins. Q Eff. Ext. Q Q Surf. Area Pore Vol.
    No. Ex. No.1 % Si (mAh/cc)2 graphite (mAh/g)3 (%)4 (mAh/g)5 Ret.6 (m2/g)7 (cm3/g)8
    1 17, 1, 3, 4, 5,  5% 1645 18% 901 59% 531 87% N/A N/A
    6, 7, 40
    2 17, 1, 3, 4, 5, 10% 1692 18% 915 59% 537 83% N/A N/A
    6, 7, 40
    3 17, 1, 3, 4, 5, 20% 1327 15% 717 56% 401 80% N/A N/A
    6, 7
    4 17, 1, 3, 4, 5, 50% 6651 27% 3595 33% 1193  3% N/A N/A
    6, 7
    5 8, 23, 25, 26, 75% 2151 21% 1163 47% 552  8% N/A N/A
    33, 36, 38
    6 8, 23, 25, 26, 82%  376 −24%  203 47% 95 15% N/A N/A
    33, 36, 38
    7 1, 3, 4, 5, 16, 66% 1847 20% 999 73% 725 146%  13 0.10
    17, 41
    8 1, 3, 4, 5, 16, 75% 1838 19% 993 69% 690 184%  12 0.09
    17, 41
    9 1, 3, 4, 5, 16, 80% 1839 19% 994 74% 733 155%   8 0.06
    17, 41
    10 1, 3, 4, 5, 16, 83% 1856 19% 1003 72% 720 166%  12 0.09
    17, 41
    11 35, 36 50% 3164 24% 1710 69% 1174 83% N/A N/A
    12 23, 26, 32, 36, 30% 2044 20% 1105 80% 883 97% 25 0.05
    38, 43
    13 23, 26, 32, 36, 10% 1106 12% 598 76% 456 96% 24 0.03
    38, 40
    14 23, 26, 32, 36, 15% 1364 15% 737 72% 527 99% 40 0.05
    38, 40
    15 23, 26, 32, 36,  5% 1111 12% 600 72% 435 91% 29 0.04
    38, 40
    16 23, 26, 32, 36, 10% 1499 17% 810 69% 560 N/A 23 0.03
    38, 40
    17 23, 26, 32, 36, 15% 1729 19% 934 31% 293 22% 42 0.04
    38, 40
    18 23, 26, 32, 36,  5% 1245 14% 673 77% 521 64% 13 0.01
    38, 40
    19 23, 26, 32, 36, 50% 3788 25% 2047 75% 1538 41% 35 0.04
    38, 40
    20 23, 26, 33, 36, 70% 1928 20% 1042 77% 806 100%  26 0.04
    38, 40
    21 23, 26, 33, 36, 90% 4466 26% 2414 82% 1988 48% 22 0.04
    38, 40
    22 23, 36, 38, 44  5% 1065 11% 576 80% 458 98% N/A N/A
    23 23, 36, 38, 44 50% 1043 11% 564 31% 174 73% N/A N/A
    24 23, 36, 38  5% 1118 12% 604 76% 462 97% N/A N/A
    25 23, 36, 38, 45  5% 1145 12% 619 61% 376 97% N/A N/A
    26 23, 13, 36, 38  5% 1201 14% 649 65% 420 93% N/A N/A
    27 23, 36, 38 50% 1325 15% 716 54% 389 61% N/A N/A
    28 23, 36, 38 80% 1677 18% 906 51% 459 46% N/A N/A
    29 15, 35, 36 50% 1347 15% 728 32% 231 60% 740  0.30
    30 42 18% N/A NA N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A N/A
    31 41, 46 50% 2379 22% 1286 24% 306 56% 663  0.55
    1Refers to example number for preparation of sample.
    2 Volumetric capacity
    31st cycle insertion
    41st cycle efficiency
    51st cycle extraction
    65th cycle retention
    7Specific surface area
    8Pore volume
  • The various embodiments described above can be combined to provide further embodiments. All of the U.S. patents, U.S. patent application publications, U.S. patent applications, foreign patents, foreign patent applications and non-patent publications referred to in this specification and/or listed in the Application Data Sheet, are incorporated herein by reference, in their entirety. Aspects of the embodiments can be modified, if necessary to employ concepts of the various patents, applications and publications to provide yet further embodiments. These and other changes can be made to the embodiments in light of the above-detailed description. In general, in the following claims, the terms used should not be construed to limit the claims to the specific embodiments disclosed in the specification and the claims, but should be construed to include all possible embodiments along with the full scope of equivalents to which such claims are entitled. Accordingly, the claims are not limited by the disclosure.

Claims (26)

1. A composite material having a first cycle insertion of at least 700 mAh/g and a first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation of greater than 70% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, wherein the composite material comprises a carbon material and a lithium alloying electrochemical modifier.
2. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the first cycle insertion is at least 1000 mAh/g and the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 80%.
3. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the first cycle insertion is at least 2400 mAh/g and the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 80%.
4. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation is greater than 90%.
5. The composite material of claim 1, further comprising a first cycle extraction of at least 600 mAh/g and a fifth cycle retention of greater than 99%.
6. The composite material of claim 5, wherein the first cycle extraction is at least 1200 mAh/g.
7. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier is silicon, tin, germanium, nickel, aluminum, manganese, Al2O3, titanium, titanium oxide, sulfur, molybdenum, arsenic, gallium, phosphorous, selenium, antimony, bismuth, tellurium or indium or combinations thereof.
8. The composite material of claim 7, wherein the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier is silicon.
9. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the composite material comprises particles having a core-shell structure, wherein the shell comprises substantially the carbon material and the core comprises substantially the electrochemical modifier.
10. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the composite material comprises particles having a core-shell structure wherein the core comprises substantially the carbon material and the shell comprises substantially the electrochemical modifier.
11. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the composite material comprises particles of the carbon material, the carbon material particles encapsulating a plurality of particles of the lithium alloying electrochemical modifier.
12. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the electrochemical modifier comprises nanoparticles.
13. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the electrochemical modifier comprises particles having a particle size ranging from 10 nm to 500 nm.
14. The composite material of claim 1, wherein a ratio of carbon material to electrochemical modifier ranges from 40:1 to 1:99 on a mass basis.
15. The composite material of claim 1, wherein a ratio of carbon material to electrochemical modifier ranges from 19:1 to 1:9 on a mass basis.
16. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the composite material further comprises an efficiency enhancing electrochemical modifier.
17. The composite material of claim 16, wherein the efficiency enhancing electrochemical modifier comprises phosphorus and is present in the composite material at 3-13% by weight as measured by TXRF.
18. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the composite material comprises a total of less than 200 ppm of all elements having atomic numbers ranging from 11 to 92, excluding any intentionally added electrochemical modifier, as measured by TXRF.
19. The composite material of claim 1, wherein the carbon material is a hard carbon material.
20. A composite material having a first cycle extraction of at least 1900 mAh/g and a first cycle efficiency in the absence of ex situ prelithiation of greater than 80% when the composite material is incorporated into an electrode of a lithium based energy storage device, wherein the composite material comprises silicon and carbon material in a ratio ranging from about 8.5:1 to about 9.5:1 by weight and further comprises 3-13% by weight phosphorus.
21. A method for preparing a composite material, the composite material comprising a carbon material and a lithium alloying electrochemical modifier, the method comprising:
A) copolymerizing one or more polymer precursors in the presence of the electrochemical modifier or a compound comprising the electrochemical modifier to obtain a polymer gel; and
B) pyrolyzing the polymer gel to obtain the composite material.
22-27. (canceled)
28. An electrode comprising the composite material of claim 1.
29. A device comprising the electrode of claim 28.
30. An electrical energy storage device comprising:
a) at least one anode comprising a composite material according to claim 1;
b) at least one cathode comprising a metal oxide; and
c) an electrolyte comprising lithium ions.
31-32. (canceled)
US14/084,469 2013-03-14 2013-11-19 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers Abandoned US20140272592A1 (en)

Priority Applications (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US14/084,469 US20140272592A1 (en) 2013-03-14 2013-11-19 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US15/675,462 US10454103B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2017-08-11 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US16/406,971 US10714744B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-05-08 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US16/894,582 US11495793B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2020-06-05 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US17/960,707 US20230115078A1 (en) 2013-03-14 2022-10-05 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers

Applications Claiming Priority (3)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US201361786165P 2013-03-14 2013-03-14
US201361834258P 2013-06-12 2013-06-12
US14/084,469 US20140272592A1 (en) 2013-03-14 2013-11-19 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers

Related Child Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/675,462 Continuation US10454103B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2017-08-11 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20140272592A1 true US20140272592A1 (en) 2014-09-18

Family

ID=49674420

Family Applications (5)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US14/084,469 Abandoned US20140272592A1 (en) 2013-03-14 2013-11-19 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US15/675,462 Active US10454103B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2017-08-11 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US16/406,971 Active US10714744B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-05-08 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US16/894,582 Active 2034-07-22 US11495793B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2020-06-05 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US17/960,707 Pending US20230115078A1 (en) 2013-03-14 2022-10-05 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers

Family Applications After (4)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US15/675,462 Active US10454103B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2017-08-11 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US16/406,971 Active US10714744B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-05-08 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US16/894,582 Active 2034-07-22 US11495793B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2020-06-05 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US17/960,707 Pending US20230115078A1 (en) 2013-03-14 2022-10-05 Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers

Country Status (3)

Country Link
US (5) US20140272592A1 (en)
CN (2) CN105190948B (en)
WO (1) WO2014143213A1 (en)

Cited By (70)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20130211005A1 (en) * 2012-02-09 2013-08-15 Georgia-Pacific Chemicals, Llc Methods for making polymer particulates in gel form
US20130209348A1 (en) * 2012-02-09 2013-08-15 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
CN105355867A (en) * 2015-10-21 2016-02-24 山东玉皇新能源科技有限公司 Hard carbon negative electrode material for high-performance lithium ion power battery, and preparation method and application of hard carbon negative electrode material
US9325012B1 (en) * 2014-09-17 2016-04-26 Baker Hughes Incorporated Carbon composites
US20160118647A1 (en) * 2013-10-27 2016-04-28 Bindia Bhagat Carbonous composite material made with and from pine tree needles and its use in an energy cell
US20170015559A1 (en) * 2014-03-14 2017-01-19 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Novel methods for sol-gel polymerization in absence of solvent and creation of tunable carbon structure from same
WO2017031006A1 (en) * 2015-08-14 2017-02-23 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Composites of porous nano-featured silicon materials and carbon materials
US9580321B2 (en) 2009-07-01 2017-02-28 Basf Se Ultrapure synthetic carbon materials
US20170110715A1 (en) * 2014-06-10 2017-04-20 Hitachi Chemical Company, Ltd. Lithium ion secondary battery
US9680159B2 (en) 2010-03-12 2017-06-13 Basf Se Mesoporous carbon materials comprising bifunctional catalysts
US9714709B2 (en) 2014-11-25 2017-07-25 Baker Hughes Incorporated Functionally graded articles and methods of manufacture
US9726300B2 (en) 2014-11-25 2017-08-08 Baker Hughes Incorporated Self-lubricating flexible carbon composite seal
US9745451B2 (en) 2014-11-17 2017-08-29 Baker Hughes Incorporated Swellable compositions, articles formed therefrom, and methods of manufacture thereof
US9840887B2 (en) 2015-05-13 2017-12-12 Baker Hughes Incorporated Wear-resistant and self-lubricant bore receptacle packoff tool
US20180026262A1 (en) * 2016-07-19 2018-01-25 Samsung Sdi Co., Ltd. Negative active material, lithium battery including the same, and method of preparing the negative active material
US9962903B2 (en) 2014-11-13 2018-05-08 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Reinforced composites, methods of manufacture, and articles therefrom
US9963395B2 (en) 2013-12-11 2018-05-08 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Methods of making carbon composites
US9985289B2 (en) 2010-09-30 2018-05-29 Basf Se Enhanced packing of energy storage particles
DE102016225312A1 (en) * 2016-12-16 2018-06-21 Bayerische Motoren Werke Aktiengesellschaft Anode active material with glassy carbon coating
CN108352511A (en) * 2015-11-13 2018-07-31 西诺德科技股份有限公司 Electroactive material is encapsulated for the graphene in lithium ion electrochemical cells
KR20180113187A (en) * 2015-08-28 2018-10-15 에너지2 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Novel materials exhibiting extremely durable lithium intercalation and methods for their preparation
US20180316002A1 (en) * 2017-04-27 2018-11-01 Tec One Co., Ltd. Carbon-silicon composite material, negative electrode, and secondary battery
US10125274B2 (en) 2016-05-03 2018-11-13 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Coatings containing carbon composite fillers and methods of manufacture
US20180369791A1 (en) * 2017-06-26 2018-12-27 Ut-Battelle, Llc Production of biofuels with novel salts impregnated tire-derived carbon catalysts
US10195583B2 (en) 2013-11-05 2019-02-05 Group 14 Technologies, Inc. Carbon-based compositions with highly efficient volumetric gas sorption
US10300627B2 (en) 2014-11-25 2019-05-28 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Method of forming a flexible carbon composite self-lubricating seal
US10315922B2 (en) 2014-09-29 2019-06-11 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Carbon composites and methods of manufacture
US10344559B2 (en) 2016-05-26 2019-07-09 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc High temperature high pressure seal for downhole chemical injection applications
US10424786B1 (en) 2018-12-19 2019-09-24 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US10454103B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-10-22 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US10456747B2 (en) * 2015-11-13 2019-10-29 Exxonmobil Research And Engineering Company Hydrocarbon reverse osmosis membranes and separations
US10480288B2 (en) 2014-10-15 2019-11-19 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Articles containing carbon composites and methods of manufacture
US10490358B2 (en) 2011-04-15 2019-11-26 Basf Se Flow ultracapacitor
US10508335B1 (en) 2019-02-13 2019-12-17 Nexeon Limited Process for preparing electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US20200095129A1 (en) * 2018-09-24 2020-03-26 Plasma App Ltd. Carbon materials
US20200152973A1 (en) * 2018-11-08 2020-05-14 Nexeon Limited Electroactive Materials For Metal-Ion Batteries
WO2020095066A1 (en) * 2018-11-08 2020-05-14 Nexeon Limited Electroactive Materials for Metal-Ion Batteries
WO2020128523A1 (en) 2018-12-21 2020-06-25 Nexeon Limited Process for preparing electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
EP3780197A1 (en) * 2019-08-14 2021-02-17 Commissariat à l'Energie Atomique et aux Energies Alternatives Method for preparing a porous carbonaceous and nitrogenous material with metallic dopant, in particular useful as a catalyst for oxygen reduction reaction (orr)
CN112510182A (en) * 2020-12-08 2021-03-16 英德奥克莱电源有限公司 Lead paste for lead-acid storage battery and lead-acid storage battery
US10964940B1 (en) 2020-09-17 2021-03-30 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US20210135208A1 (en) * 2015-12-28 2021-05-06 Johnson Matthey Public Limited Company Silicon Based Materials For And Method Of Making And Using Same
CN113113601A (en) * 2021-04-06 2021-07-13 常德速碳新能源科技有限公司 Hard carbon negative electrode material for lithium ion secondary battery and preparation method thereof
US11101458B2 (en) 2012-08-24 2021-08-24 Sila Nanotechnologies, Inc. Scaffolding matrix with internal nanoparticles
US11097511B2 (en) 2014-11-18 2021-08-24 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Methods of forming polymer coatings on metallic substrates
US11127945B2 (en) 2016-06-14 2021-09-21 Nexeon Limited Electrodes for metal-ion batteries
US11174167B1 (en) 2020-08-18 2021-11-16 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon carbon composites comprising ultra low Z
WO2022040328A1 (en) * 2020-08-18 2022-02-24 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon-carbon composites
WO2022040327A1 (en) * 2020-08-18 2022-02-24 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Manufacturing of silicon-carbon composites materials
US11289700B2 (en) 2016-06-28 2022-03-29 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York KVOPO4 cathode for sodium ion batteries
WO2022046645A3 (en) * 2020-08-25 2022-04-28 Aspen Aerogels Inc. Polyimide bead materials and methods of manufacture thereof
US11335904B2 (en) 2016-02-17 2022-05-17 Wacker Chemie Ag Composite core-shell particles
US11335903B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2022-05-17 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Highly efficient manufacturing of silicon-carbon composites materials comprising ultra low z
US11367868B2 (en) * 2018-11-12 2022-06-21 Sumitomo Rubber Industries, Ltd. Sulfur-based positive-electrode active material, positive-electrode and lithium-ion secondary battery
US11374213B2 (en) 2019-03-22 2022-06-28 Aspen Aerogels, Inc. Carbon aerogel-based cathodes for lithium-sulfur batteries
JP2022533387A (en) * 2019-05-20 2022-07-22 ネクシオン リミテッド Electroactive materials for metal ion batteries
US11401363B2 (en) * 2012-02-09 2022-08-02 Basf Se Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
US11447399B2 (en) * 2016-05-27 2022-09-20 Umicore Method for producing nickel lithium metal complex oxide powder of small particle size
US20220304326A1 (en) * 2021-03-25 2022-09-29 Eric Wright Shaved coffee beans and coffee shaving methods
CN115332532A (en) * 2022-10-12 2022-11-11 宁德新能源科技有限公司 Hard carbon material and preparation method thereof
CN115321514A (en) * 2022-08-29 2022-11-11 惠州亿纬锂能股份有限公司 Hard carbon material and preparation method and application thereof
US11588152B2 (en) * 2016-08-23 2023-02-21 Nexeon Ltd. Cathode active material for secondary battery and manufacturing method thereof
CN115732756A (en) * 2021-08-30 2023-03-03 张家港市国泰华荣化工新材料有限公司 Electrolyte and secondary battery using same
US11605854B2 (en) 2019-03-22 2023-03-14 Aspen Aerogels, Inc. Carbon aerogel-based cathodes for lithium-air batteries
US11611071B2 (en) 2017-03-09 2023-03-21 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Decomposition of silicon-containing precursors on porous scaffold materials
US11639292B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2023-05-02 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Particulate composite materials
US11648521B2 (en) 2019-02-27 2023-05-16 Aspen Aerogels, Inc. Carbon aerogel-based electrode materials and methods of manufacture thereof
WO2023088540A1 (en) 2021-11-16 2023-05-25 Wacker Chemie Ag Silicon subhalide-containing composite particles
US20230223537A1 (en) * 2020-05-28 2023-07-13 Showa Denko K.K. Composite particles, negative electrode active material, and lithium-ion secondary battery
US11710819B2 (en) 2017-06-16 2023-07-25 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries

Families Citing this family (27)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
KR101496934B1 (en) 2006-11-15 2015-03-03 유니버시티 오브 워싱톤 스루 이츠 센터 포 커머셜리제이션 electric double layer capacitance device
CN107785180A (en) 2011-06-03 2018-03-09 巴斯福股份公司 For the carbon lead blend in mixed tensor storage device
US11081690B2 (en) * 2016-09-12 2021-08-03 Imerys Graphite & Carbon Switzerland Ltd. Compositions and uses thereof
EP3626333A4 (en) * 2017-05-18 2021-03-10 Daicel Corporation Ionic liquid-containing laminate and method for producing same
KR102256534B1 (en) * 2017-11-08 2021-05-25 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 Negative active material for rechargeable lithium battery and rechargeable lithium battery including same
CN108446530A (en) * 2018-03-08 2018-08-24 中国地质科学院地质力学研究所 A kind of geochemical elements anisotropy space Quantitative Analysis Method
EP3814430A1 (en) * 2018-06-27 2021-05-05 Imertech Surface-functionalized carbonaceous particles, methods of making, and applications of the same
WO2020056368A1 (en) * 2018-09-14 2020-03-19 Sila Nanotechnologies, Inc. Battery electrode composition comprising biomass-derived carbon
US11539053B2 (en) 2018-11-12 2022-12-27 Utility Global, Inc. Method of making copper electrode
US11603324B2 (en) 2018-11-06 2023-03-14 Utility Global, Inc. Channeled electrodes and method of making
US11761100B2 (en) 2018-11-06 2023-09-19 Utility Global, Inc. Electrochemical device and method of making
EP3877180A4 (en) 2018-11-06 2022-12-14 Utility Global, Inc. Method and system for making a fuel cell
US11611097B2 (en) 2018-11-06 2023-03-21 Utility Global, Inc. Method of making an electrochemical reactor via sintering inorganic dry particles
WO2020102634A1 (en) * 2018-11-17 2020-05-22 Utility Global, Inc. Method of making electrochemical reactors
EP3881377A4 (en) * 2018-11-17 2022-09-28 Utility Global, Inc. Method of making electrochemical reactors
CN109638266B (en) * 2018-12-26 2021-04-13 山东大学 Carbon-coated selenium indium lithium material and preparation method and application thereof
US20220085363A1 (en) * 2019-01-07 2022-03-17 The Board of Regents for the Oklahoma Agricultural and Mechanical Colleges Preparation of silicon-based anode for use in a li-ion battery
CN112563491B (en) 2019-03-21 2023-10-24 宁德新能源科技有限公司 Negative electrode material, negative electrode comprising same, and electrochemical device
US11489948B2 (en) * 2019-12-30 2022-11-01 Cloudflare, Inc. Method and system for reliable application layer data transmission through unreliable transport layer connections in a network
WO2021195450A1 (en) * 2020-03-26 2021-09-30 Zeta Energy Llc Sulfurized-carbon cathode with conductive carbon framework
US10916802B1 (en) 2020-04-29 2021-02-09 Nanostar Inc. Ionic conductivity in silicon electrolyte composite particles
US11411211B2 (en) 2020-05-07 2022-08-09 Advano, Inc. Solid electrolyte-secondary particle composites
WO2022035879A1 (en) 2020-08-10 2022-02-17 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Vibro-thermally assisted chemical vapor infiltration
CA3195673A1 (en) * 2020-09-25 2022-03-31 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon-carbon composite materials with enhanced electrochemical properties
US20220376247A1 (en) * 2021-05-21 2022-11-24 Zeta Energy Llc Anode-Free Electrochemical Cell
EP4343889A1 (en) 2021-11-27 2024-03-27 Lanxi Zhide Advanced Materials Co., Ltd. Nano-silicon-oxygen-carbon structure composite material and preparation method therefor, negative electrode and electrochemical device
WO2023145603A1 (en) * 2022-01-28 2023-08-03 パナソニックエナジ-株式会社 Negative electrode for nonaqueous electrolyte secondary battery, and nonaqueous electrolyte secondary battery

Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5093216A (en) * 1989-07-29 1992-03-03 Sony Corporation Carbonaceous material and a non aqueous electrolyte cell using the same
US5294498A (en) * 1991-03-02 1994-03-15 Sony Corporation Anode material, method for producing it and non-aqueous electrolyte cell employing such anode materials
US5834138A (en) * 1995-03-06 1998-11-10 Sony Corporation Negative electrode material for non-aqueous liquid electrolyte secondary cell and non-aqueous liquid electrolyte secondary cell employing same
US20110159375A1 (en) * 2009-12-11 2011-06-30 Energ2, Inc. Carbon materials comprising an electrochemical modifier
US20140335410A1 (en) * 2009-05-11 2014-11-13 Nexeon Limited Electrode composition for a secondary battery cell

Family Cites Families (339)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
GB1226544A (en) 1967-05-11 1971-03-31
US3619428A (en) 1968-04-05 1971-11-09 Constant V David Porous particle fabrication process
US3518123A (en) 1968-06-10 1970-06-30 Leesona Corp Metal/air battery
US3876505A (en) 1972-12-08 1975-04-08 Calgon Corp Manufacture of activated carbon from sized coal
JPS5339107B2 (en) 1973-03-17 1978-10-19
US3892580A (en) 1973-03-26 1975-07-01 Corning Glass Works Method of making porous inorganic bodies
US3977901A (en) 1974-10-23 1976-08-31 Westinghouse Electric Corporation Metal/air cells and improved air electrodes for use therein
US4082694A (en) 1975-12-24 1978-04-04 Standard Oil Company (Indiana) Active carbon process and composition
AU2574477A (en) 1976-06-04 1978-12-07 Ici Ltd Siliceous materials
JPS5441913A (en) 1977-09-09 1979-04-03 Kanebo Ltd Carbonncarbon composite material and method of making same
US4628834A (en) 1981-10-14 1986-12-16 Mckelvie Alastair H Vibratory fluidized bed reactor
US4543341A (en) 1983-12-23 1985-09-24 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Synthesis and processing of monosized oxide powders
US4580404A (en) 1984-02-03 1986-04-08 Air Products And Chemicals, Inc. Method for adsorbing and storing hydrogen at cryogenic temperatures
JPH07105316B2 (en) 1985-08-13 1995-11-13 旭硝子株式会社 Polarizable electrode for electric double layer capacitor and method for manufacturing the same
US4769197A (en) 1987-02-02 1988-09-06 United Technologies Corporation Method for molding precured high temperature resins
US4843015A (en) 1987-11-05 1989-06-27 Westvaco Corporation Method for determining volatile phosphorus in carbon
US4999330A (en) 1988-03-22 1991-03-12 Universite Du Quebec A Trois-Rivieres High-density adsorbent and method of producing same
US4873218A (en) 1988-05-26 1989-10-10 The United States Department Of Energy Low density, resorcinol-formaldehyde aerogels
US4997804A (en) 1988-05-26 1991-03-05 The United States Of America As Represented By The United States Department Of Energy Low density, resorcinol-formaldehyde aerogels
US4954469A (en) 1988-08-01 1990-09-04 Robinson Ken K Granulated activated carbon for water treatment
JPH02300222A (en) 1989-05-15 1990-12-12 Maruzen Petrochem Co Ltd Thermosetting resin composition
JP3060474B2 (en) 1989-07-29 2000-07-10 ソニー株式会社 Negative electrode for battery, method for producing the same, and nonaqueous electrolyte battery using the same
JPH0390615A (en) 1989-08-30 1991-04-16 Asahi Chem Ind Co Ltd Melt-spinning of high-molecular weight polyester
US5061416A (en) 1989-10-30 1991-10-29 Norton Company Process for the manufacture of friable silicon nitride bodies
JPH0459806A (en) 1990-06-29 1992-02-26 Unitika Ltd Production of macroporous-type spherical phenol-formaldehyde resin
JPH04139174A (en) 1990-09-28 1992-05-13 Asahi Denka Kogyo Kk New isocyanurate type ester derivative
JP3094567B2 (en) 1991-10-30 2000-10-03 大日本インキ化学工業株式会社 Thermosetting resin composition and cured product thereof
JPH05156121A (en) 1991-12-04 1993-06-22 Sumitomo Bakelite Co Ltd Molding material of phenol resin
US5260855A (en) 1992-01-17 1993-11-09 Kaschmitter James L Supercapacitors based on carbon foams
JPH05311512A (en) 1992-05-01 1993-11-22 Asahi Chem Ind Co Ltd Production of polyester yarn
JP2873988B2 (en) 1992-05-25 1999-03-24 東海カーボン株式会社 Electrode plate for plasma etching
US5420168A (en) 1993-04-01 1995-05-30 The Regents Of The University Of California Method of low pressure and/or evaporative drying of aerogel
GB9313501D0 (en) 1993-06-30 1993-08-11 Nycomed Imaging As Improvements in or relating to polymer materials
US5508341A (en) 1993-07-08 1996-04-16 Regents Of The University Of California Organic aerogel microspheres and fabrication method therefor
US5710092A (en) 1993-10-25 1998-01-20 Westvaco Corporation Highly microporous carbon
US5626637A (en) 1993-10-25 1997-05-06 Westvaco Corporation Low pressure methane storage with highly microporous carbons
US5965483A (en) 1993-10-25 1999-10-12 Westvaco Corporation Highly microporous carbons and process of manufacture
US5416056A (en) 1993-10-25 1995-05-16 Westvaco Corporation Production of highly microporous activated carbon products
NZ264766A (en) 1993-10-25 1996-10-28 Westvaco Corp Microporous activated carbon derived from lignocellulose material
US5465603A (en) 1993-11-05 1995-11-14 General Electric Company Optically improved diamond wire die
JPH0859919A (en) 1994-08-23 1996-03-05 Sumitomo Durez Co Ltd Phenolic resin composition
JPH08112539A (en) 1994-10-14 1996-05-07 Tokai Carbon Co Ltd Ball mill member for preparing high purity carbonaceous powder and its production
IT1271325B (en) 1994-12-23 1997-05-27 Poli Ind Chimica Spa DIASTEREOMERICALLY PURE COMPOUNDS DERIVED FROM 3-OXO AND 3-THIOXO-4-AZAANDROSTANI AND THEIR USE AS ANTI-ANDROGEN
US5626977A (en) 1995-02-21 1997-05-06 Regents Of The University Of California Composite carbon foam electrode
US5858486A (en) 1995-02-27 1999-01-12 Sgl Carbon Composites, Inc. High purity carbon/carbon composite useful as a crucible susceptor
US5674642A (en) 1995-06-02 1997-10-07 Regents Of The University Of Minnesota High capacity high rate materials
US5726118A (en) 1995-08-08 1998-03-10 Norit Americas, Inc. Activated carbon for separation of fluids by adsorption and method for its preparation
US5614460A (en) 1995-08-23 1997-03-25 Syracuse University Microporous carbons for fuel gas storage
JPH0963905A (en) 1995-08-29 1997-03-07 Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd Electric double-layer capacitor and manufacture thereof
US6096456A (en) 1995-09-29 2000-08-01 Showa Denko K.K. Film for a separator of electrochemical apparatus, and production method and use thereof
GB9522476D0 (en) 1995-11-02 1996-01-03 Boc Group Plc Method and vessel for the storage of gas
US5670571A (en) 1995-11-03 1997-09-23 Georgia-Pacific Resins, Inc. Process for producing a dispersed novolac resin and use in a binder system for thermal insulation
CA2238286C (en) 1995-11-14 2004-02-17 Osaka Gas Company Limited Material for negative electrode of lithium secondary battery, method for production thereof and lithium secondary battery using the same
AU1147597A (en) 1995-12-07 1997-06-27 Sandia Corporation Methods of preparation of carbon materials for use as electrodes in rechargeable batteries
JPH09275042A (en) 1996-02-09 1997-10-21 Honda Motor Co Ltd Activated charcoal for organic solvent-based electric double layer capacitor
JPH09328308A (en) 1996-04-10 1997-12-22 Mitsubishi Chem Corp Activated carbon, its production and capacitor using the same
CA2176452C (en) 1996-05-13 2008-12-02 Qiming Zhong Method for reducing the surface area of carbonaceous powders
US6268081B1 (en) 1996-07-02 2001-07-31 Ensci Inc Battery element containing efficiency improving additives
US5891822A (en) 1996-09-17 1999-04-06 Honda Giken Kogyo Kabushiki Kaisha Production process of active carbon used for electrode for organic solvent type electric double layer capacitor
FR2753963B1 (en) 1996-09-30 1998-12-24 Schlumberger Cie Dowell GROUT CEMENT AND METHOD OF DESIGNING A FORMULATION
US5744258A (en) 1996-12-23 1998-04-28 Motorola,Inc. High power, high energy, hybrid electrode and electrical energy storage device made therefrom
EP0891943A1 (en) 1997-01-09 1999-01-20 Nippon Sanso Corporation Porous carbon stock material and method of manufacturing same
US6309446B1 (en) 1997-02-17 2001-10-30 Kanebo, Ltd. Activated carbon for adsorptive storage of gaseous compound
US6338809B1 (en) 1997-02-24 2002-01-15 Superior Micropowders Llc Aerosol method and apparatus, particulate products, and electronic devices made therefrom
JP3709267B2 (en) 1997-02-26 2005-10-26 エア・ウォーター株式会社 Mesopore carbon and method for producing the same
US6205016B1 (en) 1997-06-04 2001-03-20 Hyperion Catalysis International, Inc. Fibril composite electrode for electrochemical capacitors
US5945084A (en) 1997-07-05 1999-08-31 Ocellus, Inc. Low density open cell organic foams, low density open cell carbon foams, and methods for preparing same
US6117585A (en) 1997-07-25 2000-09-12 Motorola, Inc. Hybrid energy storage device
US6911412B2 (en) 1998-02-24 2005-06-28 Cabot Corporation Composite particles for electrocatalytic applications
US6310762B1 (en) 1998-03-03 2001-10-30 Jeol Ltd. Carbon material for electric double layer capacitor, method of producing same, electric double layer capacitor and method of fabricating same
US6443490B2 (en) 1998-06-12 2002-09-03 William E. Webb Dual mode stabilizer for backhoe loaders and backhoe attachments
US6069107A (en) 1998-06-17 2000-05-30 Aer Energy Resources, Inc. Recharge catalyst with thin film carbon coating, metal-air electrode including said catalyst and methods for making said catalyst and electrode
KR100547455B1 (en) 1998-08-25 2006-02-01 후지 주코교 카부시키카이샤 Electrode material
US6072693A (en) 1998-11-02 2000-06-06 Asahi Glass Company Ltd. Electric double layer capacitor and separator therefor
US6631072B1 (en) 1998-12-05 2003-10-07 Energy Storage Systems Pty Ltd Charge storage device
JP2001089119A (en) 1999-04-30 2001-04-03 Adchemco Corp Carbonaceous material, method for producing and electric double layer capacitor using the carbonaceous material
US6865068B1 (en) 1999-04-30 2005-03-08 Asahi Glass Company, Limited Carbonaceous material, its production process and electric double layer capacitor employing it
US6589694B1 (en) 1999-05-14 2003-07-08 Mitsubishi Cable Industries, Ltd. Positive electrode active material, positive electrode active material composition and lithium ion secondary battery
JP3601581B2 (en) 1999-06-11 2004-12-15 東洋紡績株式会社 Carbon electrode material for vanadium redox flow battery
US6242127B1 (en) 1999-08-06 2001-06-05 Microporous Products, L.P. Polyethylene separator for energy storage cell
US6225257B1 (en) 1999-09-14 2001-05-01 Niagara Mohawk Power Corporation Post-carbonization treatment of microporous carbons for enhancement of methane and natural gas storage properties
US6339528B1 (en) 1999-09-16 2002-01-15 Ness Capacitor Co., Ltd. Metal oxide electrode for supercapacitor and manufacturing method thereof
JP2001118753A (en) 1999-10-21 2001-04-27 Matsushita Electric Ind Co Ltd Activated carbon for electric double layered capacitor and manufacturing method therefor
JP2001278609A (en) 2000-03-30 2001-10-10 Sumitomo Durez Co Ltd Method of producing oxygen-containing carbonaceous material
US7005181B2 (en) 2000-04-06 2006-02-28 American Aerogel Corporation Organic, open cell foam materials, their carbonized derivatives, and methods for producing same
WO2001086674A1 (en) 2000-05-09 2001-11-15 Mitsubishi Chemical Corporation Activated carbon for electric double layer capacitor
CA2377892C (en) 2000-05-11 2009-02-03 Tokuyama Corporation Polycrystalline silicon, method and apparatus for producing the same
JP2001332304A (en) 2000-05-24 2001-11-30 Sony Corp Electrolyte and cell using the same
DE60113195T2 (en) 2000-06-27 2006-07-06 Asahi Glass Co., Ltd. Activated carbon material, process for its preparation and electric double layer capacitor using this
US6815121B2 (en) 2000-07-31 2004-11-09 Electrovaya Inc. Particulate electrode including electrolyte for a rechargeable lithium battery
US20030170548A1 (en) 2000-09-07 2003-09-11 Masashi Otsuki Additive for non-aqueous liquid electrolyte, non-aqueous liquid electrolyte secondary cell and non-aqueous liquid electrolyte electric double layer capacitor
JP2002128514A (en) 2000-10-16 2002-05-09 Nisshinbo Ind Inc Carbonaceous material, polarizable electrode for electric double layer capacitor and electric double layer capacitor
US6815105B2 (en) 2000-10-23 2004-11-09 The Regents Of The University Of California Fuel cell apparatus and method thereof
IL155790A0 (en) 2000-11-09 2003-12-23 Foc Frankenburg Oil Company Es A supercapacitor and a method of manufacturing such a supercapacitor
FR2817387B1 (en) 2000-11-27 2003-03-21 Ceca Sa ENERGY STORAGE CELLS WITH HIGH ELECTRICAL CHEMICAL DOUBLE LAYER AND HIGH POWER DENSITY
US20020122985A1 (en) 2001-01-17 2002-09-05 Takaya Sato Battery active material powder mixture, electrode composition for batteries, secondary cell electrode, secondary cell, carbonaceous material powder mixture for electrical double-layer capacitors, polarizable electrode composition, polarizable electrode, and electrical double-layer capacitor
FR2821616B1 (en) 2001-03-01 2003-05-30 Pica ACTIVE CARBON WITH HIGH ADSORPTION CAPACITY AND LOW PHOSPHORIC RESIDUAL CONTENT, METHOD FOR PREPARING SAME AND APPLICATIONS
US20020168314A1 (en) 2001-03-08 2002-11-14 Roemmler Mike G. Method of making expanded graphite with high purity and related products
US6764667B1 (en) 2001-03-09 2004-07-20 Steiner, Iii Stephen A. Method for the formation of aerogel precursor using rapid gelation two-step catalysis
EP1248307A1 (en) 2001-04-03 2002-10-09 Hitachi, Ltd. Lead-acid battery
CN1172397C (en) 2001-06-12 2004-10-20 王立都 Liquid-state low-Na silicon salt dielectric prepared by magnetization technology for accumulator and its usage
EP1280215A1 (en) 2001-07-26 2003-01-29 University of Liege Porous carbon material
US20040248790A1 (en) 2001-09-03 2004-12-09 Shuji Hinuma Novel secretory proteins and dna thereof
TW504841B (en) 2001-09-27 2002-10-01 Nanya Technology Corp Manufacture method of memory cell of flash memory
US7218489B2 (en) 2001-10-04 2007-05-15 Ise Corporation High-power ultracapacitor energy storage pack and method of use
US20030108785A1 (en) 2001-12-10 2003-06-12 Wu L. W. Meso-porous carbon and hybrid electrodes and method for producing the same
CN1617765A (en) 2001-12-27 2005-05-18 气凝胶合成物有限公司 Aerogel and metallic compositions
JP3897709B2 (en) 2002-02-07 2007-03-28 日立マクセル株式会社 Electrode material, method for producing the same, negative electrode for non-aqueous secondary battery, and non-aqueous secondary battery
JP2004067498A (en) 2002-06-13 2004-03-04 Kashima Oil Co Ltd Activated carbon and electrical double layer capacitor using the same
US20030012722A1 (en) 2002-07-02 2003-01-16 Jie Liu High yiel vapor phase deposition method for large scale sing walled carbon nanotube preparation
JP4076381B2 (en) 2002-07-05 2008-04-16 横浜ゴム株式会社 Thermoplastic elastomer composition
US7074880B2 (en) 2002-07-22 2006-07-11 Aspen Aerogels, Inc. Polyimide aerogels, carbon aerogels, and metal carbide aerogels and methods of making same
JP4238830B2 (en) 2002-07-30 2009-03-18 クラレケミカル株式会社 Activated carbon, manufacturing method thereof, polarizable electrode, and electric double layer capacitor
WO2004035883A2 (en) 2002-10-17 2004-04-29 Nexen Nano Tech Co., Ltd Fibrous nano-carbon and preparation method thereof
JP4025995B2 (en) 2002-11-26 2007-12-26 信越化学工業株式会社 Nonaqueous electrolyte secondary battery negative electrode material, method for producing the same, and lithium ion secondary battery
JP2004203715A (en) 2002-12-26 2004-07-22 Honda Motor Co Ltd Alkali activated carbon, its producing method, polarizable electrode for electric double-layer capacitor containing it and electric double-layer capacitor containing the electrode
JP2004221332A (en) 2003-01-15 2004-08-05 Gun Ei Chem Ind Co Ltd Active carbon composition for electrode of electric double layer capacitor and its manufacturing method
JP3585043B2 (en) 2003-01-22 2004-11-04 メルク・ホエイ株式会社 Pharmaceutical adsorbent and its production method
JP4626514B2 (en) 2003-02-18 2011-02-09 日本電気株式会社 ELECTRODE FOR FUEL CELL, FUEL CELL, AND METHOD FOR PRODUCING THE SAME
KR100480969B1 (en) 2003-03-10 2005-04-14 한국에너지기술연구원 Electrocatalyst using support material modified CO tolerant electrocatalyst of fuel cells
EP1612819B1 (en) 2003-03-31 2019-06-12 Subaru Corporation Organic electrolyte capacitor
SE0300975D0 (en) 2003-04-03 2003-04-03 Protista Internat Ab Chromatographic separation method, separation device and process for the preparation of a separation medium for use therein
JP2004315283A (en) 2003-04-15 2004-11-11 National Institute Of Advanced Industrial & Technology Porous carbon particle and its producing method
WO2004099073A2 (en) 2003-05-09 2004-11-18 Mcgill University Process for the production of activated carbon
US7432221B2 (en) 2003-06-03 2008-10-07 Korea Institute Of Energy Research Electrocatalyst for fuel cells using support body resistant to carbon monoxide poisoning
WO2004110930A1 (en) 2003-06-12 2004-12-23 Matsushita Electric Industrial Co., Ltd. Composite porous body containing nanoparticle and method for producing same
US20050250011A1 (en) 2004-04-02 2005-11-10 Maxwell Technologies, Inc. Particle packaging systems and methods
US7754382B2 (en) 2003-07-30 2010-07-13 Tdk Corporation Electrochemical capacitor having at least one electrode including composite particles
KR101046857B1 (en) 2003-08-04 2011-07-06 니폰 제온 가부시키가이샤 Binder for Electric Double Layer Capacitor Electrode
JP4662730B2 (en) 2003-09-12 2011-03-30 ローム アンド ハース カンパニー Macroreticular carbonaceous materials useful in energy storage devices
CN100539287C (en) 2003-09-18 2009-09-09 联邦科学及工业研究组织 High performance energy storage devices
JP2005136397A (en) 2003-10-10 2005-05-26 Showa Denko Kk Activated carbon, electrode material using it, and electric double layer capacitor
JP3764157B2 (en) 2003-10-10 2006-04-05 東洋炭素株式会社 High-purity carbon-based material and ceramic film-coated high-purity carbon-based material
KR101027091B1 (en) 2003-10-31 2011-04-06 쇼와 덴코 가부시키가이샤 Carbon material for battery electrode and production method and use thereof
JP4391198B2 (en) 2003-10-31 2009-12-24 オルガノ株式会社 Activated carbon precursor, activated carbon, method for producing activated carbon, and polarizable electrode for electric double layer capacitor
JP4754813B2 (en) 2003-12-01 2011-08-24 肇 田門 Method for producing carbon material and tablet-like dried gel
DE10357873A1 (en) 2003-12-11 2005-07-07 Robert Bosch Gmbh Injector
US20050135993A1 (en) 2003-12-23 2005-06-23 Jun Xu Manganese oxide based materials as ion intercalation hosts in lithium batteries
WO2005065425A2 (en) 2003-12-30 2005-07-21 The Regents Of The University Of California Localized synthesis and self-assembly of nanostructures
US7255924B2 (en) 2004-01-13 2007-08-14 The United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Navy Carbon nanoarchitectures with ultrathin, conformal polymer coatings for electrochemical capacitors
US7449165B2 (en) 2004-02-03 2008-11-11 Ut-Battelle, Llc Robust carbon monolith having hierarchical porosity
US20050196336A1 (en) 2004-03-05 2005-09-08 Chatterjee Arup K. Activated graphitic carbon and metal hybrids thereof
US7626804B2 (en) 2004-03-10 2009-12-01 Masaki Yoshio Power storage element and electric double layer capacitor
US7799733B2 (en) 2004-03-31 2010-09-21 Council Of Scientific And Industrial Research Process for preparing high surface area carbon
US7521140B2 (en) 2004-04-19 2009-04-21 Eksigent Technologies, Llc Fuel cell system with electrokinetic pump
US7695760B2 (en) 2004-06-04 2010-04-13 Yamanashi University Deposition method for oxide thin film or stacked metal thin films using supercritical fluid or subcritical fluid, and deposition apparatus therefor
KR101205661B1 (en) 2004-06-04 2012-11-27 고꾸리쯔다이가꾸호오징 야마나시다이가꾸 Method of forming metal laminate thin film or oxide thin film using supercritical fluid or subcritical fluid, and film forming apparatus therefor
GB0413324D0 (en) 2004-06-15 2004-07-21 Johnson Matthey Plc Gas diffusion substrate
US7245478B2 (en) 2004-08-16 2007-07-17 Maxwell Technologies, Inc. Enhanced breakdown voltage electrode
EP1786008B1 (en) 2004-08-18 2013-12-18 Nippon Oil Corporation Raw material carbon composition for carbon material for electrode of electric double layer capacitor
CN100336774C (en) 2004-10-18 2007-09-12 成都理工大学 Process for synthesizing heat-stable aluminium titanate
JP4547519B2 (en) 2004-10-22 2010-09-22 独立行政法人物質・材料研究機構 Method for producing silicon nanowire
US20060093915A1 (en) 2004-11-04 2006-05-04 Lundquist Eric G Carbons useful in energy storage devices
JP2006179697A (en) 2004-12-22 2006-07-06 Nippon Oil Corp Coking coal composition of electrode carbon material of electric double-layer capacitor
JP2006248848A (en) 2005-03-11 2006-09-21 Jfe Chemical Corp Method for manufacturing porous carbon material and method for processing the same
DE102005011940A1 (en) 2005-03-14 2006-09-21 Degussa Ag Process for the preparation of coated carbon particles and their use in anode materials for lithium-ion batteries
JP2006264993A (en) 2005-03-22 2006-10-05 Sumitomo Bakelite Co Ltd Method of manufacturing carbon material, carbon material, negative electrode material for secondary cell and non-aqueous electrolyte secondary cell
US20060223965A1 (en) 2005-03-31 2006-10-05 Aspen Aerogels Inc. High strength organic-inorganic hybrid gel materials
US20090213529A1 (en) 2005-04-14 2009-08-27 Drexel University Nanocellular high surface area material and methods for use and production thereof
KR101257966B1 (en) 2005-05-27 2013-04-24 수미토모 케미칼 컴퍼니 리미티드 Electric double layer capacitor
JP4968425B2 (en) * 2005-08-04 2012-07-04 戸田工業株式会社 Spherical porous carbon particle powder and method for producing the same
US20070048605A1 (en) 2005-08-23 2007-03-01 Pez Guido P Stable electrolyte counteranions for electrochemical devices
US7817403B2 (en) 2005-08-30 2010-10-19 Fuji Jukogyo Kabushiki Kaisha Lithium ion capacitor
JP4708152B2 (en) 2005-10-18 2011-06-22 Jx日鉱日石エネルギー株式会社 Method for producing carbon material for electric double layer capacitor electrode
CN107069091A (en) 2005-10-20 2017-08-18 三菱化学株式会社 Lithium secondary battery and the nonaqueous electrolytic solution wherein used
US7723262B2 (en) 2005-11-21 2010-05-25 Energ2, Llc Activated carbon cryogels and related methods
AU2006320362A1 (en) 2005-11-30 2007-06-07 Energ2, Inc. Carbon-based foam nanocomposite hydrogen storage material
JP5338073B2 (en) 2005-12-02 2013-11-13 株式会社Gsユアサ Non-aqueous electrolyte battery and manufacturing method thereof
CN101326675B (en) 2005-12-06 2012-06-06 雷沃尔特科技有限公司 Bifunctionan air electrode
US20080132632A1 (en) 2006-03-02 2008-06-05 Schiraldi David A Absorbent compositions with clay aerogels and methods for forming absorbent compositions
KR20080108222A (en) 2006-04-07 2008-12-12 미쓰비시 가가꾸 가부시키가이샤 Lithium transition metal-based compound powder for positive electrode material in lithium rechargeable battery, method for manufacturing the powder, spray dried product of the powder, firing precursor of the powder, and positive electrode for lithium rechargeable battery and lithium rechargeable battery using the powder
CN1877888A (en) 2006-05-19 2006-12-13 清华大学 Hard carbon-metal lithium nitride composite cathode materials and method for preparing same
EP2038218A1 (en) 2006-05-31 2009-03-25 Max-Planck-Gesellschaft zur Förderung der Wissenschaften e.V. Porous electrically conductive carbon material and uses thereof
JP2008008539A (en) 2006-06-28 2008-01-17 Sharp Corp Heating cooker
JP5210504B2 (en) 2006-06-30 2013-06-12 関西熱化学株式会社 Activated carbon purification method and activated carbon purification apparatus
US7722991B2 (en) 2006-08-09 2010-05-25 Toyota Motor Corporation High performance anode material for lithium-ion battery
KR100839613B1 (en) 2006-09-11 2008-06-19 주식회사 씨앤테크 Composite Sintering Materials Using Carbon Nanotube And Manufacturing Method Thereof
KR101431855B1 (en) 2006-10-09 2014-08-25 브리티쉬 아메리칸 토바코 (인베스트먼츠) 리미티드 Carbonising and/or activating carbonaceous material
JP2008094925A (en) 2006-10-11 2008-04-24 Nagoya Oil Chem Co Ltd Flame-retarding treatment liquid, flame-retardant fiber material and interior decoration material comprising the same
US8293860B2 (en) 2006-10-20 2012-10-23 Air Water Inc. Non-thermofusible phenol resin powder, method for producing the same, thermosetting resin composition, sealing material for semiconductor, and adhesive for semiconductor
EP2109868A4 (en) 2006-11-08 2015-07-29 Univ Missouri High surface area carbon and process for its production
WO2008118199A2 (en) 2006-11-09 2008-10-02 Indspec Chemical Corporation Method of stabilizing resorcinol resins and gel compositions made therefrom
KR101496934B1 (en) 2006-11-15 2015-03-03 유니버시티 오브 워싱톤 스루 이츠 센터 포 커머셜리제이션 electric double layer capacitance device
KR100818263B1 (en) 2006-12-19 2008-03-31 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 Porous anode active material, method of preparing the same, and anode and lithium battery containing the material
JPWO2008081883A1 (en) * 2006-12-28 2010-04-30 東レ・ダウコーニング株式会社 Porous silicon-containing carbon-based composite material and electrode and battery comprising the same
CN1986401A (en) 2007-01-10 2007-06-27 华东理工大学 Improved process for preparing porous microsphere active carbon
US20080173239A1 (en) 2007-01-24 2008-07-24 Yuri Makarov Method, system, and apparatus for the growth of SiC and related or similar material, by chemical vapor deposition, using precursors in modified cold-wall reactor
EP2117068A4 (en) 2007-02-01 2010-04-14 Nat Inst Of Advanced Ind Scien Electrode catalyst for fuel cell and fuel cell using the same
JP4983304B2 (en) 2007-02-26 2012-07-25 新神戸電機株式会社 Energy conversion device
US20080201925A1 (en) 2007-02-28 2008-08-28 Maxwell Technologies, Inc. Ultracapacitor electrode with controlled sulfur content
US20080204973A1 (en) 2007-02-28 2008-08-28 Maxwell Technologies, Inc. Ultracapacitor electrode with controlled iron content
AR067238A1 (en) 2007-03-20 2009-10-07 Commw Scient Ind Res Org OPTIMIZED DEVICES FOR ENERGY STORAGE
US8143185B2 (en) 2007-03-26 2012-03-27 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Photocatalytic deposition of metals and compositions comprising the same
US7642333B2 (en) 2007-05-21 2010-01-05 Georgia-Pacific Chemicals Llc Anhydride and resorcinol latent catalyst system for improving cure characteristics of phenolic resins
JP2008294314A (en) 2007-05-28 2008-12-04 Sanyo Electric Co Ltd Capacitor
JP4458117B2 (en) 2007-06-01 2010-04-28 株式会社豊田中央研究所 Non-aqueous air battery and its catalyst
US7731988B2 (en) 2007-08-03 2010-06-08 Zimmer, Inc. Multi-polymer hydrogels
US20090053594A1 (en) 2007-08-23 2009-02-26 Johnson Lonnie G Rechargeable air battery and manufacturing method
JP5311930B2 (en) 2007-08-29 2013-10-09 住友化学株式会社 Method for producing silicon
US7933114B2 (en) 2007-08-31 2011-04-26 Corning Incorporated Composite carbon electrodes useful in electric double layer capacitors and capacitive deionization and methods of making the same
KR101557481B1 (en) 2007-10-02 2015-10-02 아토테크 도이칠란드 게엠베하 Crystalline chromium alloy deposit
KR100937961B1 (en) 2007-10-18 2010-01-21 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 Carrier for fuel cell, and catalyst, membrane-electrode assembly, and fuel cell system including same
KR100911845B1 (en) 2007-10-30 2009-08-11 한국과학기술연구원 Carbon aerogels for supercapacitors and method for manufacturing the same
US8119288B2 (en) 2007-11-05 2012-02-21 Nanotek Instruments, Inc. Hybrid anode compositions for lithium ion batteries
CN101919090B (en) 2007-11-12 2014-04-16 三洋电机株式会社 Negative electrode material for rechargeable battery with nonaqueous electrolyte, negative electrode for rechargeable battery with nonaqueous electrolyte, rechargeable battery with nonaqueous electrolyte, and process for producing polycrystalline silcon particle as active ingredient of rechargeable battery negative electrode material
US8613973B2 (en) 2007-12-06 2013-12-24 International Business Machines Corporation Photovoltaic device with solution-processed chalcogenide absorber layer
US7986509B2 (en) 2008-01-17 2011-07-26 Fraser Wade Seymour Composite electrode comprising a carbon structure coated with a thin film of mixed metal oxides for electrochemical energy storage
US9941709B2 (en) * 2009-02-25 2018-04-10 Cf Traverse Llc Hybrid energy storage device charging
JP5412909B2 (en) 2008-03-24 2014-02-12 日本ゼオン株式会社 Lead-acid battery electrode and lead-acid battery
CN101550531B (en) 2008-04-03 2013-04-24 清华大学 Method for preparing silicon nano structures
WO2009131700A2 (en) 2008-04-25 2009-10-29 Envia Systems, Inc. High energy lithium ion batteries with particular negative electrode compositions
CN101284665A (en) 2008-05-08 2008-10-15 华东理工大学 Process for preparing mesopore pitch-based spherical activated carbon by post-carbonizing impregnated metal salts
EP3213956B1 (en) 2008-06-12 2021-12-29 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Energy storage device
US9786944B2 (en) 2008-06-12 2017-10-10 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology High energy density redox flow device
US8361659B2 (en) 2008-06-20 2013-01-29 Toyota Motor Engineering & Manufacturing North America, Inc. Lithium-alloying-material/carbon composite
EP2306476A4 (en) 2008-06-24 2015-05-06 Panasonic Ip Man Co Ltd Activated carbon for electrochemical element and electrochemical element using the same
CN101318648B (en) 2008-07-10 2011-05-11 深圳市贝特瑞新能源材料股份有限公司 Process and equipment for producing graphite dust
CN102089240B (en) 2008-07-15 2016-06-08 杜伊斯堡-艾森大学 Insert the porous carbon substrate of silicon and/or stannum
JP5522444B2 (en) 2008-09-22 2014-06-18 株式会社Gsユアサ Lead acid battery
US8318122B2 (en) 2008-10-10 2012-11-27 Headwaters Tech Innovation Llc Preparation of a carbon nanomaterial using a reverse microemulsion
CN102282704A (en) 2008-11-18 2011-12-14 康奈尔大学 Carbon coated anode materials
WO2011002536A2 (en) 2009-04-08 2011-01-06 Energ2, Inc. Manufacturing methods for the production of carbon materials
JP5495887B2 (en) 2009-04-28 2014-05-21 株式会社デンソー Negative electrode for non-aqueous electrolyte battery and non-aqueous electrolyte battery
KR101093705B1 (en) 2009-04-29 2011-12-19 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 Rechargeable lithium battery
GB2470056B (en) 2009-05-07 2013-09-11 Nexeon Ltd A method of making silicon anode material for rechargeable cells
US20100285358A1 (en) 2009-05-07 2010-11-11 Amprius, Inc. Electrode Including Nanostructures for Rechargeable Cells
JP5310251B2 (en) 2009-05-18 2013-10-09 信越化学工業株式会社 Method for producing negative electrode material for non-aqueous electrolyte secondary battery
CN102449823B (en) * 2009-05-28 2015-05-13 德克萨斯大学系统董事会 Novel composite anode materials for lithium ion batteries
US10366802B2 (en) * 2009-06-05 2019-07-30 University of Pittsburgh—of the Commonwealth System of Higher Education Compositions including nano-particles and a nano-structured support matrix and methods of preparation as reversible high capacity anodes in energy storage systems
EP2448748A4 (en) 2009-07-01 2016-04-06 Basf Se Ultrapure synthetic carbon materials
DE102009033739A1 (en) 2009-07-17 2011-01-27 Evonik Degussa Gmbh Nanostructured silicon-carbon composites for battery electrodes
CN101604743A (en) 2009-07-24 2009-12-16 长春锂源新能源科技有限公司 Composite cathode material for lithium ion cell and preparation method
US9373838B2 (en) 2009-09-29 2016-06-21 Georgia Tech Research Corporation Electrodes, lithium-ion batteries, and methods of making and using same
JP5678372B2 (en) 2009-11-30 2015-03-04 独立行政法人産業技術総合研究所 Nitrogen-containing porous carbon material, method for producing the same, and electric double layer capacitor using the nitrogen-containing porous carbon material
KR102098547B1 (en) 2010-01-18 2020-04-08 에네베이트 코포레이션 Composite material film for electrochemical storage
JP5534000B2 (en) 2010-02-18 2014-06-25 株式会社村田製作所 Electrode active material for all solid state secondary battery and all solid state secondary battery
WO2011112992A1 (en) 2010-03-12 2011-09-15 Energ2, Inc. Mesoporous carbon materials comprising bifunctional catalysts
WO2011125325A1 (en) 2010-04-06 2011-10-13 Necトーキン株式会社 Electricity accumulator device
CN102214817A (en) * 2010-04-09 2011-10-12 清华大学 Carbon/silicon/carbon nano composite structure cathode material and preparation method thereof
US20110287189A1 (en) 2010-05-12 2011-11-24 Enerize Corporation Method of the electrode production
US9876221B2 (en) 2010-05-14 2018-01-23 Samsung Sdi Co., Ltd. Negative active material for rechargeable lithium battery and rechargeable lithium battery including same
WO2011156599A2 (en) 2010-06-09 2011-12-15 Georgia-Pacific Chemicals Llc Methods for producing precursor solutions and sol-gels for nano-engineered carbon materials and non-engineered carbon materials created therefrom
WO2011157013A1 (en) 2010-06-18 2011-12-22 深圳市贝特瑞新能源材料股份有限公司 Composite hard carbon material of negative electrode for lithium ion battery and method for preparing the same
CN101969120B (en) 2010-09-15 2012-08-08 超威电源有限公司 Technology for manufacturing lead-acid battery pole plate
CN103118976B (en) 2010-09-17 2016-07-06 古河电气工业株式会社 Porous silicon particle and Porous silicon complex particles and their manufacture method
US8654507B2 (en) 2010-09-30 2014-02-18 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Enhanced packing of energy storage particles
US20120264020A1 (en) * 2010-10-07 2012-10-18 Applied Sciences, Inc. Method of depositing silicon on carbon nanomaterials
DE102010049249A1 (en) 2010-10-25 2012-04-26 Heraeus Quarzglas Gmbh & Co. Kg Porous carbon product, process for its production and use
FR2967669B1 (en) 2010-11-23 2012-11-30 Hutchinson NEW SULFUR MODIFIED MONOLITHIC POROUS CARBON MATERIAL, PROCESS FOR PREPARING SAME, AND USES FOR ENERGY STORAGE AND RESTITUTION
JP2013544748A (en) 2010-11-26 2013-12-19 ビーエーエスエフ ソシエタス・ヨーロピア Method for producing nitrogen-containing porous carbonaceous material
CN102479949B (en) 2010-11-30 2015-05-27 比亚迪股份有限公司 Anode active material of lithium ion battery, preparation method thereof and lithium ion battery
US8482900B2 (en) 2010-11-30 2013-07-09 Corning Incorporated Porous carbon for electrochemical double layer capacitors
US9397338B2 (en) 2010-12-22 2016-07-19 Enevate Corporation Electrodes, electrochemical cells, and methods of forming electrodes and electrochemical cells
EP2659498B1 (en) 2010-12-28 2020-07-22 Basf Se Carbon materials comprising enhanced electrochemical properties
DE102011004564A1 (en) 2011-02-23 2012-08-23 Evonik Litarion Gmbh Electrode material with high capacity
WO2012122213A2 (en) 2011-03-07 2012-09-13 Exide Technologies Energy storage devices comprising carbon-based additives and methods of making thereof
US20120262127A1 (en) 2011-04-15 2012-10-18 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Flow ultracapacitor
EP2653598B1 (en) 2011-05-18 2016-07-27 C-Eng Co., Ltd. Three-dimensional net structure, method for producing three-dimensional net structure, and apparatus for producing three-dimensional net structure
US20120305651A1 (en) 2011-05-31 2012-12-06 Wisconsin Alumni Research Foundation Electrochemical capacitor battery hybrid energy storage device capable of self-recharging
CN107785180A (en) 2011-06-03 2018-03-09 巴斯福股份公司 For the carbon lead blend in mixed tensor storage device
US8542261B2 (en) 2011-06-30 2013-09-24 Kabushiki Kaisha Toshiba Method for color erasing process and color erasing device
US8871116B2 (en) 2011-09-30 2014-10-28 Corning Incorporated Hydrochloric acid washing of carbon and graphite for making conductive ink for ultracapacitors
FR2981643B1 (en) 2011-10-25 2013-12-27 Commissariat Energie Atomique PROCESS FOR THE PREPARATION OF A COMPOSITE MATERIAL SILICON / CARBON, MATERIAL THUS PREPARED, AND ELECTRODE, IN PARTICULAR ELECTRODE NEGATIVE, COMPRISING THIS MATERIAL.
CN102509781B (en) 2011-10-27 2015-11-04 上海交通大学 Silicon-carbon composite cathode material and preparation method thereof
CN103107315B (en) 2011-11-10 2016-03-30 北京有色金属研究总院 A kind of nano-silicone wire/carbon composite material and preparation method thereof
US8993172B2 (en) 2011-12-10 2015-03-31 Kalptree Energy, Inc. Li-ion battery and battery active components on metal wire
JP6039687B2 (en) 2011-12-22 2016-12-07 キャボット コーポレイションCabot Corporation Use in electrodes for carbon black and lead acid batteries
WO2013106782A2 (en) 2012-01-11 2013-07-18 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Hard carbon materials
US9139441B2 (en) 2012-01-19 2015-09-22 Envia Systems, Inc. Porous silicon based anode material formed using metal reduction
US9409777B2 (en) 2012-02-09 2016-08-09 Basf Se Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
JP2015513570A (en) 2012-02-09 2015-05-14 ジョージア − パシフィック ケミカルズ エルエルシー Preparation of polymer resins and carbon materials
JP2015507064A (en) 2012-02-09 2015-03-05 ジョージア − パシフィック ケミカルズ エルエルシー Method for producing polymer particles in gel form
CN104394853B (en) 2012-02-19 2017-10-10 纳维基因股份有限公司 Purposes of the porous nanostructured in delivering
JP6047799B2 (en) 2012-03-23 2016-12-21 アイオン株式会社 Activated carbon for electrode of electricity storage device and method for producing activated carbon for electrode of electricity storage device
CN102623680B (en) * 2012-04-05 2014-03-12 中南大学 Silicon-carbon composite cathode material with three-dimensional preformed hole structure and preparation method thereof
US20130344391A1 (en) * 2012-06-18 2013-12-26 Sila Nanotechnologies Inc. Multi-shell structures and fabrication methods for battery active materials with expansion properties
US9186174B2 (en) 2012-08-22 2015-11-17 Subramaniam Chitoor Krishnan Methods and systems for accessing a pericardial space and preventing strokes arising from the left atrial appendage
CN102820455A (en) * 2012-08-02 2012-12-12 天津市贝特瑞新能源科技有限公司 Hard carbon negative electrode material of lithium ion battery, preparation method and application of hard carbon negative electrode material
US9929400B2 (en) 2012-08-06 2018-03-27 Ut-Battelle, Llc High capacity monolithic composite Si/carbon fiber electrode architectures synthesized from low cost materials and process technologies
US10374221B2 (en) 2012-08-24 2019-08-06 Sila Nanotechnologies, Inc. Scaffolding matrix with internal nanoparticles
WO2014062470A1 (en) 2012-10-19 2014-04-24 California Institute Of Technology Nanostructured carbon materials for adsorption of methane and other gases
CN105050949A (en) 2012-11-26 2015-11-11 佐治亚-太平洋化工品有限公司 Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
JP5952507B2 (en) 2012-11-29 2016-07-13 ジョージア − パシフィック ケミカルズ エルエルシー Method for producing gel-form polymer particles using suspension or emulsion polymerization and method for producing airgel
CN103094528B (en) 2013-01-09 2016-05-04 深圳市贝特瑞新能源材料股份有限公司 A kind of lithium ion power and energy-storage battery hard carbon cathode material and preparation method thereof
JP5339107B1 (en) 2013-02-27 2013-11-13 東洋紡株式会社 Network structure with excellent compression durability
KR101580039B1 (en) 2013-03-13 2015-12-23 주식회사 엘지화학 Manufacturing method of porous carbon-silicon composite, and porous carbon-silicon composite manufactured thereby
EP2970552A4 (en) 2013-03-13 2017-03-08 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Improved emulsion and suspension polymerization processes, and improved electrochemical performance for carbon derived from same
CN105190948B (en) 2013-03-14 2019-04-26 14族科技公司 The complex carbon material of electrochemical modification agent comprising lithium alloyage
WO2014160385A2 (en) 2013-03-14 2014-10-02 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Energy storage devices based on hybrid carbon electrode systems
KR101325952B1 (en) 2013-04-01 2013-11-07 한국기계연구원 High performance functionalized activated carbon supercapacitor by using curable polymer binder
US20160344030A1 (en) 2013-06-12 2016-11-24 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. High capacity hard carbon materials comprising efficiency enhancers
US9136064B2 (en) 2013-07-26 2015-09-15 Corning Incorporated Carbon for high voltage EDLCs
CN104347857B (en) 2013-07-29 2017-07-07 华为技术有限公司 Negative electrode of lithium ionic secondary battery and preparation method thereof, cathode pole piece of lithium ion secondary battery and lithium rechargeable battery
CN103456929B (en) 2013-09-04 2015-08-12 中南大学 A kind of lithium sulfur battery anode material and preparation method thereof
JP6526685B2 (en) 2013-09-20 2019-06-05 ジョージア − パシフィック ケミカルズ エルエルシー Method for producing wet gel and method for producing dry gel from the wet gel
US10195583B2 (en) 2013-11-05 2019-02-05 Group 14 Technologies, Inc. Carbon-based compositions with highly efficient volumetric gas sorption
US10224537B2 (en) 2013-11-29 2019-03-05 Sila Nanotechnologies, Inc. Fluorides in nanoporous, electrically-conductive scaffolding matrix for metal and metal-ion batteries
CN103746098B (en) 2013-12-25 2015-08-12 中南大学 A kind of preparation method of rich nitrogen multimode honeycomb carbon-sulphur composite positive pole
JP2015130287A (en) 2014-01-08 2015-07-16 株式会社デンソー Carbon complex and power storage device
US9735430B2 (en) 2014-01-23 2017-08-15 Semiconductor Energy Laboratory Co., Ltd. Electrode, power storage device, and electronic device
US10590277B2 (en) 2014-03-14 2020-03-17 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Methods for sol-gel polymerization in absence of solvent and creation of tunable carbon structure from same
KR20150117545A (en) 2014-04-10 2015-10-20 삼성에스디아이 주식회사 Anode active material, preparing method thereof, and lithium secondary battery comprising the same
US20150306570A1 (en) 2014-04-29 2015-10-29 Ut-Battelle, Llc Metal-carbon composites and methods for their production
DE102014211012A1 (en) 2014-06-10 2015-12-17 Robert Bosch Gmbh Manufacturing method for a silicon-carbon composite
CN104108698B (en) 2014-07-30 2015-11-18 兰州理工大学 The preparation method of highly doped amount nitrogen sulphur codoped ordered mesopore carbon
JP5796263B1 (en) 2014-07-30 2015-10-21 有限会社 トラスト21 Knitting resin manufacturing apparatus and knitting resin manufacturing method
US9742001B2 (en) 2014-08-07 2017-08-22 Nanotek Instruments, Inc. Graphene foam-protected anode active materials for lithium batteries
US10340520B2 (en) 2014-10-14 2019-07-02 Sila Nanotechnologies, Inc. Nanocomposite battery electrode particles with changing properties
JP6609909B2 (en) 2014-11-21 2019-11-27 日立化成株式会社 Negative electrode material for lithium ion secondary battery, negative electrode for lithium ion secondary battery, and lithium ion secondary battery
JP6503700B2 (en) 2014-11-21 2019-04-24 日立化成株式会社 Negative electrode material for lithium ion secondary battery, negative electrode and lithium ion secondary battery
JP6451340B2 (en) 2015-01-22 2019-01-16 株式会社豊田中央研究所 Composite and production method thereof
US20190097222A1 (en) 2015-08-14 2019-03-28 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Composites of porous nano-featured silicon materials and carbon materials
US10147950B2 (en) 2015-08-28 2018-12-04 Group 14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US11108034B2 (en) 2015-10-06 2021-08-31 Arcactive Limited Lead-acid battery electrode including carbon fiber material with low surface area
CN108475777A (en) 2015-10-15 2018-08-31 艾纳G2技术公司 Low deflation carbon material for improving lead-acid battery performance
US10008338B2 (en) 2016-01-13 2018-06-26 Lawrence Livermore National Security, Llc High temperature oxygen treated carbon aerogels
CN105680023B (en) 2016-04-06 2018-11-09 上海璞泰来新能源科技股份有限公司 A kind of preparation method, negative material and the lithium battery of high magnification silicon based composite material
CN106207108B (en) 2016-07-09 2018-07-27 太原理工大学 Si-C composite material and the preparation method and application thereof based on macromolecule foaming microballoon
KR102571014B1 (en) 2017-03-09 2023-08-25 그룹14 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Degradation of silicon-containing precursors on porous scaffold materials
AU2018338093A1 (en) 2017-09-20 2020-03-26 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Hydrated carbon material powder and use of it for preparation of an electrode for an electrical storage device
KR101942815B1 (en) 2017-11-13 2019-01-30 한국과학기술연구원 A eco-friendly method for manufacturing of a porous silicon carbide structure
WO2019147836A2 (en) 2018-01-24 2019-08-01 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Methods for preparing carbon materials
US20200144619A1 (en) 2018-09-05 2020-05-07 Basf Se Carbon materials for improving performance of lead acid batteries
GB201818232D0 (en) 2018-11-08 2018-12-26 Nexeon Ltd Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
GB201818235D0 (en) 2018-11-08 2018-12-26 Nexeon Ltd Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
GB2580033B (en) 2018-12-19 2021-03-10 Nexeon Ltd Electroactive materials for metal-Ion batteries
US10508335B1 (en) 2019-02-13 2019-12-17 Nexeon Limited Process for preparing electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
WO2020128523A1 (en) 2018-12-21 2020-06-25 Nexeon Limited Process for preparing electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US10964940B1 (en) 2020-09-17 2021-03-30 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
GB2597759A (en) 2020-08-03 2022-02-09 Nexeon Ltd Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
WO2022035879A1 (en) 2020-08-10 2022-02-17 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Vibro-thermally assisted chemical vapor infiltration
US11335903B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2022-05-17 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Highly efficient manufacturing of silicon-carbon composites materials comprising ultra low z
CN116323482A (en) 2020-08-18 2023-06-23 14集团技术公司 Manufacture of silicon-carbon composite materials
US20220059818A1 (en) 2020-08-18 2022-02-24 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Lithium-silicon battery
US11639292B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2023-05-02 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Particulate composite materials
US11174167B1 (en) 2020-08-18 2021-11-16 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon carbon composites comprising ultra low Z
WO2022040328A1 (en) 2020-08-18 2022-02-24 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon-carbon composites
CA3195673A1 (en) 2020-09-25 2022-03-31 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon-carbon composite materials with enhanced electrochemical properties
CA3195890A1 (en) 2020-09-30 2022-04-07 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Methods of passivation to control oxygen content and reactivity of silicon-carbon composite materials

Patent Citations (5)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US5093216A (en) * 1989-07-29 1992-03-03 Sony Corporation Carbonaceous material and a non aqueous electrolyte cell using the same
US5294498A (en) * 1991-03-02 1994-03-15 Sony Corporation Anode material, method for producing it and non-aqueous electrolyte cell employing such anode materials
US5834138A (en) * 1995-03-06 1998-11-10 Sony Corporation Negative electrode material for non-aqueous liquid electrolyte secondary cell and non-aqueous liquid electrolyte secondary cell employing same
US20140335410A1 (en) * 2009-05-11 2014-11-13 Nexeon Limited Electrode composition for a secondary battery cell
US20110159375A1 (en) * 2009-12-11 2011-06-30 Energ2, Inc. Carbon materials comprising an electrochemical modifier

Cited By (125)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US9580321B2 (en) 2009-07-01 2017-02-28 Basf Se Ultrapure synthetic carbon materials
US10287170B2 (en) 2009-07-01 2019-05-14 Basf Se Ultrapure synthetic carbon materials
US9680159B2 (en) 2010-03-12 2017-06-13 Basf Se Mesoporous carbon materials comprising bifunctional catalysts
US9985289B2 (en) 2010-09-30 2018-05-29 Basf Se Enhanced packing of energy storage particles
US10490358B2 (en) 2011-04-15 2019-11-26 Basf Se Flow ultracapacitor
US11725074B2 (en) 2012-02-09 2023-08-15 Group 14 Technologies, Inc. Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
US11401363B2 (en) * 2012-02-09 2022-08-02 Basf Se Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
US10173900B2 (en) * 2012-02-09 2019-01-08 Georgia-Pacific Chemicals Llc Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
US11718701B2 (en) 2012-02-09 2023-08-08 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
US20130211005A1 (en) * 2012-02-09 2013-08-15 Georgia-Pacific Chemicals, Llc Methods for making polymer particulates in gel form
US11732079B2 (en) 2012-02-09 2023-08-22 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
US9133337B2 (en) * 2012-02-09 2015-09-15 Georgia-Pacific Chemicals Llc Methods for making polymer particulates in gel form
US20130209348A1 (en) * 2012-02-09 2013-08-15 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Preparation of polymeric resins and carbon materials
US11101458B2 (en) 2012-08-24 2021-08-24 Sila Nanotechnologies, Inc. Scaffolding matrix with internal nanoparticles
US11495793B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2022-11-08 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US10714744B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2020-07-14 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US10454103B2 (en) 2013-03-14 2019-10-22 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US20160118647A1 (en) * 2013-10-27 2016-04-28 Bindia Bhagat Carbonous composite material made with and from pine tree needles and its use in an energy cell
US11707728B2 (en) 2013-11-05 2023-07-25 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Carbon-based compositions with highly efficient volumetric gas sorption
US10814304B2 (en) 2013-11-05 2020-10-27 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Carbon-based compositions with highly efficient volumetric gas sorption
US10195583B2 (en) 2013-11-05 2019-02-05 Group 14 Technologies, Inc. Carbon-based compositions with highly efficient volumetric gas sorption
US9963395B2 (en) 2013-12-11 2018-05-08 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Methods of making carbon composites
US10711140B2 (en) 2014-03-14 2020-07-14 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Methods for sol-gel polymerization in absence of solvent and creation of tunable carbon structure from same
US10590277B2 (en) * 2014-03-14 2020-03-17 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Methods for sol-gel polymerization in absence of solvent and creation of tunable carbon structure from same
US20170015559A1 (en) * 2014-03-14 2017-01-19 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Novel methods for sol-gel polymerization in absence of solvent and creation of tunable carbon structure from same
US20170110715A1 (en) * 2014-06-10 2017-04-20 Hitachi Chemical Company, Ltd. Lithium ion secondary battery
US10202310B2 (en) 2014-09-17 2019-02-12 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Carbon composites
US9325012B1 (en) * 2014-09-17 2016-04-26 Baker Hughes Incorporated Carbon composites
US10501323B2 (en) 2014-09-29 2019-12-10 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Carbon composites and methods of manufacture
US10315922B2 (en) 2014-09-29 2019-06-11 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Carbon composites and methods of manufacture
US10480288B2 (en) 2014-10-15 2019-11-19 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Articles containing carbon composites and methods of manufacture
US9962903B2 (en) 2014-11-13 2018-05-08 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Reinforced composites, methods of manufacture, and articles therefrom
US11148950B2 (en) 2014-11-13 2021-10-19 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Reinforced composites, methods of manufacture, and articles therefrom
US10119011B2 (en) 2014-11-17 2018-11-06 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Swellable compositions, articles formed therefrom, and methods of manufacture thereof
US9745451B2 (en) 2014-11-17 2017-08-29 Baker Hughes Incorporated Swellable compositions, articles formed therefrom, and methods of manufacture thereof
US11097511B2 (en) 2014-11-18 2021-08-24 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Methods of forming polymer coatings on metallic substrates
US9714709B2 (en) 2014-11-25 2017-07-25 Baker Hughes Incorporated Functionally graded articles and methods of manufacture
US9726300B2 (en) 2014-11-25 2017-08-08 Baker Hughes Incorporated Self-lubricating flexible carbon composite seal
US10300627B2 (en) 2014-11-25 2019-05-28 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Method of forming a flexible carbon composite self-lubricating seal
US9840887B2 (en) 2015-05-13 2017-12-12 Baker Hughes Incorporated Wear-resistant and self-lubricant bore receptacle packoff tool
US11611073B2 (en) 2015-08-14 2023-03-21 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Composites of porous nano-featured silicon materials and carbon materials
WO2017031006A1 (en) * 2015-08-14 2017-02-23 Energ2 Technologies, Inc. Composites of porous nano-featured silicon materials and carbon materials
US10763501B2 (en) 2015-08-14 2020-09-01 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Nano-featured porous silicon materials
US11942630B2 (en) 2015-08-14 2024-03-26 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Nano-featured porous silicon materials
KR20230091915A (en) * 2015-08-28 2023-06-23 그룹14 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Novel materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US11437621B2 (en) 2015-08-28 2022-09-06 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US20200152983A1 (en) * 2015-08-28 2020-05-14 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Novel materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US11646419B2 (en) 2015-08-28 2023-05-09 Group 14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US10608254B2 (en) 2015-08-28 2020-03-31 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US11495798B1 (en) 2015-08-28 2022-11-08 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
KR20230092015A (en) * 2015-08-28 2023-06-23 그룹14 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Novel materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
KR102637617B1 (en) 2015-08-28 2024-02-19 그룹14 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Novel materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US10756347B2 (en) 2015-08-28 2020-08-25 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
EP3836261A1 (en) * 2015-08-28 2021-06-16 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Novel materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US10784512B2 (en) * 2015-08-28 2020-09-22 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
KR20180113187A (en) * 2015-08-28 2018-10-15 에너지2 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Novel materials exhibiting extremely durable lithium intercalation and methods for their preparation
US10923722B2 (en) 2015-08-28 2021-02-16 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
KR102528934B1 (en) 2015-08-28 2023-05-08 그룹14 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Novel material exhibiting extremely durable lithium intercalation and its preparation method
US10147950B2 (en) 2015-08-28 2018-12-04 Group 14 Technologies, Inc. Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
KR102636894B1 (en) 2015-08-28 2024-02-19 그룹14 테크놀로지스, 인코포레이티드 Novel materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
CN105355867A (en) * 2015-10-21 2016-02-24 山东玉皇新能源科技有限公司 Hard carbon negative electrode material for high-performance lithium ion power battery, and preparation method and application of hard carbon negative electrode material
US11189825B2 (en) * 2015-11-13 2021-11-30 Nanograf Corporation Graphene-encapsulated electroactive material for use in a lithium ion electrochemical cell
US10456747B2 (en) * 2015-11-13 2019-10-29 Exxonmobil Research And Engineering Company Hydrocarbon reverse osmosis membranes and separations
CN108352511A (en) * 2015-11-13 2018-07-31 西诺德科技股份有限公司 Electroactive material is encapsulated for the graphene in lithium ion electrochemical cells
US20210135208A1 (en) * 2015-12-28 2021-05-06 Johnson Matthey Public Limited Company Silicon Based Materials For And Method Of Making And Using Same
US11901551B2 (en) * 2015-12-28 2024-02-13 Sicona Battery Technologies Pty Ltd Silicon based materials for and method of making and using same
US11335904B2 (en) 2016-02-17 2022-05-17 Wacker Chemie Ag Composite core-shell particles
US10125274B2 (en) 2016-05-03 2018-11-13 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc Coatings containing carbon composite fillers and methods of manufacture
US10344559B2 (en) 2016-05-26 2019-07-09 Baker Hughes, A Ge Company, Llc High temperature high pressure seal for downhole chemical injection applications
US11447399B2 (en) * 2016-05-27 2022-09-20 Umicore Method for producing nickel lithium metal complex oxide powder of small particle size
US11127945B2 (en) 2016-06-14 2021-09-21 Nexeon Limited Electrodes for metal-ion batteries
US11894550B2 (en) 2016-06-28 2024-02-06 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York VOPO4 cathode for sodium ion batteries
US11289700B2 (en) 2016-06-28 2022-03-29 The Research Foundation For The State University Of New York KVOPO4 cathode for sodium ion batteries
US20180026262A1 (en) * 2016-07-19 2018-01-25 Samsung Sdi Co., Ltd. Negative active material, lithium battery including the same, and method of preparing the negative active material
US11588152B2 (en) * 2016-08-23 2023-02-21 Nexeon Ltd. Cathode active material for secondary battery and manufacturing method thereof
DE102016225312A1 (en) * 2016-12-16 2018-06-21 Bayerische Motoren Werke Aktiengesellschaft Anode active material with glassy carbon coating
US11611071B2 (en) 2017-03-09 2023-03-21 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Decomposition of silicon-containing precursors on porous scaffold materials
US20180316002A1 (en) * 2017-04-27 2018-11-01 Tec One Co., Ltd. Carbon-silicon composite material, negative electrode, and secondary battery
US11710819B2 (en) 2017-06-16 2023-07-25 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US11117121B2 (en) * 2017-06-26 2021-09-14 Ut-Battelle, Llc Production of biofuels with novel salts impregnated tire-derived carbon catalysts
US20180369791A1 (en) * 2017-06-26 2018-12-27 Ut-Battelle, Llc Production of biofuels with novel salts impregnated tire-derived carbon catalysts
US20200095129A1 (en) * 2018-09-24 2020-03-26 Plasma App Ltd. Carbon materials
US11695110B2 (en) 2018-11-08 2023-07-04 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
WO2020095066A1 (en) * 2018-11-08 2020-05-14 Nexeon Limited Electroactive Materials for Metal-Ion Batteries
CN113169308A (en) * 2018-11-08 2021-07-23 奈克松有限公司 Electroactive material for metal ion batteries
US11011748B2 (en) * 2018-11-08 2021-05-18 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US11165054B2 (en) 2018-11-08 2021-11-02 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
JP2022506881A (en) * 2018-11-08 2022-01-17 ネクシオン リミテッド Electrically active material for metal ion batteries
JP2022506882A (en) * 2018-11-08 2022-01-17 ネクシオン リミテッド Electrically active material for metal ion batteries
CN113169307A (en) * 2018-11-08 2021-07-23 奈克松有限公司 Electroactive material for metal ion batteries
US11688849B2 (en) 2018-11-08 2023-06-27 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US20200152973A1 (en) * 2018-11-08 2020-05-14 Nexeon Limited Electroactive Materials For Metal-Ion Batteries
WO2020095067A1 (en) * 2018-11-08 2020-05-14 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US11367868B2 (en) * 2018-11-12 2022-06-21 Sumitomo Rubber Industries, Ltd. Sulfur-based positive-electrode active material, positive-electrode and lithium-ion secondary battery
US10424786B1 (en) 2018-12-19 2019-09-24 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
WO2020128495A1 (en) 2018-12-19 2020-06-25 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US11905593B2 (en) 2018-12-21 2024-02-20 Nexeon Limited Process for preparing electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
WO2020128523A1 (en) 2018-12-21 2020-06-25 Nexeon Limited Process for preparing electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US10508335B1 (en) 2019-02-13 2019-12-17 Nexeon Limited Process for preparing electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
US11648521B2 (en) 2019-02-27 2023-05-16 Aspen Aerogels, Inc. Carbon aerogel-based electrode materials and methods of manufacture thereof
US11374213B2 (en) 2019-03-22 2022-06-28 Aspen Aerogels, Inc. Carbon aerogel-based cathodes for lithium-sulfur batteries
US11605854B2 (en) 2019-03-22 2023-03-14 Aspen Aerogels, Inc. Carbon aerogel-based cathodes for lithium-air batteries
JP7447150B2 (en) 2019-05-20 2024-03-11 ネクシオン リミテッド Electroactive materials for metal ion batteries
JP2022533387A (en) * 2019-05-20 2022-07-22 ネクシオン リミテッド Electroactive materials for metal ion batteries
FR3099885A1 (en) * 2019-08-14 2021-02-19 Commissariat A L'energie Atomique Et Aux Energies Alternatives Process for preparing a porous and nitrogenous carbonaceous material with a metal dopant, in particular useful as a catalyst for the reduction of oxygen (ORR)
EP3780197A1 (en) * 2019-08-14 2021-02-17 Commissariat à l'Energie Atomique et aux Energies Alternatives Method for preparing a porous carbonaceous and nitrogenous material with metallic dopant, in particular useful as a catalyst for oxygen reduction reaction (orr)
US20230223537A1 (en) * 2020-05-28 2023-07-13 Showa Denko K.K. Composite particles, negative electrode active material, and lithium-ion secondary battery
US11639292B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2023-05-02 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Particulate composite materials
US11611070B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2023-03-21 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Highly efficient manufacturing of silicon-carbon composites materials comprising ultra low Z
WO2022040328A1 (en) * 2020-08-18 2022-02-24 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon-carbon composites
US11492262B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2022-11-08 Group14Technologies, Inc. Silicon carbon composites comprising ultra low Z
WO2022040327A1 (en) * 2020-08-18 2022-02-24 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Manufacturing of silicon-carbon composites materials
US11804591B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2023-10-31 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Highly efficient manufacturing of silicon-carbon composite materials comprising ultra low Z
US11335903B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2022-05-17 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Highly efficient manufacturing of silicon-carbon composites materials comprising ultra low z
US11498838B2 (en) 2020-08-18 2022-11-15 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon carbon composites comprising ultra low z
US11174167B1 (en) 2020-08-18 2021-11-16 Group14 Technologies, Inc. Silicon carbon composites comprising ultra low Z
WO2022046645A3 (en) * 2020-08-25 2022-04-28 Aspen Aerogels Inc. Polyimide bead materials and methods of manufacture thereof
US10964940B1 (en) 2020-09-17 2021-03-30 Nexeon Limited Electroactive materials for metal-ion batteries
CN112510182A (en) * 2020-12-08 2021-03-16 英德奥克莱电源有限公司 Lead paste for lead-acid storage battery and lead-acid storage battery
US20220304326A1 (en) * 2021-03-25 2022-09-29 Eric Wright Shaved coffee beans and coffee shaving methods
CN113113601A (en) * 2021-04-06 2021-07-13 常德速碳新能源科技有限公司 Hard carbon negative electrode material for lithium ion secondary battery and preparation method thereof
CN115732756A (en) * 2021-08-30 2023-03-03 张家港市国泰华荣化工新材料有限公司 Electrolyte and secondary battery using same
WO2023088540A1 (en) 2021-11-16 2023-05-25 Wacker Chemie Ag Silicon subhalide-containing composite particles
CN115321514A (en) * 2022-08-29 2022-11-11 惠州亿纬锂能股份有限公司 Hard carbon material and preparation method and application thereof
CN115332532A (en) * 2022-10-12 2022-11-11 宁德新能源科技有限公司 Hard carbon material and preparation method thereof

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
US20210126251A1 (en) 2021-04-29
US20190267622A1 (en) 2019-08-29
US11495793B2 (en) 2022-11-08
CN110112377A (en) 2019-08-09
US20230115078A1 (en) 2023-04-13
US10454103B2 (en) 2019-10-22
WO2014143213A1 (en) 2014-09-18
US10714744B2 (en) 2020-07-14
CN105190948A (en) 2015-12-23
CN105190948B (en) 2019-04-26
US20170346084A1 (en) 2017-11-30

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US11495793B2 (en) Composite carbon materials comprising lithium alloying electrochemical modifiers
US20230327087A1 (en) Decomposition of silicon-containing precursors on porous scaffold materials
US11495798B1 (en) Materials with extremely durable intercalation of lithium and manufacturing methods thereof
US11611073B2 (en) Composites of porous nano-featured silicon materials and carbon materials
US20200280070A1 (en) High capacity hard carbon materials comprising efficiency enhancers
US20130252082A1 (en) Hard carbon materials
US20160133394A1 (en) Energy storage devices based on hybrid carbon electrode systems

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: ENERG2 TECHNOLOGIES, INC., WASHINGTON

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:THOMPKINS, LEAH A.;SAKSHAUG, AVERY J.;GERAMITA, KATHARINE;AND OTHERS;SIGNING DATES FROM 20131211 TO 20131213;REEL/FRAME:032164/0396

AS Assignment

Owner name: GROUP 14 TECHNOLOGIES, INC., WASHINGTON

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNOR:ENERG2 TECHNOLOGIES, INC.;REEL/FRAME:047025/0368

Effective date: 20180705

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO RESPOND TO AN OFFICE ACTION